diff options
Diffstat (limited to '23372.txt')
| -rw-r--r-- | 23372.txt | 11183 |
1 files changed, 11183 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/23372.txt b/23372.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d61d46f --- /dev/null +++ b/23372.txt @@ -0,0 +1,11183 @@ +The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Buffalo Runners, by R.M. Ballantyne + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + +Title: The Buffalo Runners + A Tale of the Red River Plains + +Author: R.M. Ballantyne + +Illustrator: R.M. Ballantyne + +Release Date: November 6, 2007 [EBook #23372] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ASCII + +*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BUFFALO RUNNERS *** + + + + +Produced by Nick Hodson of London, England + + + + +The Buffalo Runners, A tale of the Red River Plains, by R.M. Ballantyne. + +________________________________________________________________________ + +Here once again Ballantyne is on familiar ground. The theme is the +trials and tribulations suffered by the early settlers, the pioneers, in +the lands to the east of the Rockies, in particular in the Red River +basin, where it flows northwards into Lake Winnipeg. There are problems +with bad men of their own settlement; bad men from the other main fur +company (our heroes worked with the Hudson Bay Company), the +Nor'westers; Sioux and Salteaux Indians; a plague of grass-hoppers; a +plague of mice; storms that destroyed fishing-gear such as nets; Cree +Indians as well as the other two tribes; bad decisions and actions by +the advisors of Lord Selkirk, who was in charge of the whole operation +of settlement; accidental wounds. The heroes of the tale are two young +boys, one of whom is "disabled" and weak, but both are shining examples +of goodness and bravery. The women of the tale are of course all +beautiful and devoted members of their various households. The men of +the tale vary between the competent and the incompetent; the lazy and +idle, and the industrious; the cunning, and the stupid. + +It might be quite a good idea to read the book more than once, so that +you can get it clear in your mind who is on whose side! + +________________________________________________________________________ + +THE BUFFALO RUNNERS; A TALE OF THE RED RIVER PLAINS, BY R.M. BALLANTYNE. + + + +CHAPTER ONE. + +A TALE OF THE RED RIVER PLAINS. + +HELP! + +A blizzard was blowing wildly over the American prairies one winter day +in the earlier part of the present century. + +Fresh, free and straight, it came from the realms of Jack Frost, and +cold--bitterly cold--like the bergs on the Arctic seas, to which it had +but recently said farewell. + +Snow, fine as dust and sharp as needles, was caught up bodily by the +wind in great masses--here in snaky coils, there in whirling eddies, +elsewhere in rolling clouds; but these had barely time to assume +indefinite forms when they were furiously scattered and swept away as by +the besom of destruction, while earth and sky commingled in a smother of +whitey-grey. + +All the demons of the Far North seemed to have taken an outside passage +on that blizzard, so tremendous was the roaring and shrieking, while the +writhing of tormented snow-drifts suggested powerfully the madness of +agony. + +Two white and ghostly pillars moved slowly but steadily through all this +hurly-burly in a straight line. One of the pillars was short and broad; +the other was tall and stately. Both were very solid--agreeably so, +when contrasted with surrounding chaos. Suddenly the two pillars +stopped--though the gale did not. + +Said the short pillar to the tall one-- + +"Taniel Tavidson, if we will not get to the Settlement this night; it +iss my belief that every one o' them will perish." + +"Fergus," replied the tall pillar, sternly, "they shall _not_ perish if +I can help it. At all events, if they do, I shall die in the attempt to +save them. Come on." + +Daniel Davidson became less like a white pillar as he spoke, and more +like a man, by reason of his shaking a good deal of the snow off his +stalwart person. Fergus McKay followed his comrade's example, and +revealed the fact--for a few minutes--that beneath the snow-mask there +stood a young man with a beaming countenance of fiery red, the flaming +character of which, however, was relieved by an expression of ineffable +good-humour. + +The two men resumed their march over the dreary plain in silence. +Indeed, conversation in the circumstances was out of the question. The +brief remarks that had been made when they paused to recover breath were +howled at each other while they stood face to face. + +The nature of the storm was such that the gale seemed to rush at the +travellers from all quarters at once--including above and below. Men of +less vigour and resolution would have been choked by it; but men who +don't believe in choking, and have thick necks, powerful frames, vast +experience, and indomitable wills are not easily choked! + +"It blows hard--whatever," muttered Fergus to himself, with that +prolonged emphasis on the last syllable of the last word which is +eminently suggestive of the Scottish Highlander. + +Davidson may have heard the remark, but he made no reply. + +Day declined, but its exit was not marked by much difference in the very +feeble light, and the two men held steadily on. The moon came out. As +far as appearances went she might almost as well have stayed in, for +nobody saw her that night. Her mere existence somewhere in the sky, +however, rendered the indescribable chaos visible. Hours passed by, but +still the two men held on their way persistently. + +They wore five-feet-long snow-shoes. Progress over the deep snow +without these would have been impossible. One traveller walked behind +the other to get the benefit of his beaten track, but the benefit was +scarcely appreciable, for the whirling snow filled each footstep up +almost as soon as it was made. Two days and a night had these men +travelled with but an hour or two of rest in the shelter of a copse, +without fire, and almost without food, yet they pushed on with the +energy of fresh and well-fed men. + +Nothing but some overpowering necessity could have stimulated them to +such prolonged and severe exertion. Even self-preservation might have +failed to nerve them to it, for both had well-nigh reached the limit of +their exceptional powers, but each was animated by a stronger motive +than self. Fergus had left his old father in an almost dying state on +the snow-clad plains, and Davidson had left his affianced bride. + +The buffalo-hunt had failed that year; winter had set in with unwonted +severity and earlier than usual. The hunters, with the women and +children who followed them in carts to help and to reap the benefit of +the hunt, were starving. Their horses died or were frozen to death; +carts were snowed up; and the starving hunters had been scattered in +making the best of their way back to the Settlement of Red River from +which they had started. + +When old McKay broke down, and his only daughter Elspie had firmly +asserted her determination to remain and die with him, Fergus McKay and +Daniel Davidson felt themselves to be put upon their mettle--called on +to face a difficulty of the most appalling nature. To remain on the +snow-clad prairie without food or shelter would be death to all, for +there was no living creature there to be shot or trapped. On the other +hand, to travel a hundred miles or so on foot--and without food, seemed +an impossibility. Love, however, ignores the impossible! The two young +men resolved on the attempt. They were pretty well aware of the extent +of their physical powers. They would put them fairly to the test for +once--even though for the last time! They prepared for the old man and +his daughter a shelter in the heart of a clump of willows, near to which +spot they had found a group of the hapless hunters already dead and +frozen. + +Here, as far from the frozen group as possible, they made an encampment +by digging down through the snow till the ground was reached. As much +dried wood as could be found was collected, and a fire made. The young +men left their blankets behind, and, of the small quantity of provisions +that remained, they took just sufficient to sustain life. Then, with +cheery words of encouragement, they said good-bye, and set out on their +journey to the Settlement for help. + +The object at which they aimed was almost gained at the point when we +introduce them to the reader. + +"Taniel!" said Fergus, coming to a sudden halt. + +"Well?" exclaimed the other. + +"It iss sleepy that I am. Maybe if I wass to lie down--" + +He ceased to speak. Davidson looked anxiously into his face, and saw +that he had already begun to give way to irresistible drowsiness. +Without a moment's hesitation he seized the Highlander by the throat, +and shook him as if he had been a mere baby. + +"Iss it for fightin' ye are?" said Fergus, whose good-nature was not +proof against such rough and unexpected treatment. + +"Yes, my boy, that's just what I am for, and I think you'll get the +worst of it too." + +"What iss that you say? Ay, ay! You will hev to bend your back then, +Taniel, for it iss not every wan that can give Fergus McKay the worst of +it!" + +Davidson made no reply, but gave his comrade a shake so violent that it +put to flight the last vestige of his good-humour and induced him to +struggle so fiercely that in a few minutes the drowsiness was also, and +effectually, driven away. + +"You'll do now," said Davidson, relaxing his grip and panting somewhat. + +"Ay, Taniel, I will be doin' now. An' you're a frund in need whatever," +returned the restored Highlander with a smile of appreciation. + +About an hour later the travellers again stopped. This time it was +Davidson who called a halt. + +"Fergus," he said, "we have been successful so far, thank God. But we +must part here. Half-an-hour will take me to my father's house, and I +want you to go down to the hut of Francois La Certe; it is nearer than +our house, you know--and get him to help you." + +"Surely, Tan, that will be wasted time," objected the Highlander. "Of +all the lazy useless scamps in Rud Ruver, Francois La Certe iss the +laziest an' most useless." + +"Useful enough for our purpose, however," returned Davidson. "Send him +up to Fort Garry with a message, while you lie down and rest. If you +don't rest, you will yourself be useless in a short time. La Certe is +not such a bad fellow as people think him, specially when his feelings +are touched." + +"That may be as you say, Tan. I will try--_whatever_." + +So saying, the two men parted and hurried on their several ways. + + + +CHAPTER TWO. + +A LAZY COUPLE DESCRIBED--AND ROUSED. + +Francois La Certe was seated on the floor of his hut smoking a long clay +pipe beside an open wood fire when Fergus McKay approached. His wife +was seated beside him calmly smoking a shorter pipe with obvious +enjoyment. + +The man was a Canadian half-breed. His wife was an Indian woman. They +were both moderately young and well matched, for they thoroughly agreed +in everything conceivable--or otherwise. In the length and breadth of +the Settlement there could not have been found a lazier or more +good-natured or good-for-nothing couple than La Certe and his spouse. +Love was, if we may venture to say so, the chief element in the +character of each. Love of self was the foundation. Then, happily, +love of each other came next. Rising gracefully, the superstructure may +be described as, love of tobacco, love of tea, love of ease, and love of +general comfort, finishing off with a top-dressing, or capital, of +pronounced, decided, and apparently incurable love of indolence. They +had only one clear and unmistakable hatred about them, and that was the +hatred of work. They had a child about four years of age which was +like-minded--and not unlike-bodied. + +In the wilderness, as in the city, such individuals are well-known by +the similarity of their characteristics. It is not that they can't +work, but they won't work--though, of course, if taxed with this +disposition they would disclaim it with mild indignation, or an +expression of hurt remonstrance, for they are almost too lazy to become +enraged. "Take life easy, or, if we can't take it easy, let us take it +as easy as we can," is, or ought to be, their motto. In low life at +home they slouch and smile. In high life they saunter and affect +easy-going urbanity--slightly mingled with mild superiority to things in +general. Whatever rank of life they belong to they lay themselves out +with persistent resolution to do as little work as they can; to make +other people do as much work for them as possible; to get out of life as +much of enjoyment as may be attainable--consistently, of course, with +the incurable indolence--and, to put off as long as may be the evil day +which, they perceive or suspect, must inevitably be coming. + +The curious thing about this race of beings is, that, whether in high or +low station, they are never ashamed of themselves--or of their position +as drones in the world's hive. They seem rather to apologise for their +degradation as a thing inevitable, for which they are not accountable-- +and sometimes, in the case of the rich, as a thing justifiable. + +"I'm glad I did not go to the plains this fall," said La Certe, stirring +the logs on the fire with his toe and emitting a prolonged sigh of +mingled smoke and contentment, while a blast from the bleak nor'-west +shook every blackened rafter in his little hut. + +"Heel hee!" responded his wife, whose Indian name--translated--was +Slowfoot, and might have been Slowtongue with equal propriety, for she +was quite an adept at the art of silence. She frequently caused a +giggle to do duty for speech. This suited her husband admirably, for he +was fond of talking--could tell a good story, sing a good song, and +express his feelings in a good hearty laugh. + +"Yes, it will be hard for the poor boys who have gone to the plains, the +weather is so awful, to say nothing of the women." + +"Ho," replied Slowfoot--though what she meant to express by this no +mortal knows--nor, perhaps, cares. It meant nothing bad, however, for +she smiled seraphically and sent forth a stream of smoke, which, +mingling with that just emitted by her husband, rose in a curling +harmony to the roof. + +Slowfoot was not a bad-looking woman as North American Indians go. She +was brown unquestionably, and dirty without doubt, but she had a +pleasant expression, suggestive of general good-will, and in the budding +period of life must have been even pretty. She was evidently older than +her husband, who might, perhaps, have been a little over thirty. + +"I should not wonder," continued La Certe, "if the buffalo was drove +away, and the people starved this year. But the buffalo, perhaps, will +return in time to save them." + +"Hm!" responded the wife, helping herself to some very strong tea, which +she poured out of a tin kettle into a tin mug and sweetened with maple +sugar. + +"Do you know if Cloudbrow went with them?" asked the half-breed, pushing +forward his mug for a supply of the cheering beverage. + +"No, he stopped in his house," replied the woman, rousing herself for a +moment to the conversational point, but relapsing immediately. + +The man spoke in patois French, the woman in her native Cree language. +For convenience we translate their conversation as near as may be into +the English in which they were wont to converse with the Scotch settlers +who, some time before, had been sent out by the Earl of Selkirk to +colonise that remote part of the northern wilderness. + +La Certe's father was a French Canadian, his mother an Indian woman, but +both having died while he was yet a boy he had been brought or left to +grow up under the care of an English woman who had followed the fortunes +of the La Certe family. His early companions had been half-breeds and +Indians. Hence he could speak the English, French, and Indian languages +with equal incorrectness and facility. + +"You don't like Cloudbrow," remarked the man with an inquiring glance +over the rim of his mug. "Why you not like him?" + +"Hee! hee!" was Slowfoot's lucid reply. Then, with an unwonted frown on +her mild visage, she added with emphasis-- + +"No! I _not_ like him." + +"I know that," returned the husband, setting down his mug and resuming +his pipe, "but why?" + +To this the lady answered with a sound too brief to spell, and the +gentleman, being accustomed to his wife's little eccentricities, broke +into a hilarious laugh, and assured her that Cloudbrow was not a bad +fellow--a capital hunter and worthy of more regard than she was aware +of. + +"For," said he, "Cloudbrow is willing to wait till spring for payment of +the horse an' cart I hired from him last year. You know that I could +not pay him till I go to the plains an' get another load of meat an' +leather. You will go with me, Slowfoot, an' we will have grand times of +it with buffalo-humps an' marrow bones, an' tea an' tobacco. Ah! it +makes my mouth water. Give me more tea. So. That will do. What a +noise the wind makes! I hopes it won't blow over the shed an' kill the +horse. But if it do I cannot help that. Cloudbrow could not ask me to +pay for what the wind does." + +There came another gust of such violence, as he spoke, that even +Slowfoot's benignant expression changed to a momentary glance of +anxiety, for the shingles on the roof rattled, and the rafters creaked +as if the hut were groaning under the strain. It passed, however, and +the pair went on smoking with placid contentment, for they had but +recently had a "square" meal of pemmican and flour. + +This compost when cooked in a frying-pan is exceedingly rich and +satisfying--not to say heavy--food, but it does not incommode such as La +Certe and his wife. It even made the latter feel amiably disposed to +Cloudbrow. + +This _sobriquet_ had been given by the half-breeds to a young Scotch +settler named Duncan McKay, in consequence of the dark frown which had +settled habitually on his brow--the result of bad temper and unbridled +passion. He was younger brother to that Fergus who has already been +introduced to the reader. Having been partially trained, while in +Scotland, away from the small farm-house of his father, and having +received a better education, Duncan conceived himself to stand on a +higher level than the sedate and uneducated Fergus. Thus pride was +added to his bad temper. But he was not altogether destitute of good +points. What man is? One of these was a certain reckless +open-handedness, so that he was easily imposed on by the protestations +and assurances of the sly, plausible, and lazy La Certe. + +The couple were still engaged in smoking, quaffing tea, and other +intellectual pursuits, when they heard sounds outside as of some one +approaching. Another moment, and the door burst open, and a man in +white stepped in. He saluted them with a familiar and hasty +"_bonjour_," as he stamped and beat the snow vigorously from his +garments. + +"What? Antoine Dechamp!" exclaimed La Certe, rising slowly to welcome +his friend; "you seem in hurry?" + +"Ay--in great hurry! They are starving on the plains! Many are dead! +Davidson has come in! He is more than half-dead! Can hardly tell the +news! Drops asleep when he is speaking! Luckily I met him when going +home in my cariole! Okematan, the Indian, was with me. So he got out, +and said he would pilot Davidson safe home! He said something about +Fergus McKay, which I could not understand, so I have come on, and will +drive to Fort Garry with the news! But my horse has broke down! Is +yours in the stable?" + +Dechamp was a sturdy young half-breed and an old playmate of La Certe. +He spoke with obvious impatience at the delay caused by having so much +to tell. + +"Is your horse in the stable?" he demanded sharply a second time, while +his friend began, with exasperating composure, to assure him that it +was, but that the horse was not his. + +"Cloudbrow is its owner," he said, "and you know if anything happens to +it he will ---. Stay, I will get you lantern--" + +He stopped, for Dechamp, observing a large key hanging on the wall, had +seized it and rushed out of the hut without waiting for a lantern. + +"Strange, how easy some men get into a fuss!" remarked La Certe to his +surprised, but quiet, spouse as he lighted a large tin lantern, and went +to the door. Looking out with an expression of discomfort, he put on +his cap, and prepared to face the storm in the cause of humanity. He +held the lantern high up first, however, and peered under it as if to +observe the full extent of the discomfort before braving it. Just then +a furious gust blew out the light. + +"Ha! I expected that," he said, with a sigh that was strongly +suggestive of relief, as he returned to the fire to relight the lantern. + +On going the second time to the door he observed the form of his friend +leading the horse past--both of them looking dim and spectral through +the driving snow. + +"Dechamp have good eyes!" he remarked, halting on the threshold. "There +is light enough without the lantern; besides--ha! there, it is out +again! What a trouble it is! Impossible to keep it in--such a night!" + +"Hee! hee!" giggled Slowfoot, who was busy refilling her pipe. + +La Certe was still standing in a state of hesitancy, troubled by a +strong desire to help his friend, and a stronger desire to spare +himself, when he was thrown somewhat off his wonted balance by the +sudden reappearance of Dechamp, leading, or rather supporting, a man. + +Need we say that it was Fergus McKay, almost blind and dumb from +exhaustion, for the parting from Dan Davidson which we have mentioned +had proved to be the last straw which broke them both down, and it is +probable that the frozen corpse of poor Dan would have been found next +day on the snow, had he not been accidentally met by Dechamp, and taken +in charge by the Indian Okematan. Fergus, having a shorter way to go, +and, perhaps, possessing a little more vitality or endurance, had just +managed to stagger to La Certe's hut when he encountered the same man +who, an hour previously, had met and saved his companion further down +the Settlement. + +The moment Fergus entered the hut, he looked wildly round, and opened +his mouth as if to speak. Then he suddenly collapsed, and fell in a +heap upon the floor, scattering flakes of snow from his person in all +directions. + +La Certe and his wife, though steeped in selfishness, were by no means +insensible to the sufferings of humanity when these were actually made +visible to their naked eyes. Like many--too many--people, they were +incapable of being impressed very deeply through their ears, but could +be keenly touched through the eyes. No sooner did they behold the +condition of Fergus--who was well-known to them--than they dropped their +apathetic characters as though they had been garments. + +In her haste Slowfoot let fall her pipe, which broke to atoms on the +floor--but she heeded it not. La Certe capsized his mug of tea--but +regarded it not; and while the former proceeded to remove the shawl from +Fergus's neck and chafe his cold hands, the latter assisted Dechamp to +drag the exhausted man a little nearer to the fire, and poured a cup of +warm tea down his throat. + +Their efforts, though perchance not as wisely directed as they might +have been, were so vigorously conducted that success rewarded them. +Fergus soon began to show signs of returning animation. A hunter of the +western wilderness is not easily overcome, neither is he long of +reviving, as a rule, if not killed outright. + +They set him up in a sitting posture with his back against a box, and +his feet towards the fire. Heaving a deep sigh, Fergus looked round +with a bewildered, anxious expression. In a moment intelligence +returned to his eyes, and he made a violent attempt to rise, but Dechamp +held him down. + +"Let me up!" he gasped, "life and death are in the matter--if it iss not +death already--" + +"Be still, Fergus McKay," said Dechamp, with that firmness of manner and +tone which somehow command respect; "I know all about it. Take one bit +of bread, one swig more of tea, and you go with me to Fort Garry, to +tell the Gov'nor what you know. He will send help at once." + +Great was the relief of Fergus when he heard this. Submitting to +treatment like an obedient child, he was soon fit to stagger to the +sleigh or cariole, into which he was carefully stuffed and packed like a +bale of goods by La Certe and his wife, who, to their credit be it +recorded, utterly ignored, for once, the discomforts of the situation. + +Fergus was asleep before the packing was quite done. Then Dechamp +jumped in beside him, and drove off in the direction of the Hudson's Bay +Company's establishment, Fort Garry, while our worthy couple returned to +their hut to indulge in a final and well-earned pipe and a mug of the +strongest possible tea. + + + +CHAPTER THREE. + +TO THE RESCUE. + +Winnipeg city, with its thousands of inhabitants, now covers the spot to +which Antoine Dechamp drove his friend Fergus McKay. + +At the time we write of, the only habitation there was Fort Garry, a +solitary stone building of some strength, but without regular troops of +any kind, and held only by a few employes of the Hudson's Bay Company, +who were there only in the capacity of fur-traders. + +Here the Governor of the colony received the unexpected guests with +hospitality; heard the tale of Fergus with a sympathetic ear, and at +once organised a rescue-expedition with dog-sledges and provisions. + +While this was being done at the fort, Dan Davidson was similarly +employed at Prairie Cottage, the residence of his mother, who, since the +death of her husband--a farmer from the Scottish Lowlands--had managed +her farm with the aid of her two sons, Dan and Peter; the latter being a +youth of seventeen. She was also assisted by her only daughter, Jessie, +who was over thirteen years of age, and already esteemed an authority on +the subjects of poultry, cookery, and dairy produce. A small servant--a +French half-breed named Louise--completed the household of the widow +Davidson. + +On reaching home, Dan, like Fergus McKay, experienced difficulties that +he had not counted on, for his overtaxed strength fairly broke down, and +he found himself almost incapable at first of telling his tale of +disaster. Then, when he tried to go about the needful preparations for +rescue, he found himself unable to resist drowsiness, and if he ventured +to sit down for a moment he fell sound asleep at once. + +Those who have experienced this condition know how overwhelming and +intensely disagreeable it is, especially if resistance to it is rendered +imperative by a matter of life or death. Davidson struggled bravely +against it of course, but the struggle had already been so long +continued that his efforts were now in vain. + +Starting up from the supper which Jessie had spread before him, and +which he was languidly attempting to eat, he said, almost fiercely, +"Where is the wash-tub, Louise?" + +The surprised little domestic pointed to the article in question. + +"Here; fetch some cold water." + +"It is full," said Louise with a strong French accent and a pretty lisp. + +Without the ceremony even of throwing back his collar Dan plunged his +head into the water, and, after steeping it for a few seconds, drew it +out refreshed. + +His younger brother entered the room at that moment. + +"Peter," he said, drying his head violently with a jack-towel, "have you +got the sledge ready, and the provisions packed, and the empty sledge +wi' the buffalo-robes?" + +"Ay--all ready," answered the other, for he was a sprightly, willing +youth, who rejoiced in any unexpected demand on his superabundant +energies. "But I say, Dan, you are quite unfit to start off again +without rest." + +He looked in his brother's face anxiously, for Dan had seated himself +once more to his food, but seemed unable to deal with it properly. +"Why, you've got the knife and fork in the wrong hands, Dan! You _must_ +have an hour's rest before we start." + +"Impossible," returned the other with a dazed look, as he seized a mug +of water and drank it off. "An hour's delay may mean death to Elspie +and old Duncan McKay." + +"But let _me_ start off at once," returned Peter, eagerly. "I've a +pretty good guess, from your description, where you left them. Besides, +the gale is not so bad now. After an hour's sleep you will be able to +start fresh, maybe overtake me. Jess will be sure to waken you in--" + +He stopped, for his brother's head had bent slowly forward while he was +speaking, and now rested on his arms on the table. The worn-out man was +sound asleep. + +"Just leave him, Peter, and be off wi' the dogs," said Mrs Davidson. +"Okematan will keep you in the right track. I'll be sure to wake him in +time to catch you up." + +"No, mother, not without his leave," said the youth, firmly. "Dan! +Dan! rouse up, old boy! Shall we start without you?" + +"Yes, yes--I'm ready," said the poor fellow, starting up and swaying to +and fro like a drunken man; "but--I say, Peter, I'm done for. I depend +on you, lad, to keep me up to the scratch. Lay the dog-whip across my +shoulders if I try to lie down. Promise me that. D'ee hear!" + +"Yes, I understand," returned the youth with intense earnestness. "Now +look here, Dan, you know me: will you trust me?" + +"Of course I will," answered Dan with a languid smile. + +"Well, then; come along, we'll rescue Elspie--you may depend on that. +Okematan and I will look after you and see that all goes right. Come." + +He took his brother by the arm, and led him unresistingly away, followed +by the dark-skinned Indian, who, with the usual reticence of his race, +had stood like a brown statue, silently observing events. + +Jessie Davidson, who was a fair and comely maiden, touched him on the +arm as he was passing out-- + +"Oh! take care of him, Okematan," she said, anxiously. + +Okematan replied "Ho!" in a sort of grunt. It was an expressively +uttered though not very comprehensible reply; but Jessie was satisfied, +for she knew the man well, as he had for a considerable time been, not +exactly a servant of the house, but a sort of self-appointed hanger-on, +or unpaid retainer. For an Indian, he was of a cheerful disposition and +made himself generally useful. + +When they were outside, it was found that the gale had abated +considerably, and that the moon was occasionally visible among the +clouds which were driving wildly athwart the heavens, as though the +elemental war which had ceased to trouble the earth were still raging in +the sky. + +"Peter," said the brother, as they stood for a moment beside two Indian +sledges, one of which was laden with provisions, the other +empty--"Peter, don't forget your promise. Lay the whip on heavy. +Nothing else will keep me awake!" + +"All right! Sit down there for a moment. We're not quite ready yet." + +"I'd better not. No! I will stand till it's time to start," returned +Dan with a dubious shake of his head. + +"Didn't you say you would trust me?" + +"Yes, I did, old boy." + +"Does it look like trusting me to refuse the very first order I give +you? What an example to Okematan! I am in command, Dan. Do as you're +bid, sir, and sit down." + +With a faint smile, and a still more dubious shake of the head, Dan +obeyed. He sat down on the empty sledge and the expected result +followed. In a few seconds he was asleep. + +"Now we'll pack him in tight," observed his brother, as he and the +Indian stretched the sleeper at full length on the sledge, wrapped him +completely up in the warm buffalo-robes, and lashed him down in such a +way that he resembled a mummy, with nothing visible of him except his +mouth and nose. + +Four strong large dogs were attached to each sledge in tandem fashion, +each dog having a little collar and harness of its own. No reins were +necessary. A track beaten in the soft snow with his snow-shoes by the +Indian, who stepped out in front, was guide enough for them; and a +tail-line attached to the rear of each sledge, and held by the drivers, +sufficed to restrain them when a stretch of hard snow or ice tempted +them to have a scamper. + +The road thus beaten over the prairie by Okematan, though a +comparatively soft one, was by no means smooth, and the rough motion +would, in ordinary circumstances, have rendered sleep impossible to our +hero; but it need hardly be said that it failed to disturb him on the +present occasion. He slept like an infant throughout the whole night; +cared nothing for the many plunges down the prairie waves, and recked +not of the frequent jerks out of the hollows. + +Hour after hour did Peter Davidson with his silent companion trudge over +the monotonous plains--hope in the ascendant, and vigour, apparently, +inexhaustible. The dogs, too, were good and strong. A brief halt now +and then of a few minutes sufficed to freshen them for every new start. +Night passed away, and daylight came in with its ghostly revelations of +bushes that looked like bears or buffaloes, and snow-wreaths that +suggested the buried forms of frozen men. + +Then the sun arose and scattered these sombre visions of early morning +with its gladdening, soul-reviving rays. + +At this point the rescue-party chanced to have reached one of those +bluffs of woodland which at that time speckled the plains--though they +were few indeed and far between. + +"Breakfast," said Peter, heaving a profound sigh as he turned about and +checked the teams, for at that point he happened to be in advance +beating the track. + +Okematan expressed his entire concurrence with an emphatic "Ho!" The +wearied dogs lay down in their tracks, shot out their tongues, panted, +and looked amiable, for well they knew the meaning of the word +"breakfast" and the relative halt. + +The sudden stoppage awoke the sleeper, and he struggled to rise. + +"Hallo! What's wrong? Where am I? Have the Redskins got hold o' me at +last?" + +"Ay, that they have. At least one Red-skin has got you," said Peter. +"Have a care, man, don't struggle so violently. Okematan won't scalp +you." + +The sound of his brother's voice quieted Davidson, and at once restored +his memory. + +"Cast me loose, Peter," he said; "you're a good fellow. I see you have +brought me along wi' you, and I feel like a giant refreshed now, tho' +somewhat stiff. Have we come far?" + +"I don't know how far we've come, but I know that we've been pegging +along the whole night, and that we must have breakfast before we take +another step. It's all very well for you, Dan, to lie there all night +like a mere bag o' pemmican enjoying yourself, but you must remember +that your brother is mortal, and so are the dogs, to say nothing o' the +Red-skin." + +While he was speaking, the youth undid the fastenings, and set his +brother free, but Dan was far too anxious to indulge in pleasantries +just then. After surveying the landscape, and coming to a conclusion as +to where they were, he took a hurried breakfast of dried meat--cold. +The dogs were also treated to a hearty feed, and then, resuming the +march, the rescuers pushed on with renewed vigour--Dan Davidson now +beating the track, and thus rendering it more easy for those who came +behind him. + +All that day they pushed on almost without halt, and spent the next +night in a clump of willows; but Dan was too anxious to take much rest. +They rose at the first sign of daybreak, and pushed on at their utmost +speed, until the poor dogs began to show signs of breaking down; but an +extra hour of rest, and a full allowance of food kept them up to the +mark, while calm weather and clear skies served to cheer them on their +way. + + + +CHAPTER FOUR. + +TELLS OF LOVE, DUTY, STARVATION, AND MURDER. + +Pushing on ahead of them, with that sometimes fatal facility peculiar to +writers and readers, we will now visit the couple whom Dan and his party +were so anxious to rescue. + +A single glance at Elspie McKay would have been sufficient to account to +most people for the desperate anxiety of Daniel Davidson to rescue her +from death, for her pretty sparkling face and ever-varying expression +were irresistibly suggestive of a soul full of sympathy and tender +regard for the feelings of others. + +Nut-brown hair, dark eyes, brilliant teeth, and many more charms that it +would take too much time and room to record still further accounted for +the desperate determination with which Dan had wooed and won her. + +But to see this creature at her best, you had to see her doing the +dutiful to her old father. If ever there was a peevish, cross-grained, +crabbed, unreasonable old sinner in this world, that sinner was Duncan +McKay, senior. He was a widower. Perhaps that accounted to some extent +for his condition. That he should have a younger son--also named +Duncan--a cross ne'er-do-weel like himself--was natural, but how he came +to have such a sweet daughter as Elspie, and such a good elder son as +Fergus, are mysteries which we do not attempt to unravel or explain. +Perhaps these two took after their departed mother. We know not, for we +never met her. Certain it is that they did not in the least resemble +their undeparted father--except in looks, for McKay senior had been a +handsome man, though at the time we introduce him his good looks, like +his temper, had nearly fled, and he was considerably shrivelled up by +age, hard work, and exposure. The poor man was too old to emigrate to a +wilderness home when he had set out for the Red River Colony, and the +unusual sufferings, disappointments, and hardships to which the first +settlers were exposed had told heavily on even younger men than he. + +Elspie's love for her father was intense; her pity for him in his +misfortunes was very tender; and, now that he was brought face to face +with, perhaps, the greatest danger that had ever befallen him, her +anxiety to relieve and comfort him was very touching. She seemed quite +to forget herself, and the fact that she might perish on the bleak +plains along with her father did not seem even to occur to her. + +"It wass madness to come here, _whatever_," said the poor old man, as he +cowered over the small fire, which his son Fergus had kindled before +leaving, and which Elspie had kept up with infinite labour and +difficulty ever since. + +The remark was made testily to himself, for Elspie had gone into the +surrounding bush, axe in hand, to find, if possible, and cut down some +more small pieces of firewood. When she returned with an armful of dry +sticks, he repeated the sentiment still more testily, and added--"If it +wass not for Tuncan, I would have been at home this night in my warm +bed, wi' a goot supper inside o' me, instead o' freezin' an' starvin' +oot here on the plain among the snow. It's mischief that boy wass +always after from the tay he wass born." + +"But you know that poor Duncan could not guess we were to have such +awful weather, or that the buffalo would be so scarce. Come now, dear +daddy," said the cheery girl, as she heaped on wood and made a blaze +that revived the old man, "I'll warm up some more of the tea. There's a +very little left--and--and--it surely won't be long till God sends +Daniel and Fergus back to us with food." + +Old McKay was somewhat mollified by her manner, or by the fire, or by +the prospect of relief held out, for his tone improved decidedly. + +"Try the bag again, lass," he said, "maybe you'll find a crumb or two in +the corners yet. It will do no harm to try." + +Obediently poor Elspie tried, but shook her head as she did so. + +"There's nothing there, daddy. I turned it inside out last time." + +"Wow! but it's ill to bear!" exclaimed old Duncan, with a +half-suppressed groan. + +Meanwhile his daughter put the tin kettle on the fire and prepared their +last cup of tea. When it was ready she looked up with a peculiar +expression on her face, as she drew something from her pocket. + +"Look here, daddy," she said, holding up a bit of pemmican about the +size of a hen's egg. + +The old man snatched it from her, and, biting off a piece, began to chew +with a sort of wolfish voracity. + +"I reserved it till now," said the girl, "for I knew that this being the +second night, you would find it impossible to get to sleep at all +without something in you, however small. If you manage to sleep on this +and the cup of hot tea, you'll maybe rest well till morning--and then--" + +"God forgive me!" exclaimed the old man, suddenly pausing, as he was +about to thrust the last morsel into his mouth; "hunger makes me +selfish. I wass forgettin' that you are starvin' too, my tear. Open +your mouth." + +"No, father, I don't want it. I really don't feel hungry." + +"Elspie, my shild," said old Duncan, in a tone of stern remonstrance, +"when wass it that you began to tell lies?" + +"I'm telling the truth, daddy. I did feel hungry yesterday, but that +has passed away, and to-day I feel only a little faint." + +"Open your mouth, I'm tellin' you," repeated old Duncan in a tone of +command which long experience had taught Elspie promptly to obey. She +received the morsel, ate it with much relish, and wished earnestly for +more. + +"Now, you'll lie down and go to sleep," she said, after her father had +washed down the last morsel of food with the last cup of hot tea, "and +I'll gather a few more sticks to keep the fire going till morning. I +think it is not so cold as it was, and the wind is quite gone. They +have been away five days now, or more. I think that God, in His mercy, +will send us relief in the morning." + +"You are a goot lass, my tear," said the old man, allowing himself to be +made as comfortable as it was in his daughter's power to accomplish; +"what you say is ferry true. The weather feels warmer, and the wind is +down. Perhaps they will find us in the mornin'. Goot-night, my tear." + +It was one of the characteristics of this testy old man, that he +believed it quite possible for a human being to get on quite well enough +in this world without any distinct recognition of his Maker. + +Once, in conversation with his youngest son and namesake Duncan junior, +he had somehow got upon this subject, not by any means in a reverential, +but in an argumentative, controversial spirit, and had expressed the +opinion that as man knew nothing whatever about God, and had no means of +finding out anything about Him, there was no need to trouble one's head +about Him at all. + +"I just go about my work, Tuncan," he said, "an' leave preachin' an' +prayin' an' psalm-singin' to them that likes it. There's Elspie, now. +She believes in God, an' likes goin' to churches an' meetin's, an' that +seems to make her happy. Ferry goot--I don't pelieve in these things, +an' I think I'm as happy as hersel'." + +"Humph!" grunted the son in a tone of unconcealed contempt; "if ye _are_ +as happy as hersel', faither, yer looks give the lie to your condeetion, +_whatever_. An' there's this great dufference between you an' her, that +she's not only happy hersel', but she does her best to mak other folk +happy--but you, wi' your girnin' an' snappin', are always doin' the best +ye can to mak everybody aboot ye meeserable." + +"Tuncan," retorted the sire, with solemn candour, "it iss the same +compliment I can return to yoursel' with interest, my boy--what_ever_." + +With such sentiments, then, it is not remarkable that Duncan McKay +senior turned over to sleep as he best could without looking to a higher +source than earth afforded for help in his extremity. Happily his +daughter was actuated by a better spirit, and when she at last lay down +on her pile of brushwood, with her feet towards the fire, and her head +on a buffalo robe, the fact of her having previously committed herself +and her father to God made her sleep all the sounder. + +In another clump of wood not many miles distant from the spot where the +father and daughter lay, two hunters were encamped. One was Duncan +McKay, to whom we have just referred as being in discord with his +father. The other was a Canadian named Henri Perrin. + +Both men were gaunt and weakened by famine. They had just returned to +camp from an unsuccessful hunt, and the latter, being first to return, +had kindled the fire, and was about to put on the kettle when McKay came +in. + +"I've seen nothing," remarked McKay as he flung down his gun and then +flung himself beside it. "Did you see anything?" + +"No, nothing," answered Perrin, breaking off a piece of pemmican and +putting it into the pot. + +"How much is left?" asked McKay. + +"Hardly enough for two days--for the two of us; four days perhaps for +one!" answered the other. + +McKay looked up quickly, but the Canadian was gazing abstractedly into +the pot. Apparently his remark had no significance. But McKay did not +think so. Since arriving in the colony he had seen and heard much about +deception and crime among both Indians and half-breeds. Being +suspicious by nature, he became alarmed, for it was evident enough, as +Perrin had said, that food to last two men for three days would last one +man for six, and the one who should possess six days' provisions might +hope to reach the Settlement alive, even though weakened by previous +starvation. + +The dark expression which had procured for Duncan McKay junior the +_sobriquet_ of Cloudbrow from La Certe and his wife, deepened visibly as +these thoughts troubled his brain, and for some time he sat gazing at +the fire in profound abstraction. + +Young McKay was not by any means one of the most depraved of men, but +when a man is devoid of principle it only requires temptation strong +enough, and opportunity convenient, to sink him suddenly to the lowest +depths. Starvation had so far weakened the physique of the hunters that +it was obviously impossible for both of them to reach the Settlement on +two days' short allowance of food. The buffalo had been driven away +from that neighbourhood by the recent storm, and the hope of again +falling in with them was now gone. The starving hunters, as we have +said, had broken up camp, and were scattered over the plains no one +could tell where. To find them might take days, if not weeks; and, even +if successful, of what avail would it be to discover groups of men who +were in the same predicament with themselves? To remain where they were +was certain and not far-distant death! The situation was desperate, and +each knew it to be so. Yet each did not take it in the same way. +McKay, as we have said, became abstracted and slightly nervous. The +Canadian, whatever his thoughts, was calm and collected, and went about +his culinary operations as if he were quite at ease. He was about to +lift the pot off the hook that suspended it over the fire, when his +companion quietly, and as if without any definite purpose, took up his +gun. + +Perrin observed the action, and quickly reached out his hand towards his +own weapon, which lay on the ground beside him. + +Quick as lightning McKay raised his gun and fired. Next moment his +comrade lay dead upon the ground--shot through the heart! + +Horror-struck at what he had done, the murderer could scarcely believe +his eyes, and he stood up glaring at the corpse as if he had been frozen +to death in that position. After standing a long time, he sat down and +tried to think of his act and the probable consequences. + +Self-defence was the first idea that was suggested clearly to him; and +he clung to it as a drowning man is said to cling to a straw. "Was it +not clear," he thought, "that Perrin intended to murder me? If not, why +so quick to grip his gun? If I had waited it would have been me, not +Perrin, that would be lying there now!" + +His memory reminded him faithfully, however, that when he first thought +of taking up his gun, Conscience had sternly said,--"Don't." Why should +Conscience have spoken thus, or at all, if his motive had been innocent? + +There are two ways in which a wicked man gets rid of conscientious +troubles--at least for a time. One way is by stout-hearted defiance of +God, and ignoring of Conscience altogether. The other is by sophistical +reasoning, and a more or less successful effort to throw dust in his own +eyes. + +Duncan McKay took the latter method. It is an easy enough method-- +especially with the illogical--but it works indifferently, and it does +not last long. + +Conscience may be seared; may be ignored; may be trampled on, but it +cannot be killed; it cannot even be weakened and is ever ready at the +most unseasonable and unexpected times to start up, vigorous and +faithful to the very end, with its emphatic "Don't!" and "No!" + +Dragging the body out of the camp, McKay returned to take his supper and +reason the matter out with himself. + +"I could not help myself," he thought; "when I took up my gun I did not +intend to kill the man." + +Conscience again reminded him of its "Don't!" + +"And would not every man in Rud Ruver justify me for firing first in +self-defence?" + +Conscience again said "No!" + +Here the hunter uttered a savage oath, to which Conscience made no +reply, for Conscience never speaks back or engages in disputation. + +We need not attempt further to analyse the workings of sophistry in the +brain of a murderer. Suffice it to say that when the man had finished +his supper he had completely, though not satisfactorily, justified +himself in his own eyes. There was, he felt, a disagreeable +undercurrent of uneasiness; but this might have been the result of fear +as to how the Canadian half-breeds and friends of the slain man would +regard the matter in the event of its being found out. + +There was reason for anxiety on this head, for poor Perrin was a great +favourite among his comrades, while Cloudbrow was very much the reverse. + +Having finished the supper which he had purchased at such a terrible +price, the young man gathered his things together, packed the provisions +on his back, put on his snow-shoes and left the scene of the murder. + +Although a dark night, there was sufficient moon-light to enable him to +pick his steps, but he had not advanced more than two miles when he came +upon the track of a party that had preceded him. This rendered the +walking more easy, and as he plodded along he reflected that the wolves +would soon find Perrin's body, and, by tearing it to pieces render +recognition of the victim impossible. + +Suddenly it occurred to him that if any of the scattered band of hunters +should come on the camp before the wolves had time to do their work, the +print of his snow-shoes might tell a tale--for snowshoes were of various +shapes and sizes, and most of his companions in the Settlement might be +pretty well acquainted with the shape of his. The danger of such a +_contretemps_ was not great, but, to make quite sure that it should not +occur, he turned round and walked straight back on his track to the camp +he had just left--thus obliterating, or, rather, confusing the track, so +as to render recognition improbable. As he walked over it a third time, +in resuming his march to the Settlement, all danger on this ground, he +considered, was effectually counteracted. Of course, when he reached +the tracks of the party before mentioned, all trace of his own track was +necessarily lost among these. + +That "murder will out" is supposed to be an unquestionable truism. We +nevertheless question it very much; for, while the thousands of cases of +murder that have been discovered are obvious, the vast number, it may +be, that have never been found out are not obvious, however probable. + +The case we are now describing seemed likely to belong to the class +which remains a mystery till altogether forgotten. Nevertheless Nemesis +was on the wing. + +While Duncan McKay junior was thus pushing his way over the plains in +the direction of Red River Settlement, two poor half-breed women were +toiling slowly over the same plains behind him, bound for the same haven +of hoped-for and much-needed rest and refreshment. The poor creatures +had been recently made widows. The husband of one, Louis Blanc, had +been killed by Indians during this hunt; that of the other, Antoine +Pierre, had met his death by being thrown from his horse when running +the buffalo. Both women were in better condition than many of the other +hunters' wives, for they had started on the homeward journey with a +better supply of meat, which had not yet been exhausted. + +It happened that Marie Blanc and Annette Pierre came upon McKay's camp +soon after he left it the second time. Here they prepared to spend the +night, but, on discovering marks of fresh blood about, they made a +search, and soon came on the unburied corpse of the murdered man, lying +behind a bush. They recognised it at once, for Perrin had been +well-known, as well as much liked, in the Settlement. + +Neither of the women was demonstrative. They did not express much +feeling, though they were undoubtedly shocked; but they dug a hole in +the snow with their snow-shoes, and buried the body of the hunter +therein--having first carefully examined the wound in his breast, and +removed the poor man's coat, which exhibited a burnt hole in front, as +well as a hole in the back, for the bullet had gone quite through him. + +Then they returned to the camp, and made a careful examination of it; +but nothing was found there which could throw light on the subject of +who was the murderer. Whether a comrade or an Indian had done the deed +there was nothing to show; but that a murder had been committed they +could not doubt, for it was physically almost impossible that a man +could have shot himself in the chest, either by accident or intention, +with one of the long-barrelled trading guns in use among the +buffalo-hunters. + +Another point, justifying the supposition of foul play, was the +significant fact that Perrin's gun, with his name rudely carved on the +stock, still lay in the camp _undischarged_. + +"See--here is something," said one woman to the other in the Cree +tongue, as they were about to quit the camp. + +She held up a knife which she had found half buried near the fire. + +"It is not a common scalping-knife," said the other woman. "It is the +knife of a settler." + +The weapon in question was one of the large sheath-knives which many of +the recently arrived settlers had brought with them from their native +land. Most of these differed a little in size and form from each other, +but all of them were very different from the ordinary scalping-knives +supplied by the fur-traders to the half-breeds and Indians. + +"I see no name on it--no mark," said the woman who found it, after a +critical inspection. Her companion examined it with equal care and +similar result. + +The two women had at first intended to encamp at this spot, but now they +determined to push forward to the Settlement as fast as their exhausted +condition permitted, carrying the knife, with the coat and gun of the +murdered man, along with them. + + + +CHAPTER FIVE. + +SAVED. + +Duncan McKay senior was dreaming of, and gloating over, the flesh-pots +of Red River, and his amiable daughter was rambling over the green +carpet of the summer prairies, when the sun arose and shone upon the +bushes which surrounded their winter camp--Starvation Camp, as the old +man had styled it. + +There is no saying how long Duncan would have gloated, and the fair +Elspie wandered, if a hair of the buffalo robe on which the former lay +had not entered his nostril, and caused him to sneeze. + +Old McKay's sneeze was something to be remembered when once heard. +Indeed it was something that could not be forgotten! From the +profoundest depths of his person it seemed to burst, and how his nose +sustained the strain without splitting has remained one of the mysteries +of the Nor'-West unto this day. It acted like an electric shock on +Elspie, who sat bolt upright at once with a scared look that was quite +in keeping with her tousled hair. + +"Oh! daddy, what a fright you gave me!" Elspie said, remonstratively. + +"It iss goot seventeen years an' more that you hev had to get used to +it, whatever," growled the old man. "I suppose we've got nothin' for +breakfast?" + +He raised himself slowly, and gazed at Elspie with a disconsolate +expression. + +"Nothing," returned the girl with a look of profound woe. + +It is said that when things are at the worst they are sure to mend. It +may be so: the sayings of man are sometimes true. Whether or not the +circumstances of Elspie and old McKay were at the worst is an open +question; but there can be no doubt that they began to mend just about +that time, for the girl had not quite got rid of her disconsolate +feelings when the faint but merry tinkle of sleigh-bells was heard in +the frosty air. + +The startled look of sudden surprise and profound attention is +interesting to behold, whether in old or young. It is a condition of +being that utterly blots out self for a brief moment in the person +affected, and allows the mind and frame for once to have free +unconscious play. + +Elspie said, "Sh!--" and gazed aside with wide and lustrous eyes, head a +little on one side, a hand and forefinger slightly raised, as if to +enforce silence, and her graceful figure bent forward--a petrifaction of +intensely attentive loveliness. + +Old McKay said "Ho!" and, with both hands resting on the ground to prop +him up, eyes and mouth wide open, and breath restrained, presented the +very personification of petrified stupidity. + +Another moment, and the sound became too distinct to admit of a doubt. + +"Here they are at long last!" exclaimed the old man, rising with +unwonted alacrity for his years. + +"Thank God!" ejaculated Elspie, springing up and drawing a shawl round +her shoulders, at the same time making some hasty and futile attempts to +reduce the confusion of her hair. + +It need scarcely be said that this was the arrival of the rescue-party +of which Daniel Davidson was in command. Before the starving pair had +time to get fairly on their legs, Daniel strode into the camp and seized +Elspie in his arms. + +We need not repeat what he said, for it was not meant to be made public, +but no such reticence need trouble us in regard to old Duncan. + +"Hoot! Taniel," said he, somewhat peevishly, "keep your coortin' till +efter breakfast, man! It iss a wolf that will be livin' inside o' me +for the last few tays--a hungry wolf too--an' nothin' for him to eat. +That's right, Okematan, on wi' the kettle; it iss yourself that knows +what it iss to starve. Blow up the fire, Peter Tavidson. You're a +cliver boy for your age, an' hes goot lungs, I make no doubt." + +"That I have, Mr McKay, else I should not be here," said the lad, +laughing, as he knelt before the embers of the fire, and blew them into +a blaze. + +"Wow! Dan, hev ye not a pit pemmican handy?" asked McKay. "It iss +little I care for cookin' just now." + +"Here you are," said Dan, taking a lump of the desired article from his +wallet and handing it to the impatient man; at the same time giving a +morsel to Elspie. "I knew you would want it in a hurry, and kept it +handy. Where is Duncan? I thought he was with you." + +"So he wass, Taniel, when you left us to go to Rud Ruver, but my son +Tuncan was never fond o' stickin' to his father. He left us, an' no wan +knows where he iss now. Starvin', maybe, like the rest of us." + +"I hope not," said Elspie, while her sire continued his breakfast with +manifest satisfaction. "He went off to search for buffalo with Perrin +and several others. They said they would return to us if they found +anything. But, as they have not come back, we suppose they must have +been unsuccessful. Did you meet any of the poor people on the way out, +Dan?" + +"Ay, we met some of them," replied the hunter, in a sad tone. "All +struggling to make their way back to the Settlement, and all more or +less starving. We helped them what we could, but some were past help; +and we came upon two or three that had fallen in their tracks and died +in the snow. But we have roused the Settlement, and there are many +rescue-parties out in all directions now, scouring the plains." + +"You hev stirred it enough, Okematan," said old McKay, referring to the +kettle of food which was being prepared. "Here, fill my pannikin: I can +wait no longer." + +"Whenever you have finished breakfast we must start off home," said +Davidson, helping Elspie to some of the much-needed and not yet warmed +soup, which was quickly made by mixing pemmican with flour and water. +"I have brought two sleds, so that you and your father may ride, and we +will carry the provisions. We never know when the gale may break out +again." + +"Or when heavy snow may come on," added Peter, who was by that time busy +with his own breakfast. + +Okematan occupied himself in stirring the contents of the large kettle, +and occasionally devouring a mouthful of pemmican uncooked. + +An hour later, and they were making for home almost as fast as the +rescue-party had travelled out--the provisions transferred to the strong +backs of their rescuers--old McKay and Elspie carefully wrapped up in +furs, reposing on the two sledges. + + + +CHAPTER SIX. + +DISCORD AND DECEIT, ETCETERA. + +It was found, on their arrival at the home of Duncan McKay senior, that +Duncan junior had got there before them, he having been met and brought +in by one of the settlers who had gone out with his cariole to do what +he could for the hunters. The two women who discovered the body of +Perrin, however, had not yet arrived, and nothing was known of the +murder in the Settlement. + +"It iss little troubled _you_ wass, what came over us," remarked old +Duncan angrily, on entering his house, and finding his younger son +engaged with a pipe beside the kitchen fire. + +"An' how could _I_ know where you wass; efter I had been huntin' for +nothin' for two days?" retorted his son. "Wass I to think you would be +stoppin' in the lame camp till you died? Wass it not more likely that +some wan would find you an' bring you in--as they did?" + +"No thanks to you that they did, Tuncan, what_ever_. Where did you +leave the other boys?" + +"How should I know?" returned the son sharply; "they dropped off--wan +here an' wan there--sayin' they would try for a buffalo in wan place or +another, or, that they would rest awhile; an' so I wass left by myself. +I found it quite enough to look efter number wan." + +"It hes _always_ been as much, that, as ye could manitch, Tuncan, even +when things wass goin' easy," said the old man with a sarcastic laugh, +that induced the young man to rise and quit the room. + +He went towards a small shop, or store, as such places were styled in +the Nor'-West. It fell to his lot in the family arrangements to look +after and manage this store. Indeed the youth's anxiety for the ease +and comfort of "number wan" had induced him to select the post as being +a part of the family duties that was peculiarly suited to himself. + +On reaching the store he went straight to a large roll of Canadian twist +tobacco, cut off a piece, refilled his pipe, and, sitting down on a bale +began or, rather, continued to smoke. He had not been seated long when +the door opened, and the head of a half-breed peeped cautiously in with +an uncommonly sly look. + +"That you, Francois La Certe?" said McKay rather sternly, for he knew +the man well. "What iss it you will be wantin' now?" + +Francois wanted many things--things almost too numerous to mention; but, +first, he would pay his debts to Cloudbrow. + +"Come, that's something new," said McKay with a cynical laugh. "You +must have come by a fortune, or committed a robbery before ye would be +so honest. How much are you goin' to pay?" + +"The sledge that you lent me, I have brought back," said the half-breed +with a deprecatory air. + +"So, you call returning a loan paying your debts?" said Duncan. + +La Certe did not quite say that, but he thought it bore some resemblance +to a payment to account, and at all events was proof of his good +intentions. + +"And on the strength of that you'll want plenty more credit, I hev no +doubt." + +"No--not plenty," said La Certe, with the earnest air of a man who is +exposing his whole soul to inspection, and who means to act this time +with the strictest sincerity, to say nothing of honesty. "It is only a +little that I want. Not much. Just enough to keep body and soul from +sayin' good-bye." + +"But you have not paid a fraction of your old debt. How will you be +expectin' to meet the new one?" + +Oh! La Certe could easily explain that. He was going off immediately +to hunt and trap, and would soon return with a heavy load, for there +were plenty of animals about. Then in the spring, which was near at +hand, he meant to fish, or go to the plains with the hunters, and return +laden with bags of pemmican, bales of dried meat, and buffalo-robes +enough to pay off all his debts, and leave something over to enable him +to spend the winter in luxurious idleness. + +"And you expect me to believe all that nonsense?" said McKay, sternly. + +La Certe was hurt. Of course he expected to be believed! His feelings +were injured, but he was of a forgiving disposition and would say no +more about it. He had expected better treatment, however, from one who +had known him so long. + +"A trip to the plains requires more than powder and shot," said the +store-keeper; "where will you be goin' to get a horse an' cart? for you +can hev mine no longer." + +"Dechamp, he promise to sole me a horse, an' Mrs Davis'n will loan me a +cart," returned the half-breed, with lofty independence. + +"Hm! an' you will be returnin' the cart an' payin' for the horse when +the hunt is over, I suppose?" + +Yes, that was exactly the idea that was in La Certe's brain, and which, +he hoped and fully expected, to reduce to practice in course of time--if +Duncan McKay would only assist him by making him a few advances at that +present time. + +"Well, what do you want?" asked McKay, getting off the bath. + +The half-breed wanted a good many things. As he was going off in the +course of a few days, and might not be able to return for a long time, +he might as well take with him even a few things that he did not +absolutely need at the moment. Of course he wanted a good supply of +powder, shot, and ball. Without that little or nothing could be done. +Then a new axe, as his old one was much worn--the steel almost gone--and +it was well-known that a trapper without an axe was a very helpless +creature. A tin kettle was, of course, an absolute necessity; and the +only one he possessed had a small hole in it. A few awls to enable him +to mend his bark canoe when open water came, and a couple of steel +traps, some gun-flints, and, O yes, he had almost forgotten a most +essential thing--twine to make a net, and some fish-hooks. + +"It iss a regular outfit you will be wanting," remarked the +store-keeper, as he handed over the various articles. + +O no--not a regular one--only a very little one, considering the length +of time he should be away, and the wealth with which he would return. +But again he suddenly remembered that he had forgotten something else. + +"Well, what iss it?" + +Some glover's needles and sinews for making leather coats and moccasins. +Needles and thread and scissors, for it was quite clear that people +could not live without suitable clothing. A new capote, also, and-- +and--a yard or two of scarlet cloth with a few beads. + +As he made the last request, La Certe attempted to speak insinuatingly, +and to look humble. + +"Come, that iss pure extravagance," said McKay, remonstrating. + +La Certe could not, dare not, face his wife without these articles. He +pleaded earnestly. "Slowfoot is so clever wi' the needle," he said. +"See! she send you a pair of moccasins." + +The wily man here drew from the breast of his capote a pair of +beautifully made moccasins, soft as chamois leather, and richly +ornamented with dyed quills of the porcupine. + +McKay laughed; nevertheless he swallowed the bait and was pleased. He +finally handed the goods to La Certe, who, when he had obtained all that +he could possibly squeeze out of the store-keeper, bundled up the whole, +made many solemn protestations of gratitude and honest intentions, and +went off to cheer Slowfoot with the news of his success. + +It chanced that Antoine Dechamp, the very man about whom he had been +talking to Duncan McKay, had dropped in to see him and his spouse, and +was sitting beside the fire smoking when he entered. Displaying his +possessions with much pride, he assured Dechamp that he had paid for the +whole outfit, and meant to return in the spring a rich man with means +enough to buy a horse and cart, and start with the buffalo-hunters for +the plains. + +"You have a horse to sell--they say?" he remarked to his friend in a +careless way. + +"Yes--and a good one too," answered Dechamp. + +"Well, if you will loan him to me in the spring, I will pay for him when +I come back. It takes all I have to fit me out to start, you see." + +Dechamp did not quite see his way to that--but there was plenty of time +to think over it! + +"Have you heard," said Dechamp, willing to change the subject, "there is +some talk that Perrin has been killed? George McDermid was out, like +many others, huntin' about for the starvin' people, an' he came across +the wives of Blanc and Pierre--poor things! they're widows now, for +Blanc and Pierre are both dead. Well, the women had well-nigh given in. +I had dropped down, they were so tired, and were crawlin' on their +hands and knees when McDermid found them. I didn't hear all the outs +and ins of it, but there is no doubt that poor Perrin has been murdered, +for he was shot right through the breast." + +"Perhaps he shot hisself," suggested La Certe. + +"No--that could not be, for the women have brought his coat, which shows +that the ball went in at the breast and came _straight_ out at the back. +If he had shot himself he must have pulled the trigger with his toe, +an' then the ball would have slanted up from his breast to somewhere +about his shoulders." + +"It was a Saulteaux, may be," said Slowfoot, who had been listening with +all the eagerness of a gossip. + +"There were no marks of Redskins' snow-shoes about," returned Dechamp, +"an' the tracks were too confused to make them out. A knife was found, +but there were no marks about it to tell who owned it--only it was a +settler's knife, but there are lots of them about, an' many have changed +hands since the settlers came." + +At the time we write of, the colony of Red River of the north was in a +very unhappy and disorganised condition. There were laws indeed, but +there was no authority or force sufficiently strong to apply the laws, +and discord reigned because of the two great fur companies--the Hudson's +Bay, and the Nor'-West--which opposed each other with extreme +bitterness, carrying fire-water, dissension, and disaster all over the +wilderness of Rupert's Land. Happily the two companies coalesced in the +year 1821, and from that date, onward, comparative peace has reigned +under the mild sway of the Hudson's Bay Company. + +But at the period which we describe the coalition had not taken place, +and many of the functionaries of the Hudson's Bay Company in Red River, +from the Governor downward, seem to have been entirely demoralised, if +we are to believe the reports of contemporary historians. + +Some time previous to this, the Earl of Selkirk--chiefly from +philanthropic views, it is said--resolved to send a colony to Red River. +At different times bands of Scotch, Swiss, Danes, and others, made +their appearance in the Settlement. They had been sent out by the +agents of the Earl, but there was a great deal of mismanagement and +misunderstanding, both as to the motives and intentions of the Earl. +The result was that the half-breeds of Red River--influenced, it is +said, by the Nor'-West Company--received the newcomers with suspicion +and ill-will. The Indians followed the lead of the half-breeds, to whom +they were allied. Not only was every sort of obstruction thrown in the +way of the unfortunate immigrants, but more than once during those first +years they were driven from the colony, and their homesteads were burned +to the ground. + +There must have been more than the usual spirit of indomitable +resolution in those people, however, for notwithstanding all the +opposition and hardship they had to endure, they returned again and +again to their farms, rebuilt their dwellings, cultivated their fields, +and, so to speak, compelled prosperity to smile on them--and that, too, +although several times the powers of Nature, in the shape of grass +hoppers and disastrous floods, seemed to league with men in seeking +their destruction. + +Perhaps the Scottish element among the immigrants had much to do with +this resolute perseverance. Possibly the religious element in the +Scotch had more to do with it still. + +The disastrous winter which we have slightly sketched was one of the +many troubles with which not only the newcomers, but all parties in the +colony, were at this time afflicted. + + + +CHAPTER SEVEN. + +VIXEN DELIVERED AND WOLVES DEFEATED. + +With much labour and skill had the Davidsons and McKays erected two +timber cottages side by side in the land of their adoption. + +These two families were among the first band of settlers. They were +very different in character--one being Highland, the other Lowland +Scotch, but they were more or less united by sympathy, intermarriage, +and long residence beside each other on the slopes of the Grampian +Hills, so that, on the voyage out, they made a compact that they should +stick by each other, and strive, and work, and fight the battle of life +together in the new land. + +All the members of the Davidson family were sterling, sedate, hearty, +and thorough-going. Daniel and Peter were what men style "dependable" +fellows, and bore strong resemblance to their father, who died almost +immediately after their arrival in the new country. Little Jessie was +like her mother, a sort of bottomless well of sympathy, into which +oceans of joy or sorrow might be poured without causing an overflow-- +except, perchance, at the eyelids--and out of which the waters of +consolation might be pumped for evermore without pumping dry. The idea +of self never suggested itself in the presence of these two. The +consequence was that everybody adored them. It was rather a selfish +adoration, we fear, nevertheless it was extremely delightful--to the +adorers, we mean--and doubtless not unpleasant to the adored. + +The love of God, in Christ, was the foundation of their characters. + +Of the McKay family we cannot speak so confidently. Elspie, indeed, was +all that could be desired, and Fergus was in all respects a sterling +man; but the head of the family was, as we have seen, open to +improvement in many respects, and Duncan junior was of that +heart-breaking character which is known as ne'er-do-weel. Possibly, if +differently treated by his father, he might have been a better man. As +it was, he was unprincipled and hasty of temper. + +Little wonder that, when thrown together during a long voyage--to an +almost unknown land--Elspie McKay and Daniel Davidson should fall into +that condition which is common to all mankind, and less wonder that, +being a daring youth with a resolute will, Daniel should manage to +induce the pliant, loving Elspie, to plight her troth while they were +gazing over the ship's side at the first iceberg they met. We may as +well hark back here a little, and very briefly sketch the incident. It +may serve as a guide to others. + +The two were standing--according to the report of the bo's'n, who +witnessed the whole affair--"abaft the main shrouds squintin' over the +weather gangway." We are not quite sure of the exact words used by that +discreditable bo's'n, but these are something like them. It was +moon-light and dead calm; therefore propitious, so far, to Daniel's +design--for Daniel undoubtedly had a design that night, obvious to his +own mind, and clearly defined like the great iceberg, though, like it +too, somewhat hazy in detail. + +"What a glorious, magnificent object!" exclaimed Elspie, gazing in +wonder at the berg, the pinnacles of which rose considerably above the +mast-head. + +"Yes, very glorious, very magnificent!" said Daniel, gazing into the +maiden's eyes, and utterly regardless of the berg. + +"I wonder how such a huge mass ever manages to melt," said Elspie--for +the human mind, even in pretty girls, is discursive. + +"_I_ wonder it does not melt at once," said Dan, with pointed emphasis. + +"What do you mean?" she asked, turning her eyes in considerable +astonishment from the berg to the man. + +"I mean," said he, "that under the influence of your eyes the iceberg +ought to melt straight away. They have melted my heart, Elspie, and +_That_ has been an iceberg, I find, till now." + +He seized her hand. It had all come on so suddenly that poor Elspie was +quite unprepared for it. She turned as if to fly, but Daniel put his +arm round her waist and detained her. + +"Elspie, dearest Elspie, it _must_ be settled now--or--." He would +not--could not--say "never." + +"O Daniel, don't!" entreated Elspie. + +But Daniel _did_. + +"Bray-vo!" exclaimed the bo's'n with enthusiasm, for he was a +sympathetic man, though unprincipled in the matter of eavesdropping. + +That cut it short. They retired precipitately from the weather gangway +abaft the main shrouds, and sought refuge in a sequestered nook near the +companion-hatch, which was, in name as well as in every other way, much +more suited to their circumstances. The steersman had his eye on them +there, but they fortunately did not know it. + +Apologising for this reminiscence, we return to the thread of our story. + +Mrs Davidson was seated at breakfast one morning, with all her family +around her in Prairie Cottage. She had named it thus because, from one +of the windows, there was to be had a peep of the prairies lying beyond +the bushes by which it was surrounded. + +Old McKay had named his cottage Ben Nevis, either because the country +around was as flat as a pancake, or out of sheer contradictiousness. + +"Have they found out anything more about the murder of that poor fellow +Perrin?" asked Mrs Davidson. "More than four months have passed since +it happened." + +"Nothing more, mother," said Dan, who now filled his father's chair. +"As you say, four months have passed, and one would think that was time +enough to discover the murderer, but, you see, it is nobody's business +in particular, and we've no regular police, and everybody is far too +busy just now to think about it. In fact, not many people in these +parts care much about a murder, I fear." + +"Ah if they went to see Perrin's old mother," said Jessie, "it would +oblige them to care a great deal, for he was her only son." + +"Ay, her only child!" added Mrs Davidson. + +While she was yet speaking, it so happened that Duncan McKay junior +himself entered the room, with that over-done free-and-easiness which +sometimes characterises a man who is ill at ease. + +"Whose only child are you speaking about, Mrs Davidson?" he asked +carelessly. + +"Mrs Perrin's," she replied, with a familiar nod to the visitor, who +often dropped in on them casually in this way. + +The reply was so unexpected and sudden, that McKay could not avoid a +slight start and a peculiar expression, in spite of his usual +self-command. He glanced quickly at Dan and Peter, but they were busy +with their food, and had apparently not noticed the guilty signs. + +"Ah, poor thing," returned the youth, in his cynical and somewhat nasal +tone, "it _iss_ hard on her. By the way, Dan, hev ye heard that the +wolves hev killed two or three of McDermid's horses that had strayed out +on the plains, and Elspie's mare Vixen iss out too. Some of us will be +going to seek for her. The day bein' warm an' the snow soft, we hev a +good chance of killin' some o' the wolves. I thought Peter might like +to go too." + +"So Peter does," said the youth, rising and brushing the crumbs off his +knees: "there's nothing I like better than to hunt down these sneaking, +murderous brutes that are so ready to spring suddenly unawares on friend +or foe." + +Again Duncan McKay cast a quick inquiring glance at Peter, but the lad +was evidently innocent of any double meaning. It was only a movement, +within the man-slayer, of that conscience which "makes cowards of us +all." + +"Louise!" shouted Dan, as he also rose from the table. + +"Oui, monsieur," came, in polite deferential tones, from the culinary +department, and the little half-breed maiden appeared at the door. + +"Did you mend that shot-bag last night?" + +"Oui, monsieur." + +"Fetch it here, then, please; and, Jessie, stir your stumps like a good +girl, and get some food ready to take with us." + +"Will you tell me the precise way in which good girls stir their +stumps?" asked Jessie; "for I'm not quite sure." + +Dan answered with a laugh, and went out to saddle his horse, followed by +his brother and Duncan McKay. + +"Rescuing seems to be the order of the day this year," remarked Peter, +as they walked towards the stable behind the cottage. "We've had a good +deal of rescuing men in the winter, and now we are goin' to rescue +horses." + +"Rescuing is the grandest work that a fellow can undertake," said Dan, +"whether it be the body from death or the soul from sin." + +"What you say iss true--whatever," remarked McKay, whose speech, +although not so broad as that of his father, was tinged with similar +characteristics. "It will be better to rescue than to kill." + +This was so obvious a truism that his companions laughed, but Duncan had +uttered it almost as a soliloquy, for he was thinking at the moment of +poor Perrin, whose body had long since been brought to the Settlement +and buried. Indeed thoughts of the murdered man were seldom out of his +mind. + +Meanwhile, far out on the lonesome and still snow-covered prairie the +steed which they were going to rescue stood on a low mound or undulation +of the plain surrounded by wolves. It was a pitiful sight to see the +noble mare, almost worn-out with watching and defending herself, while +the pack of those sneaking hounds of the wilderness sat or stood around +her licking their chops and patiently biding their time. + +They formed a lean, gaunt, savage-looking crew, as they sat there, +calculating, apparently, how long their victim's strength would hold +out, and when it would be safe to make a united and cowardly rush. + +One wolf, more gaunt and rugged and grey than the others, with black +lips and red tongue and bloodshot eyes, moved about the circle uneasily +as if trying to screw up its craven spirit to the sticking point. The +others evidently regarded this one as their leader, for they hung back +from him a little, and kept a watchful eye on his movements. So did +Vixen, the mare. She kept her tail always turned towards him, looking +savagely back at him with her great eyes glittering, her ears laid flat, +and her heels ready. + +Poor Vixen! Elspie had given her the name when in a facetious frame of +mind, as being descriptive of the very opposite of her character, for +she was gentle as a lamb, tender in the mouth, playful in her moods, and +sensitive to a degree both in body and spirit. No curb was ever needed +to restrain Vixen, nor spur to urge her on. A chirp sent an electric +thrill through her handsome frame; a "Quiet, Vic!" sufficed to calm her +to absolute docility. Any child could have reined her in, and she went +with springy elasticity as though her limbs were made of vivified steel +and indiarubber. But she was getting old, and somehow the wolves seemed +to be aware of that melancholy fact. They would not have troubled her +in the heyday of her youth! + +An impatient howl from one of the pack seemed to insinuate that the grey +old leader was a coward. So he was, but evidently he did not relish +being told so, for he uncovered his glittering fangs and made a sudden +dash at the mare. + +With a whisk of the tail worthy of her best days, she lashed out behind +and planted both her pretty little feet on the ribs of the grey chief +with such a portentous whack that he succumbed at once. With a gasp, +and a long-drawn wail, he sank dead upon the snow; whereupon his amiable +friends--when quite sure of his demise--tore him limb from limb and +devoured him. + +This was a fortunate respite for Vixen, most of whose remaining strength +and pluck had been thrown into that magnificent fling. Old Duncan, had +he seen it, would probably have styled it a "goot Highland fling." + +But the respite was not of long duration. Their leader formed but a +mouthful to each of the pack. + +When done, they returned to encircle their victim again, lick their +chops, and wait. + +Evening was drawing on, and a sort of grey desolation seemed to be +creeping over the plains. + +A decided thaw had been operating all that day, rendering the snow soft. +If the mare had only known the advantage thus given to her, a +successful effort at escape might have been made. When snow on the +prairie is frozen with a hard crust on the surface, the light wolf can +run easily on the top of it, while the heavy horse breaks through at +every stride and is soon knocked up. The case is reversed when a thaw +softens the surface, for then the short-legged wolf flounders helplessly +in its depths, while the long-limbed and powerful horse can gallop +through it with comparative ease. But the good mare, intelligent though +she was, did not consider this fact, and the wolves, you may be sure, +did not enlighten her. Besides, by that time she was well-nigh +worn-out, and could not have made a vigorous run for life even over a +good course. + +Gradually, a worthy lieutenant of the old grey chief began to show +symptoms of impatience, and the hungry circle closed in. Vixen looked +up and whinnied slightly. It seemed a pitiful appeal for help from the +human friends who had cared for her so well and so long. Perchance it +was the last wail of despair--a final farewell to the green fields and +the flowering plains of memory. + +Whatever it was, an answer came in the form of several dark specks on +the horizon. Vixen saw them, and whinnied again in a decidedly +different tone. The wolves also saw them, and moved about uneasily. + +On came the black specks, increasing in size as they drew near. The +wolves looked at each other inquiringly, moved still more uneasily, +appeared to hold a consultation, and finally drew off to a neighbouring +knoll, as if to await the result of this unlooked-for interruption, and +return to business when it was past. + +The intelligence of the lower animals is great--in some cases very +great--but it does not amount to reason. If it did, those wolves would +not have sat there, in the pride of physical strength and personal +freedom, calmly awaiting their doom, while Daniel and Peter Davidson, +Duncan McKay junior, Okematan the Cree Indian, another Indian named +Kateegoose, and Jacques Bourassin, a half-breed, came thundering down +towards them like infuriated centaurs. + +At last they seemed to realise the truth that "discretion is the better +part of valour," and began to retire from the scene--slowly at first. + +Vixen, recognising friends, trotted off with reviving strength, and a +high head and tail to meet them. Seeing this, Dan, who led the party, +drew rein so as to allow the steeds to recover breath before the final +burst. + +The wolves, with that presumption which is usually found to be the +handmaid of ignorance, halted, and sat down again to watch the progress +of events. Fatal self-confidence! They little knew the deep duplicity +of man! + +"O you stupid brutes!" murmured Dan to himself, advancing in a somewhat +sidling manner as if he meant to pass them. They evidently believed +this to be his intention until they saw the six horsemen turn their +steeds straight in their direction and charge them at full gallop with a +yell that drove rapid conviction to their brains. + +Then, with tails between legs and ears flat they fled. But it was too +late. The horses scattered the soft snow with comparative ease. The +wolves plunged through it with difficulty. First to overtake them was +Peter Davidson. He put the muzzle of his gun to the side of the grey +lieutenant, and shot him through the heart. His brother Dan, selecting +another of the pack, pointed at the ear and blew out its brains. +Okematan, partial to the weapons of his forefathers, sent an arrow +through the ribs of a third, while Kateegoose transfixed a fourth. +Duncan McKay shot a fifth, and Bourassin knocked over a sixth at +comparatively long range, his horse being too poor or too tired to come +fairly up with the pack. + +There was no wasting of powder, shot, or shaft in this affair. Each man +was an expert with his weapon, and cool as the proverbial cucumber, +though considerably excited. Loading as they ran, they fitted and shot +again, stretching six more of the enemy on the plain. Then they pulled +up and suffered the rest to escape, being afraid to leave Vixen out of +sight behind them, for that happy creature, following and enjoying the +sport as long as she could, found that her powers were too much +exhausted to permit of her keeping up with the chase. + +"She's not fit to travel another mile," said Dan, stroking her glossy +neck and allowing her to rub her nose affectionately on his shoulder. + +"That iss true, whatever," assented Duncan. "I think we could not do +better than camp on the nearest bluff." + +This was agreed to by all. Provision for one meal, it will be +remembered, had been prepared at Prairie Cottage in the morning. A +hunter's meal, when properly divided, makes two or three average meals, +and a hunter's powers of endurance are proverbial. Each man had his +blanket strapped to his saddle. Branches of various kinds of trees make +a good mattress, and the air of the prairie is well-known to conduce to +appetite and slumber. + +With such environment it is scarcely necessary to add that the hunters +enjoyed themselves, and that Vixen had a restful night, probably without +even a dream about hungry wolves. + + + +CHAPTER EIGHT. + +STIRRING EVENTS DESCRIBED. + +The proverbial slip 'twixt the cup and the lip, and the well-known +uncertainty of all human affairs, received striking illustration in the +person and prospects of our hero, Daniel Davidson, not long after the +events narrated in the last chapter. + +Up to this period the unfortunate colonists of the Red River Settlement +had led a life chiefly of disappointment and disaster. Although +everything had been done for them by their patron the Earl of Selkirk +with the best intentions, the carrying out of his plans had been +frustrated by the feuds of the rival fur companies, the +misunderstandings and the jealousies of Indians and half-breeds, and, to +some extent, by the severity of the climate. An open rupture took place +between them and the North-westers. Encounters between the contending +parties occurred, in which several on both sides were killed, and at +last the North-Westers, attacking the settlers in force, drove them from +the colony and burnt their dwellings and homesteads. + +Retreating to the north end of Lake Winnipeg, the colonists found refuge +at Jack River--three hundred miles distant. From this place they were +ultimately recalled by the Hudson's Bay Company, which took them under +its protection. Returning to Red River, the unfortunate but persevering +people proceeded to resume their farming operations. But the prospect +before them was gloomy enough. The lawless proceedings of the rival +companies had convulsed the whole Indian country, and the evil seemed to +culminate in the Red River Colony, to which retired servants of the +fur-traders, voyageurs, adventurers, and idlers gravitated as to a +centre; so that there was little prospect of their being allowed to +prosecute their agricultural operations in peace. + +The dissensions at last became so great that a large proportion of the +new settlers, including many of the Scotch Highlanders, dispersed to +seek a precarious livelihood among the Indians, on the prairies +bordering the waters of the Missouri, or to sustain themselves and their +families by fishing in the distant lakes, and hunting on their shores. + +On the advent of spring, however, most of these returned to the colony, +with renewed hope in agriculture, and set to work--every man, woman, and +child--to get some seed into the ground. + +But at this point an event occurred which threw the colony into great +consternation, and induced vigorous action on the part of Lord Selkirk, +which was the first step towards more peaceful times. + +The North-West party, consisting chiefly of half-breeds, had augmented +to upwards of three hundred warriors. It would be more correct, +perhaps, to style them banditti; for they had penetrated through every +part of Rupert's Land, set law at defiance, pillaged and destroyed many +of the establishments of their rivals, and kept the whole country in a +state of ferment and alarm. + +One band of these men, numbering between sixty and seventy, advanced +upon Red River Colony. They were a motley crew, all mounted on +horseback and armed with guns, spears, tomahawks, bows, and +scalping-knives, besides which they were painted and plumed _a la +sauvage_, and were in the habit when rushing to battle, of yelling like +the Red-men whose blood mingled with that of the White-man in their +veins. + +What was the precise intention of these men at this time it is difficult +to say, but it was not difficult to see that peace was not their object. + +Governor Semple, of the Hudson's Bay Company, a mild, just, and much +respected man, was in charge of the colony at the time. + +Daniel Davidson was engaged in a very important conversation with old +Duncan McKay at the time the formidable troop of North-Westers swept +through the settlements. The old man was seated in the hall, parlour, +drawing-room--or whatever you choose to call it--of Ben Nevis House. It +was an uncarpeted, unpainted, unadorned room with pine plank flooring, +plank walls, a plank ceiling, a plank table, and a set of plank chairs. +Ornament was dispensed with in the hall of Ben Nevis House; for although +Elspie would fain have clothed it with a little feminine grace, its +proprietor would not hear of such proposals. + +"Stick as many gimcracks as you like about your own room, Elspie," he +had remarked when the first attempt was made, "but leave me my hall in +peace. It iss quite pleased with it I am as it iss." + +Opposite the door of the hall there was a large open fireplace without a +grate. Doors all round the walls of the hall opened into the other +rooms of the establishment. Above what would have been the mantelpiece, +had one existed, there was a row of tobacco pipes. Old Duncan was a +great smoker. Indeed he would have been almost unrecognisable without +his pipe. He was smoking when Daniel Davidson visited him, in order to +hold the very important conversation to which we have referred. + +"It iss as you say, Taniel," remarked the old man, frowning at his pipe, +which was not drawing properly. "Marrit life iss more to be desired +than single blessedness, whatever, an' it is a my opeenion that you will +do more work with Elspie helpin' you, than by yourself. When iss it you +will be wantin' to call me your father?" + +The old man asked the question with a somewhat humorous smile, for he +was, to say truth, not a little proud of the staid, sensible, and strong +young fellow who aspired to his daughter's hand--besides, the pipe was +drawing well by that time. + +"As soon as you like," answered Dan, "or, rather, as soon as Elspie +likes. You see, things are beginning to look a little more hopeful now. +People who seem to know best--or seem to think they do--tell us that +the Nor'-Westers are beginning to see that a colony here won't interfere +in any way with their business; a good deal of seed has been sown, and, +if all goes well, we may look for a better year than we have yet had; +therefore I don't see why we should wait any longer." + +"Your observations are ferry true. There iss just wan little word you +mention that requires consideration," returned the old man with a brow +wrinkled so as to suggest profound sagacity of thought. "You said `if +all goes well.' But supposin', for the sake of argument, that all does +_not_ go well--what then?" + +"Why, then," answered the young man with a laugh, "we shall be no worse +off than other people, who have to make the best of things as they find +them." + +"No doubt--no doubt--that iss the true an' pheelosophical way to look at +the matter. But don't you think, Taniel, that it would be as well to +putt off till our munister arrives? I would not be havin' my daughter +marrit without a munister if I can help it. An' you know his Lordship +has promised more than wance to send us wan. He will not be long o' +coming now." + +"Yes, a minister has been promised again an' again," returned Dan, +somewhat bitterly, "an' I suppose he will go on promising again and over +again, but I have not much faith in these promises. The Earl has too +many agents who are not as true as himself. I would rather not delay my +marriage on that account. What ails you at Mr Sutherland?" + +"Well, Taniel, I hev nothing to say against Muster Sutherland. He iss a +ferry goot man--I will not be denyin' that, but--he iss not an ordained +munister." + +"What of that?" retorted Dan. "He is an ordained elder of the Church of +Scotland, and that is much the same thing. And he is a good, Christian +man, respected by every one in the Settlement." + +"Well, well, Taniel; hev it your own way," returned old Duncan with a +resigned look. "Of course, it would have been pleesanter if he had been +a regular munister, whatever; but, as you say, my boy, `what of that?' +So, as things look a little more peaceable than they wass--though not +ferry much--I will be--" + +He was interrupted at this point by the sudden entrance of Jacques +Bourassin with the astounding intelligence that a band of North-Westers +had gone up the Settlement to attack Fort Garry. + +"Hoot! nonsense, man!" exclaimed old McKay, starting up and flinging his +pipe away in the excitement of the moment. + +"No--not nonsense!" said Bourassin in broken English; "it be true. I +knows it. I come to say that we go to the fort to help them." + +"Right, boy, right!" exclaimed the old man, hastily belting on his +capote. "Fergus! Tuncan!--Elspie! where are these boys?" + +"In the stable, father. I saw them just--" + +"Let them saddle all the nags--quick," cried the old man. "Taniel, you +better--" + +He stopped; for Daniel had already run out to saddle and mount his own +horse. + +In a few minutes a cavalcade of a dozen powerful young fellows, headed +by old Duncan McKay, and armed with guns, were galloping at full speed +in the direction of Fort Garry. + +But before this cavalcade had set out, the rencontre at the fort had +already taken place, and been fatally decided. + +The approach of the enemy had been announced to those nearest the scene +of action by the women and children of that part of the Settlement, who +were seen running about in frantic alarm trying to hide themselves, and +some of them seeking refuge in the fort. + +Among these were two brothers named Sinclair. One of them, Archie by +name, was a stout healthy fellow of twelve or thereabouts, the other was +a thin delicate boy of ten, whose illness, whatever it was, had reduced +him to skin and bone, taken all the colour out of his cheeks, and +rendered him quite unable to run or play like other boys. They had +recently become orphans, their father and mother, who were among the +most recent arrivals, having died suddenly within a few weeks of each +other. When the alarm of the threatened attack was given, the brothers +were amusing themselves on the sunny side of the cottage which had been +for only one year their happy home. + +In a moment Archie took his brother on his back and scampered away with +him to a place near the river, and hid him in a hollow under the bank, +where they had been wont to play at grizzly bears and hunters. + +Meanwhile Governor Semple, with several gentlemen and attendants, walked +out to meet the party of half-breeds and Indians, not to offer battle, +but for the purpose of parlance and conciliation. It is admitted, +however, that Governor Semple committed a grave error of judgment in +allowing his small party to carry arms. They numbered only twenty-eight +in all, and, being untrained, could have had no chance in an open fight +with such opponents. If the Governor had gone out unarmed with only one +or two attendants, he would, it was thought, have appealed irresistibly +to the honour of the party. + +As it was, when the Hudson's Bay party drew near they thought the look +of their opponents so suspicious that the Governor halted his men, and +they stood in a group as if in consultation. Seeing this, the +half-breeds divided themselves into two bodies, and commenced firing +from behind some willows--at first a shot or two, and then a merciless +volley. No fewer than twenty-one of the twenty-eight fell to rise no +more, among whom were the Governor himself; Mr Wilkinson, his +secretary: Captain Rogers, a mineralogist; Mr White, the surgeon; Mr +Holt, of the Swedish navy, and Mr McLean, a principal settler. + +Indeed the whole party would have probably been killed and the settlers +massacred at that time, but for the courageous interposition of the +chief of the half-breeds, Cuthbert Grant, who, at the risk of his life, +stood between the settlers and their foes, only one of which last was +killed. + +When old McKay and his party drew near to the scene, the massacre was +completed, and most of his little band--which had been slightly +augmented on the way up--turned right-about, and rode away to defend +their respective homes. + +But the warrior spirit of old McKay and his sons had been roused. They +refused to turn tail, and, in company with Dan and Peter Davidson, made +a furious charge into a detached party of the half-breeds which they +chanced to encounter. They scattered them like sheep, though they did +not succeed in killing any. Then they also wheeled round and galloped +back to their respective homes. + +"Come, Elspie, tear," said the old man as he dismounted, "putt what ye +value most in your pocket an' come away. The duvles are down on us, and +we are not able to hold out in Ben Nevis. The settlers must choin +altogether, an' do the best we can to defend ourselves." + +While he was speaking, the Highlander was busy stuffing some of the +smaller of his household goods into his pockets--amongst them a large +quantity of tobacco. + +Meanwhile Fergus hastened to the stable to saddle Vixen for Elspie, +while the poor girl ran to her room and secured some small objects which +she valued--among them a miniature portrait of her mother, and a Bible +which the good lady had given to her a short time before her death. +There was no money, and no valuable documents had to be looked after, so +that preparations for fight were soon completed. + +Now there was a member of old Duncan McKay's household who has not yet +been introduced to the reader, but whose character and influence in the +household were such as to demand special notice. This member was an old +woman named Peg. Probably this was an abbreviation of Peggy, but we +cannot tell. Neither can we say what her surname was, for we never +heard it, and no one spoke of the old creature by any other name than +that of "Old Peg." + +Although Old Peg was by no means feeble--indeed, judged by her +capacities, she might have been pronounced middle-aged, for she could +walk about the house all day, actively engaged in miscellaneous +self-imposed duties, and could also eat like a man and sleep like a +dormouse--she was, nevertheless, withered, and wrinkled, and grey, and +small. Her exact age nobody knew--and, for the matter of that, nobody +seemed to care. + +Extreme amiability and self-obliteration were the chief characteristics +of Old Peg. She was silent by nature, and deaf as a post--whether by +art or nature we know not; probably both. Well, no--on second thoughts, +not quite as deaf as a post, for by means of severe shouting she could +be made to hear. + +Smiles and nods, however, were her chief means of communication with the +outer world. When these failed, a yell might be tried with advantage. + +No one of the McKay household ever thought of giving Old Peg anything in +the shape of work to do, for the very good reason that, being an +extremely willing horse, she was always working; and she possessed a +peculiar faculty of observation, which enabled her to perceive, long +before any one else, what ought to be done, and the right time to do it, +so that, when any one bounced round with the sudden intention of telling +her to do anything, Old Peg was found to have done it already, or to be +in the act of doing it. It is almost superfluous to say that she +patched and mended the household garments, washed the most of things +washable, sewed the sewable, darned the sock, and, generally, did-up the +whole McKay family. When not engaged in definite or specific work, she +had a chronic sock-knitting which helped to fill up and round off the +corners of her leisure hours. + +Old Peg had been the nurse, consecutively, of Fergus, Elspie, and Duncan +junior. She was now equivalent to their second mother, having nursed +their first mother to the end with faithful untiring affection, and +received from the dying woman a solemn commission never to forsake +Duncan senior or his progeny. + +No sentiment of a religious nature ever escaped Old Peg, but it was +observed that she read her Bible regularly, and was occasionally found +asleep on her knees--greatly to the amusement of that irritable old +rascal, Duncan senior, and to the gratification of Elspie, who came to +the conclusion that the old woman must have learned well off by heart +such words as--"Whatsoever thy hand findeth to do; do it with thy +might." "Do good to all men as thy hand findeth opportunity." "Be +clothed with humility." "Trust in the Lord at all times." Probably +Elspie was right, for she judged of people in the old-fashioned way, +namely, "by their fruits." Her judgment of the two Duncans on this +principle, by the way, could not have been very exalted, but we cannot +tell. She was much too loyal and loving a daughter and sister to give +any sign or opinion. + +At the time of the sudden call to flight just described, the McKay +family had totally forgotten Old Peg in their hurry. Elspie was the +first to miss her. + +"Old Peg!" she exclaimed--almost screamed--while Fergus was assisting +her to mount Vixen, "where is she?" + +"I'll find her," said Fergus, "and bring her on in the cart. You be off +after father. We've no time to lose." + +"Be _sure_ you bring her, Fergus," said Elspie. + +"All right; no fear!" + +Thus assured, Elspie was about to gallop away after her father--who had +started in advance, to overtake and stop the Prairie Cottage family, so +that they might travel in one band--when the clatter of hoofs was heard, +and next moment Dan Davidson galloped round the corner of the house. + +"I came back for you, Elspie," he said, pulling up. "Why did you not +come on with your father?" + +"I expected to overtake him, Dan. You know Vixen is swift. Besides, I +missed Old Peg, and delayed a few minutes on her account. Is she with +your party?" + +"No--at least I did not see her. But she may have been in the cart with +Louise. Shall I look for her while you gallop on?" + +"No; Fergus has promised to find and bring her after us. Come, I am +ready." + +The two galloped away. As they did so young Duncan issued from the +stable behind the house, leading out his horse. He was in no hurry, +having a good mount. At the same time Fergus came out at the back-door +of the house shouting, "Old Peg! Hallo! old woman, where are ye?" + +"Hev ye seen her, Duncan?" he asked impatiently. + +"It iss seekin' high an' low I hev been, an' it iss of no use shoutin', +for she hears nothin'." + +"I'm sure I saw her in the cart wi' the Davidsons," said Duncan. + +"Are you sure?" asked Fergus. + +"Weel, I did not pass quite close to them, as I ran up here for my horse +on hearin' the news," replied Duncan; "but I am pretty sure that I saw +her sittin' beside Louise." + +"Hm! that accoonts for her not being here," said Fergus, running into +the stable. "Hold on a bit, Duncan. I'll go with ye in a meenit." + +In the circumstances he was not long about saddling his horse. A few +minutes more, and the brothers were galloping after their friends, who +had got a considerable distance in advance of them by that time, and +they did not overtake them till a part of the Settlement was reached +where a strong muster of the settlers was taking place, and where it was +resolved to make a stand and face the foe. + +Here it was discovered, to the consternation of the McKay family, that +Old Peg was not with the Davidson party, and that therefore she must +have been left behind! + +"She _must_ be found and rescued," exclaimed Elspie, on making the +discovery. + +"She _must_!" echoed Dan Davidson: "who will go back with me?" + +A dozen stout young fellows at once rode to the front, and old McKay +offered to take command of them, but was overruled and left behind. + + + +CHAPTER NINE. + +OLD PEG. + +Meanwhile, accustomed to think and act for herself, Old Peg, on the +first alarm, had made up her mind to do her fair share of work quietly. + +She did not require to be told that danger threatened the family and +that flight had been resolved on. A shout from some one that +Nor'-Westers were coming, coupled with the hasty preparations, might +have enlightened a mind much less intelligent than that of the old +woman. She knew that she could do nothing to help where smart bodily +exercise was needed, but, down by the creek close by, there was a small +stable in which a sedate, lumbering old cart-horse dwelt. The horse, +she felt sure, would be wanted. She could not harness it, but she could +put a bridle on it and lead it up to the house. + +This animal, which was named Elephant on account of its size, had been +totally forgotten by the family in the hurry of departure. + +Old Peg found the putting of a bridle on the huge creature more +difficult work than she had expected, and only succeeded at last by dint +of perseverance, standing on three or four bundles of hay, and much +coaxing--for the creature had evidently taken it into its head that the +old woman had come there to fondle it--perhaps to feed it with sugar +after the manner of Elspie. + +She managed the thing at last, however, and led the horse up towards the +house. + +Now, while she had been thus engaged the family had left, and the +half-breeds--having combined their forces--had arrived. + +Ben Nevis was the first house the scoundrels came to. Dismounting, and +finding the place deserted, they helped themselves to whatever was +attractive and portable--especially to a large quantity of Canada twist +tobacco, which old Duncan had found it impossible to carry away. Then +they applied fire to the mansion, and, in a wonderfully short time Ben +Nevis was reduced to a level with the plain. Another party treated +Prairie Cottage in a similar manner. + +It was when the first volume of black smoke rose into the sky that Old +Peg came to the edge of the bushes that fringed the creek and discovered +that Ben Nevis had suddenly become volcanic! She instantly became fully +aware of the state of matters, and rightly judged that the family must +have escaped, else there would have been some evidence of resistance. + +Fortunately the old woman had not yet passed quite from the shelter of +the bushes. She drew back with a degree of caution worthy of a +Red-skin, leading the horse with her. When well out of sight she paused +for the purpose of meditation. What was now to be done! As we have +said, she possessed decision of character in an eminent degree. She +never at any time had taken long to make up her mind; she was not going +to begin now, though the position was probably the most perplexing that +she had ever experienced. Suddenly she raised her head and laughed. + +In the circumstances it would not have been surprising had hysteria +seized Old Peg, but there was nothing hysterical in her nature. Calm, +cool, calculating courage dominated her every thought and feeling, but +the idea of what she was driven to in her old age had tickled her fancy. +Leading the big cart-horse close up to a bank, she prepared to mount +him--having previously broken off a good strong switch from a +neighbouring bush. + +Never before in her life had Peg mounted a steed of any kind whatever. +She knew the lady's position on horseback by sight, of course, but not +by practice. To attempt it even with a side-saddle would have been +impossible; but Elephant was barebacked. Fortunately he was fat and +broad, and without a visible back-bone. Old Peg at once made up her +mind, and, climbing the bank, scrambled on his back in gentleman's +position. It was more comfortable than she had dared to hope. + +But now an unexpected difficulty met her. Elephant declined to move! +She pulled at his bridle, and he turned sluggishly, but he would not +advance. Peg administered a sounding whack with the switch. She might +as well have hit a neighbouring tree. Elephant's hide was like that of +his namesake, and he had no feelings to speak of that could be touched, +or hurt, or worked upon. + +In this dilemma the old woman had recourse to a weapon with which her +broad bosom was at all times furnished. She drew a large pin, and drove +the point into Elephant's flank. The result was instantaneous. Up went +his hindquarters, and Peg found herself sprawling on his bushy mane. +She held on to that, however, and, gradually working her way back, +regained her old position--thankful that she had not been thrown to the +ground. + +Another result was that Elephant condescended to walk. But this was not +enough. Escape at such a pace was impossible. Old Peg prodded him +again--this time on the shoulder, for she rightly conjectured that he +could not well kick up with his fore-legs. But he might rear! The +thought caused her to grasp the bushy mane with both hands and hold on. +He did not rear, but he trotted, and poor Old Peg came to the conclusion +that there were disagreeable novelties in life, even for her. + +When Elephant at length burst out of the fringe of wood and gained the +track that followed the course of the river, she was immediately seen by +the plunderers, who laughed at the strange rider but did not follow her, +with the exception of one man--an Indian, painted and feathered,--who +started in pursuit, hoping, possibly, for an easy scalp. + +He soon came close up, and, being armed with a bow, sent an arrow in +advance of him. The shaft was well aimed. It grazed the flank of +Elephant, inflicting a painful wound. This woke up the old horse +surprisingly, so that it not only broke into a gallop, but set off at +racing speed as it used to do when young. The Indian was badly mounted, +and gradually lost ground, whereupon he sent after the fugitives several +more arrows which all fell wide of the mark. + +The change to Old Peg was as a reprieve from death! The trot had almost +dislocated her bones, and shaken her up like an addled egg, and the +change to racing speed afforded infinite relief. She could scarcely +credit her senses, and she felt a tendency to laugh again as she glanced +over her shoulder. But that glance removed the tendency, for it +revealed the Indian warrior, in all his paint and feathers and streaming +scalp-locks, in hot pursuit, while the whiz of another arrow close past +her ear convinced our heroine that it was not a dream. + +The jolting to which the poor old creature was subjected had disturbed +her costume not a little. Her shawl came nearly off, and, holding on by +one pin, fluttered like a flag of defiance. Her slippers, which were of +the carpet pattern, were left behind on the prairie to perplex the +wolves, and her voluminous hair--once a rich auburn, but now a pearly +grey--having escaped its cap and fastenings, was streaming out gaily in +the breeze, as if to tempt the fingers and knife of the pursuer. + +A stern-chase is a long one, whether ashore or afloat. Pursuer and +pursued went rapidly down the Settlement until they came in sight of the +band which had come to rescue Peg. They received her with a wild cheer +of surprise and joy, which turned the Red-skin to the right-about, and +sent him back to his friends much faster than he had come. + +On receiving his report, the half-breeds at once dashed off in pursuit +of the settlers, and did not draw rein until they reached the place +where the Scotchmen had made a stand. The latter were greatly +outnumbered, at least in fighting men, but they showed such a resolute +front, that Cuthbert Grant, the half-breed leader, again interfered to +prevent bloodshed if possible. After calming his men, and advising +forbearance, he turned to Duncan McKay senior, who was the settlers' +spokesman, and said-- + +"If you will go peaceably away out of the colony, we will spare you, but +if you show fight your blood be on your own heads, for I cannot restrain +my men much longer." + +"Iss it sparin' us you will be talkin' of, Cuthbert Grant?" answered the +Highlander, with scorn. "Wow! but if it wass not for the weemen an' +children that's with us, you would hev a goot chance o' bein' in need o' +sparin' yoursels; an' it iss not much o' the blood o' the Grants, +either, that's in _your_ veins, or ye would scorn to consort wi' such +fire-raisin' cut-throats. It iss the fortune of war--whatever, and we +can't affoord to leave our weemen an' bairns defenceless. So we accept +your terms, if we are not hindered from carryin' away our arms." + +"Carry away whatever you like," replied Grant, quietly, "only be off at +once, or I'll not answer for the consequences." + +Thus the angry Highlander was dismissed, and in the end the unfortunate +settlers, being a second time driven into exile, took refuge, as before, +at Jack River. + + + +CHAPTER TEN. + +ARCHIE AND LITTLE BILL DO WONDERS. + +We change the scene now to the margin of a small lake embosomed like a +gem in the great wilderness of the Far North. + +It is autumn. The sun is bright, the air is calm and clear. There is a +species of warm haze which, paradoxically, does not seem to interfere +with the clearness, and a faint zephyr which appears rather to emphasise +than break the calm. It sends a soft cat's-paw now and then across +parts of the lake, and thus, by contrast, brings into greater prominence +the bright reflection of trees and cloudland mirrored in its depths. +Instead of being the proverbial "dead" calm, it is, if we may so put it, +rather a lively, cheerful calm. + +The liveliness of it is vastly increased by hundreds of water-fowl, +which disport themselves on the surface of the lake, as if coquetting +with their own reflections, or whistle round its margin while busy on +the feeding-grounds. + +Myriads of mosquitoes were wont there to murmur their maddening career +in search of blood, but, happily, at the period we write of, an +incidental and premonitory night-frost had relegated these to the graves +of their forefathers, or to the mansions of Hiberna--we know not, and +care not, which. + +We have styled the lake a "little" one, but we must remind the reader +that we use the expression in an American sense, and that where lakes +are two and three hundred miles long, a little one can well afford to be +twenty or thirty miles in diameter, with, perchance, a boundless +horizon. The lake in question, however, was really a little one--not +more than two miles in length or breadth, with the opposite shore quite +visible, and a number of islets of various sizes on its bosom--all more +or less wooded, and all, more rather than less, the temporary homes of +innumerable wild-fowl, among which were noisy little gulls with pure +white bodies and bright red legs and bills. + +On the morning in question--for the sun was not yet much above the +horizon--a little birch-bark canoe might have been seen to glide +noiselessly from a bed of rushes, and proceed quietly, yet swiftly, +along the outer margin of the bed. + +The bow-paddle was wielded by a stout boy with fair curly hair. Another +boy, of gentle mien and sickly aspect, sat in the stern and steered. + +"Little Bill," said the stout boy in a low voice, "you're too light. +This will never do." + +"Archie," returned the other with a languid smile, "I can't help it, you +know--at least not in a hurry. In course of time, if I eat frightfully, +I may grow heavier, but just now there's no remedy except the old one of +a stone." + +"That's true, Little Bill," responded Archie with a perplexed look, as +he glanced inquiringly along the shore; "nevertheless, if thought could +make you heavier, you'd soon be all right, for you're a powerful +thinker. The old remedy, you see, is not available, for this side of +the lake is low and swampy. I don't see a single stone anywhere." + +"Never mind, get along; we'll come to one soon, I dare say," said the +other, dipping his paddle more briskly over the side. + +The point which troubled Archie Sinclair was the difference in weight +between himself and his invalid brother, which, as he occupied the bow, +resulted in the stern of the light craft being raised much too high out +of the water. Of course this could have been remedied by their changing +places, but that would have thrown the heavier work of the bow-paddle on +the invalid, who happened also to be the better steersman of the two. A +large stone placed in the stern would have been a simple and effective +remedy, but, as we have seen, no large stone was procurable just then. + +"It didn't much matter in the clumsy wooden things at Red River," said +Archie, "but this egg-shell of Okematan's is very different. Ho! +there's one at last," he continued with animation as they rounded a +point of land, and opened up a small bay, on the margin of which there +were plenty of pebbles, and some large water-worn stones. + +One of these having been placed in the stern of the canoe, and the +balance thus rectified, the voyage was continued. + +"Don't you think that breakfast on one of these islets would be nice?" +said Billie. + +"Just the very thing that was in my mind, Little Bill," answered his +brother. + +It was a curious peculiarity in this sturdy youth, that whatever his +invalid brother wished, he immediately wished also. Similarly, when +Billie didn't desire anything, Archie did not desire it. In short +Billie's opinion was Archie's opinion, and Billie's will was Archie's +law. Not that Archie had no will or opinion of his own. On the +contrary, he was quite sufficiently gifted in that way, but his love and +profound pity for the poor and almost helpless invalid were such that in +regard to him he had sunk his own will entirely. As to opinions--well, +he did differ from him occasionally, but he did it mildly, and with an +openness to conviction which was almost enviable. He called him Bill, +Billie, or Little Bill, according to fancy at the moment. + +Poor boys! The sudden death of both parents had been a terrible blow to +them, and had intensified the tenderness with which the elder had +constituted himself the guardian of the younger. + +When the Scotch settlers were banished from the colony, pity, as well as +friendship for their deceased parents, induced the Davidson family to +adopt the boys, and now, in exile, they were out hunting by themselves +to aid in replenishing the general store of provisions. + +It need scarcely be said that at this period of the year the exiled +colonists were not subjected to severe hardships, for the air was alive +with wild-fowl returning south from their breeding-grounds, and the +rivers and lakes were swarming with fish, many of them of excellent +quality. + +"This will do--won't it?" said Archie, pointing with his paddle to an +islet about a hundred yards in diameter. + +"Yes, famously," responded Little Bill, as he steered towards a shelving +rock which formed a convenient landing-place. + +The trees and shrubs covered the islet to the water's edge with dense +foliage, that glowed with all the gorgeous colouring for which North +American woods in autumn are celebrated. An open grassy space just +beyond the landing-place seemed to have been formed by nature for the +express purpose of accommodating picnic parties. + +"Nothing could have been better," said Archie, drawing up the bow of the +canoe, and stooping to lift his brother out. + +"I think I'll try to walk--it's such a short bit," said Billie. + +"D'ye think so? well, I've no doubt you can do it, Little Bill, for +you've got a brave spirit of your own, but there's a wet bit o' moss +you'll have to cross which you mayn't have noticed. Would you like to +be lifted over that, and so keep your moccasins dry?" + +"Archie, you're a humbug. You're always trying to make me give you +needless trouble." + +"Well, have it your own way, Little Bill. I'll help you to walk up." + +"No, carry me," said Billie, stretching out his arms; "I've changed my +mind." + +"I will, if you prefer it, Little Bill," said Archie, lifting his +brother in his strong arms and setting him down on the convenient spot +before referred to. + +Billie was not altogether helpless. He could stand on his weak legs and +even walk a little without support, but to tramp through the woods, or +clamber up a hill, was to him an absolute impossibility. He had to +content himself with enjoyments of a milder type. And, to do him +justice, he seemed to have no difficulty in doing so. Perhaps he owed +it to his mother, who had been a singularly contented woman and had +taught Billie from his earliest years the truth that, "contentment, with +godliness, is great gain." Billie did not announce his belief in this +truth, but he proclaimed it unwittingly by the more powerful force of +example. + +Breakfast is a pleasant meal at any time if the operator be hungry, but +who shall describe the delights of breakfast when eaten in company with +several thousand wild-fowl, in a romantic wilderness with fresh air +laden with the perfumes of the vegetable kingdom encircling the person; +the glorious sunshine dazzling the eyes; the sweet songs of animated +nature thrilling the ears, and the gentle solicitations of an expectant +appetite craving within? Words are wasted in such an effort. We feel +constrained to leave it--as we have not seldom left many a thing before +now--to the reader's more or less vivid imagination. + +A blazing fire of pine-logs boiled two tin kettles and roasted two fat +wild-ducks. In one of the kettles Archie compounded and stirred +robbiboo--of which, perhaps, the less said the better. In the other, +Billie infused a small quantity of tea. The roasting ducks--split open, +impaled on sticks and set up before the fire--looked after themselves +till they began to burn, when they were turned by Archie and again +neglected for a few minutes. + +It was a glorious meal in all respects, and even Billie, whose appetite +was moderately strong, enjoyed it immensely--none the less that he had +asked a blessing on it before beginning, and all the more that he +sympathised fully with his brother in his possession of an amazing--a +shamelessly robust--capacity for food. + +"Now, we'll go to work," remarked Archie, wiping his mouth with a sigh +of contentment, (he had nothing else to wipe it with!) after finishing +the last spoonful of robbiboo, the last limb of duck and the last mug of +tea. + +Such a remark at such a period in the entertainment caused Billie to +laugh. + +"Why, Archie, you've been at work this half-hour, and there's nothing +left to go to work upon now." + +"You know quite well, Little Bill, that I refer to the _day's_ work. +What is it to be? Provisions must be got if the camp is not to starve, +and you and I are bound to do our share. Shall we go to Willow Point +and shoot ducks and geese, or cross the lake and trawl for fish?" + +"Both," answered the invalid with decision. "We'll do both. We will +paddle to Willow Point, and try for jack-fish on the way." + +"Just so--the very thing, Little Bill. Are you ready to start?" + +Billie professed himself quite ready. Archie took him on his back, +replaced him in the stern of the canoe in company with the big stone, +and then stepped gently into his own place at the bow, where a common +trading gun, with the old-fashioned flint lock and single barrel, rested +against the gunwale. Pushing off they soon left Breakfast-isle far +behind them, and crept swiftly along by the margin of the reeds. + +On the way Billie cast out his fishing-line. It was a strong cod-line, +with a great cod-hook attached and a lump of fat pork on it; for Archie, +in the fervour of hope coupled with piscatorial ignorance and a sanguine +disposition, had strongly advised his brother to err, if err he must, on +the safe side, and be prepared for anything, from a great lake-serpent +to a fresh-water whale. + +No civilised fish would have deigned to give a second thought to the +obvious deception which a mass of indigestible pork presented, but fish +of the backwoods--especially in the early years of this century--were +not suspicious. An enormous pike, or "jack-fish," coveted that bait and +took it. Not only so, but it took the great cod-hook and ten inches of +the line besides. + +A shout such as Billie had not uttered for many months announced the +fact. + +"Hi! hold on, Archie! Back water! I say, I'd believe I had hanked the +bottom if it didn't tug in such a lively way!" + +"Pay out line, Little Bill!" cried the other, looking over his shoulder +with blazing eyes, but unable to render any assistance owing to the +small size and crank nature of the canoe. "Stay, I'll turn about and +become steersman, while you play the--whew! It's a whale! I say--ease +off!" + +"Ease off!" cried Billie in desperation; "how can I ease off, with only +a few yards o' the line left?" + +"Pitch the reel back to me then. I'll manage it!" cried Archie, who had +converted the bow of the canoe into the stern--both ends being alike--by +the simple process of turning himself round and sitting with his face +towards his brother. + +What Archie had styled the reel was simply a piece of stick with the +line wound round it. His brother pitched it to him with one hand while +the desperate jerking of the other--indeed of his whole body--told at +once of the size and the impatience of the fish. + +Unwinding the line in haste, Archie fastened the extreme end of it to +two spare paddles and flung them overboard. + +"Now, Little Bill," he said; "you may let him have his head, and if you +can't hold on without risking the line just let it go." + +As he spoke the captive made another rush--not very frantic indeed, for +the pike is a sluggish creature in all waters--but with a steady +persistency that meant resolution of purpose. In a few seconds our +invalid was compelled to let go, and, the line tightening, the paddles +disappeared with a jerk. + +Soon after they reappeared, and the boys paddled towards them with a +cheer, picked them up and the battle was renewed. + +It would be tedious to recount all the incidents of that fight. We can +only say that after a struggle that lasted an hour--according to the +younger brother; two hours and a half, according to the elder--a pike of +about four feet in length was hauled into the canoe. + +"That's enough of fishing for one day," remarked Billie, wiping his +heated brow. + +"Quite enough," assented the other; "shall we make for Willow Point now, +Little Bill?" + +"Yes. We will try the shooting now." + +In accordance with this plan, the direction of the canoe was changed, +and, early in the afternoon, the young hunters found themselves +alongside of a low point of rocks which stretched well out into the +lake, leaving a deep bay on either side. The extreme end of the point +consisted of naked rock, but the greater part of it was covered with a +dense under-growth of low willow bushes. + +Here they disembarked, and Archie, as before, carried his brother to the +highest part of the low point, where a piece of green sward, free from +bushes, formed an attractive resting-place. + +"Sit there now, Billie, till I get some brush, an' make yourself useful +by cutting out goose heads. See, here are some branches o' the right +sort ready to hand. No doubt some Redskins have been at work here +before us." + +He picked up some pieces of wood which Nature had formed more or less to +resemble the heads and necks of geese. By a very slight use of the +knife Billie converted these into excellent portraits. When he had +finished half-a-dozen of them, his brother had cut and brought to the +spot a number of bushy branches about two or three feet high. These +were soon stuck into the ground in a small circle so as to resemble a +growing bush, behind, or, rather, in the midst of which, they could +effectually conceal themselves by crouching. + +While this was being constructed the elder brother went down to the edge +of the water and made half-a-dozen mud-heaps well within gunshot, which +when the artificial heads and necks were attached to them, formed such +exact counterparts of geese that the wild birds might well be excused +for mistaking them for friends. Indeed tyros at this work have been +known to fire at such decoys believing them to be genuine birds. + +Even while they were thus engaged one and another flock of ducks and +geese passed them on their way to warmer climes; of course sheering off +as they passed. But when the arrangement was completed, and the two +boys, crouching low, gazed at the horizon with eager looks, the wild +birds no longer avoided the spot. On the contrary, seeing the decoys, +they rather inclined to pass close to the place. + +In flying down a river, or along the margin of a lake, wild birds may +diverge a little to follow the sinuosities of bank or shore, but they +will not get out of the way of a projecting promontory; they rather make +a short cut by crossing over it. + +The young hunters had not to wait long. + +"There's a flock of geese coming," said Archie in a whisper, though the +birds were at the moment some miles away. "Take the first shot, Little +Bill." + +They had only one gun between them. + +"I don't like to," said Billie, "that thing gave me such an awful kick +last time, and I can't stand it now." + +"O! there's no fear, I put in only a small charge of powder-and-shot, on +purpose. It won't kick hard this time. Try." + +"Well, I'll try," said Billie, taking the gun. + +"Aim well in advance, Bill. They fly fast, and primin' gets damp +sometimes." + +A flock of small geese was approaching. The boys became dumb, but they +had remarkably speaking eyes. + +Animated by curiosity, the flock descended to observe the decoys. How +often that feeling of curiosity has proved fatal--not only to feathered +geese! + +Little Bill raised his gun. Puff! went the priming. Bang! went the +charge. One of the birds, describing a beautiful curve, fell with +bursting violence on the ground. + +"Well done, Billie," cried his brother enthusiastically as he leaped +over the sheltering brush and ran to secure the prize. "A few like that +will give a supper to the whole camp. Now, then," he added on +returning, "you'll try again." + +"No, Archie. It's your turn now--and the thing _did_ give me a +tremendous kick." + +"But I will put in still less powder this time, Little Bill, and less +shot too, so you'll have to be careful of your aim. See, there's +another flock coming--there, take it, and down with you. I do believe +they are big fellows." + +Thus encouraged, Billie took the gun and crouched low. His brother was +right. It was a flock of the great grey geese of Canada which now +approached. The hearts of both boys beat high, for they were not only +actuated by what is termed the sporting tendency, but by the desire to +contribute their fair share to the general larder of their friends, who +were encamped a considerable distance off at the other end of the lake. + +"Okematan will open his eyes if we take back a goose or two like these; +why, they are swans almost!" whispered Archie, as the birds approached +in the form of an angle. "Take the big fat one on the left--the one now +squintin' down at the decoys." + +Billie obeyed, and fired. The result was, in a manner, threefold. +First, the boy's aim was so good that the big fat fellow dropped like a +stone not three yards from their position. Second, the hitherto silent +and symmetrically arranged flock went into dire confusion and sheered +off in trumpeting convulsions; and, third, a scattering shot, having +found its billet in the head of another goose immediately behind the +first one, caused it to plunge right into the camp, straight for the +head of Little Bill. Archie, ignorant of this, was in the very act of +leaping over the brush to secure the first goose, and had fortunately +got in front of his brother at the right moment when the second goose +caught him on the shoulder and knocked him into the poor invalid's arms. + +He was stunned at first, and rose in a few moments in some degree of +mental confusion; but he was not much the worse for the accident and +greatly rejoiced at his fortunate escape, as well as the splendid +shooting, of Little Bill. + +It must not be supposed that the brothers continued to shoot at this +rate. Comparatively few flocks of geese passed over Willow Point that +day, but numerous flocks of wild-ducks did, and before evening had put +an end to their work, they had secured a fair canoe-load of game. + +That night they lighted their camp-fire among the neighbouring willows; +feasted luxuriously on part of the day's hunt; lay down side by side +under one blanket, with the upturned canoe partially covering them; +dreamed at first of Okematan, gazing in wonder at their load, and, +afterwards, of being knocked head over heels by an enormous grey goose +whose persistent pugnacity was only equalled by its strange incapacity +to achieve its murderous ends. + +Ultimately Oblivion came to their rescue, and the young hunters fell +into a dreamless slumber, with the smoking camp-fire sending an +occasional gleam of ruddy light on their recumbent forms, and the dark +sky with its hosts of twinkling stars serving for a gorgeous canopy. + + + +CHAPTER ELEVEN. + +SHOWS SOME OF THE TROUBLES OF PIONEER COLONISTS. + +Okematan was not the only person who opened his eyes on the return of +the Sinclair boys to camp next day with their heavily laden canoe. The +Davidson and McKay families were much more emphatic in their +astonishment, for the boys, they knew, had not hitherto performed any +exploits in shooting. They had not supposed them gifted with even +ordinary powers as sportsmen, and had imagined that the poor invalid +little Bill was utterly helpless. On the other hand, Okematan was not +unacquainted with the sudden rise to unexpected celebrity of Indian boys +in his tribe, and knew something about the capacity of even cripples to +overcome difficulties when driven by that stern taskmaster, Necessity. + +The abundant supply of provisions thus unexpectedly received was very +acceptable, because during the day on which the boys were absent, a +fresh band of immigrants had arrived on their way to Red River, and one +party of these, hailing from Switzerland, had come on to the little lake +where our Scotch friends were encamped, for the purpose of consulting as +to their future movements--for it was evident that it would be dangerous +as well as useless for them to proceed to Red River in the existing +state of affairs. The leader of the party was a fair-haired youth, who +could speak English very well. + +The Scotch families were having their mid-day meal around the +camp-fires, when the Switzers arrived and introduced themselves. Of +course they were made heartily welcome by Mr Sutherland, who acted as +spokesman for his countrymen. + +"We are unfortunate," said the leader of the new arrivals, whose name +was Andre Morel. "We hoped that the severe climate would be our only +foe to fight with--especially in a land where the people are so few." + +Sutherland--whose sedate and quiet manner was consistent with his +position as an elder and spiritual guide of his countrymen at that +time--smiled gravely, shook his head, and stroked his chin. + +"You will find," he said, "that whatever part of this world you go to, +the passions of man are always more deadly in their consequences than +surroundings, or climates, or anything else." + +"H'm! what you say iss ferry true," remarked old McKay, who was busy +picking the drum-stick of a wild-goose at the moment. "If it wass not +for the jealousy an' ill-will o' the North-Westers we should hev been at +this goot hour in our comfortable houses amang the green fields of Rud +Ruver." + +"Wheesht! faither!" interposed Duncan junior, "Mr Sutherland wass +speakin', an' ye've stoppit him." + +"An' what if I hev, Tuncan? Can he not continoo to speak when I hev +done?" retorted the old man, resuming his drum-stick. + +"You are right, Mr McKay," said the elder. "But for the unfortunate +jealousies of the two Companies, we might have been in very different +circumstances to-day. If the North-Westers could only see that the +establishment of a colony in Red River would in no way hinder the +fur-trade, we could all get along peaceably enough together. But it +seems to have been ordained that man shall reach every good thing +through much tribulation." + +"I do not agree wi' you at all, Muster Sutherland," said old McKay. +"There iss many of rich people in this world, who hev all that hert can +wush, an' are born to it without hevin' any treebulation at all." + +"But I did not say `all that heart could wish,' Mr McKay. I said +`_every_ good thing'." + +"Well, an' iss not wealth a goot thing, Muster Sutherland?" + +"Only if God's blessing goes along with it," returned the elder. "If it +does not, wealth is a curse." + +"H'm! I wush I had a little more o' that curse--whatever," answered the +irreverent old man. + +"Besides," continued Sutherland, not noticing the remark, "the rich are +by no means exempt from tribulation. They are sometimes afflicted with +bad children; not infrequently with bad health, which doctors, at two or +three guineas a visit, cannot cure, and many of them are much troubled +with poverty!" + +"You are talking in ruddles now, Muster Sutherland," said old Duncan, +who, having finished the drum-stick and its duplicate, was preparing his +pipe for action. + +"It is not much of a riddle, Mr McKay. I suppose you consider a man +with ten thousand a year rich, and a man with two hundred poor." + +"Well, yes; I wull not be denyin' that." + +"Well--if the rich man spends ten thousand and fifty pounds a year and +never has anything to spare or to lay by, is he not miserably poor--poor +in spirit as well as in purse? For, at the end of the year his purse is +empty, and he is in debt. On the other hand, if the man with two +hundred a year spends one hundred and fifty, gives away twenty, and lays +by thirty every year, is he not rich?" + +"Ferry true, Muster Sutherland," said McKay, with a peculiar smile, as +he emitted his first whiff. "I wull not be arguin' wi' you, for you +always get the best of it. Nevertheless, it is my opeenion that we've +had treebulation enough in Rud Ruver since we came oot, an' I would be +ferry gled of a luttle prosperity now--if only by way of a pleesant +change." + +Recurring to this subject a few days later, young Morel asked Dan +Davidson, while they were paddling back to camp together one evening +with the proceeds of a day's hunt: "Has your life in the colony, since +the beginning, been as bad as old McKay made it out the other day?" + +"Well, making due allowance for the old man's use of strong language, +his account of matters has not been much overdrawn," answered Dan, who, +in virtue of his superior canoe-craft, acted the part of steersman. +"You see, when we came out here we expected, like you, that all would be +plain sailing, except as regarded climate and ordinary difficulties, but +our eyes were soon opened to the true state of things. Instead of the +wilderness, with a few peaceful inhabitants living under the mild sway +of the Hudson Bay Company, we found another company, apparently as +strong as the Hudson's Bay one, in violent opposition. They regarded +our coming as likely to ruin their trade, for Lord Selkirk was a share +holder in the Hudson's Bay Company, and it was supposed his object in +planting the colony was to advance his scheme of monopolising the whole +fur-trade of the Far West. I cannot myself see how this colony could +injure the fur-trade; but, anyhow, I know that the opposition has +affected the colonists very severely, for we have been deceived by the +contending parties, and misled, and delayed or thwarted in all our +operations. + +"At the very outset, on our arrival, a band of the Nor'-Westers, +composed of half-breeds and Indians, warned us that our presence was +unwelcome, and tried to frighten us away by their accounts of the savage +nature of the natives. Then the fear of perishing for want of food +induced a lot of us to take their advice, leave the farms allotted to +us, and go to a place called Pembina, about seventy miles distant from +the colony, there to spend the long and hard winter in tents, according +to the Indian fashion, and live on the produce of the chase." + +"I should have thought that was a pleasant way of spending the first +winter," remarked Andre Morel, who, besides being young, was strong and +enthusiastic. + +"So thought some of us at first," returned Dan, "but when we found that +the thermometer fell to somewhere between 40 and 50 degrees below zero; +that walking in snow-shoes, trapping, hunting buffalo, and shooting, +were not to be learned in a few days; and when we saw our women and +children dependent sometimes on the charity of Indians, and reduced +almost to starvation, we changed our minds as to the pleasure of the +thing. However, if the school was rough, it made the scholars all the +quicker, and now I think that most of us are equal to the Redskins +themselves at their own work. + +"When that winter came to an end," continued Dan, "we returned to Red +River, in the month of May, wiser men, thoroughly determined to plant +and sow, and make ourselves independent of the savages. But hunger +followed us, for fish were scarce that season; so were roots and +berries; and, if it had not been for a kind of parsnip which grows wild +in the plains, and a species of eatable nettle, I do believe some of us +would have gone under altogether." + +"And did your first sowing turn out well?" asked the young Swiss, who +having been bred a watchmaker, had only hazy notions as to farming. + +"Ay, there was a gleam of prosperity there that led us to hope great +things for the future," answered Dan; "but the gleam did not continue. +Why, one fellow, not far from our place, sowed four quarts of wheat, and +reaped twelve and a half bushels; but we had terrible trouble to save +our crops from the birds. In the Spring and Fall, blackbirds and wild +pigeons pass over the prairies on their way north or south, in immense +numbers. They pass in such numbers that they could, I do believe, +swallow our whole harvest, if they got only a grain a-piece. The +berries failed them that year, an' men, women, and children had to work +hard wi' guns, bird-nets, and rattles, from morning to night, to say +nothing o' scarecrows. We had resolved never to go near Pembina again, +but what we saved of the harvest was little more than enough for seed, +so we were forced to try it for another winter. Troubles again awaited +us there. The half-breeds and Indians--who had been kind at first-- +became jealous. A plot was discovered to murder two of our party who +had undertaken to hunt, so we were obliged to buy our provisions at a +high price, and even to barter away our clothing to avoid starvation, +and we returned half-naked to the Settlement the following spring. +Then, coming upon us in armed bands and superior numbers, they drove us +out of the Settlement altogether at last, and we came here to Jack River +to spend the winter as we best could. After that we went back and +struggled on for some time, but now, here have they a second time +banished us! What the end is to be, who can tell?" + +"Truly, if such be the country I have come to, I will go back to my +native land and make watches," remarked the Swiss in a tone from which +the sanguine element had almost entirely disappeared. + + + +CHAPTER TWELVE. + +ROUND THE CAMP-FIRES. + +Had any one been watching the camp-fires of the banished colonists that +night, the last idea that would have entered the observer's mind would +have been that of suffering or distress. + +The night was brilliantly fine, and just cold enough to make the blazing +fires agreeable without being necessary--except, indeed, as a means of +cooking food. The light of these fires, shining through the green, +yellow, and golden foliage, and illuminating the sunburnt faces of men, +women, and children, gave to the scene a strain of the free, the wild, +and the romantic, which harmonised well with the gypsy-like appearance +of the people, and formed a ruddy contrast to the pure cold light of the +innumerable stars overhead, which, with their blue-black setting, were +reflected in the neighbouring lake. + +Over every fire pots and kettles were suspended from tripods, or rested +on the half-burned logs, while impaled wild-fowl roasted in front of it. +Food being in great abundance, hearts were light in spite of other +adverse circumstances, and men and women, forgetting to some extent the +sufferings of the past and the dark prospects of the future, appeared to +abandon themselves to the enjoyment of the present. + +The children, of course, were full of glee, and not altogether empty of +mischief; and there were fortunately no infants of age so tender as to +induce a squalling protest against the discomforts of a situation which +could be neither understood nor appreciated. + +"It iss a pleesant night, whatever," remarked old McKay, lighting his +pipe with a brand plucked from the fire which his family and the +Davidsons shared in common; "an' if it wass always like this, it iss +myself that would not object to be a rud savitch." + +"I don't know that a rud savitch is much worse than a white wan," +growled Duncan junior, in an under-tone. + +"What iss that you say?" demanded the old man with a look of suspicion, +for his hearing was imperfect. + +"Surely the water must be boiling now, daddy?" said Elspie, by way of +checking the conversation. + +"I don't know whuther it iss boilin' or not," answered Duncan senior, +applying another brand to his pipe. + +"Archie, boy!" exclaimed Dan Davidson, "you're letting that goose roast +to a cinder." + +"No, Dan, I'm not--but Billie can't a-bear meat underdone, so it's +better to blacken the outside than have the inside raw." + +"Who iss that singing? Wheesht, boys," said Fergus McKay, turning his +head a little on one side as if to listen. + +There was profound silence for a few moments as a rich manly voice was +heard to swell forth from the neighbourhood of one of the camp-fires. + +"It comes from the camp of the Switzers, I think," said Elspie McKay. + +"I know it," said Jessie Davidson, who was seated on a log beside her +friend. "It is Francois La Certe. He came to our meeting-place in Red +River, you know, just after Cuthbert Grant and his men left us, and, +hearing that we were starting off to Jack River again, he resolved to +follow. I heard him tell Slowfoot to get ready to go along with us." + +"I wonder why he came?" said Mrs Davidson, coming out of her tent at +the moment, and joining the party round the fire. + +"He did not say," answered Jessie. + +"He did not require to say," remarked Duncan McKay, with a sarcastic +laugh. "Every wan knows that wherever there iss a chance of gettin' +ammunition and plenty of victuals for nothing, there La Certe iss +certain to be found. He knew that we would be sure to hev plenty at +this season o' the year, an' that we would not see him an' his wife +sterve when our kettles wass full. Iss not that so, Okematan? You know +him best." + +Thus appealed to, the Indian, whose usual expression was one of intense +gravity, shut his eyes, opened his mouth, displayed his superb teeth, +and uttered a low chuckle, but made no further reply. + +It was enough. Those who understood Okematan and his ways were well +aware that he thought La Certe uncommonly sly. + +The half-breed had indeed followed the expelled colonists in the belief +that they would certainly possess plenty of powder and shot--which he +had not the means of purchasing. He also knew that the whole of +Rupert's Land swarmed with game in autumn and spring, and that the +Scotch were an open-handed race when approached in the right way. +Putting these things together, he carefully gummed his canoe, put his +wife and child into it--also some of the provision which had been +supplied to him by Duncan McKay junior--and followed the settlers over +Lake Winnipeg to Jack River. + +Here, finding that a new party of immigrants had arrived, who were +necessarily unacquainted with his little peculiarities, La Certe +attached himself to them and made himself agreeable. This he could do +very well, for the Switzers understood his bad French, as well as his +good tuneful voice, and appreciated his capacity for telling a story. + +"Did you never," he said to Andre Morel, after his song was finished, +"hear of how my old mother saved her whole tribe from death one time in +the Rocky Mountains?" + +"Never," Morel replied with a somewhat sceptical but good-natured smile. + +"No! I wonder much, for every one in this land heard about it, an' I +thought the news must have spread over Europe and--and, perhaps Africa. +Well, I will tell you. Where is my baccy-bag?" + +"Never mind, fill your pipe from mine," said Morel, tossing him a little +bag of the coveted weed. + +"Thank you. Well, you must know that my mother had a beautiful voice-- +O! much more beautiful than mine. Indeed, I do not joke, so you need +not laugh. It was so sweet that men were always forced to listen till +she was done. They could not help it." + +"Did they ever want to help it?" asked Morel quietly. + +"O yes--as you shall hear. Well, one day my mother was living with all +our tribe--I say _our_ tribe because my mother was an Indian--with all +our tribe, in a great dark gorge of the Rocky Mountains. The braves had +gone out to hunt that day, but my mother stayed behind with the women +and children. I was a little foolish child at that time--too young to +hunt or fight. My father--a French Canadian--he was dead. + +"We knew--my mother and I--that the braves would be home soon. We +expected them every minute. While we were waiting for them, my mother +went into the bush to pick berries. There she discovered a war-party of +our enemies. They were preparing to attack our village, for they knew +the men were away, and they wanted the scalps of the women and children. +But they did not know the exact spot where our wigwams were pitched, +and were just going, after a feed, to look for it. + +"My mother ran home with the news, and immediately roused the camp, and +made them get ready to fly to meet the returning men. + +"`But, my daughter,' said an old chief, who had stayed in camp, `our +enemies are young and active; they will quickly overtake us before we +meet our men.' + +"`No,' said my mother, `I will stop them. Get ready, and set off +quickly.' + +"She then ran back on her trail--my mother was a tremendous runner-- +superb! She came to a narrow place where our enemies would have to +pass. A very thick tree grew there. She climbed it, and hid among the +branches. It projected beyond a precipice and overhung a stream. Soon +after that she saw the enemy advancing, step by step, slowly, +cautiously, like men who dread an ambush, and with glances quick and +solemn from side to side, like men who see a foe in every stump and +stone." + +La Certe paused at this point. He was an adept at story-telling. His +voice had slowed by degrees and become increasingly deep and solemn as +he proceeded. + +"Now," continued he, in a higher tone, "my mother did not fear that they +would see her if they looked up when they passed the tree. She was too +well hidden for that; but she was not sure what the effect of her voice +would be, for she had never tried it in that way before. However, she +was full of courage. She resembled me in that--bold as a lion! She +began to sing. Low and soft at the beginning, like a dream of song. + +"At the first note the Indians halted--every man; each in the position +in which he was fixed. If a foot was up he kept it up. If both feet +were down he left them down. The feet that were up came slowly to the +ground when the Indians got tired, but no one took another step. My +mother's voice was a weird voice. It sounded as if the place from which +it came was nowhere--or anywhere--or everywhere! Slowly the painted +heads turned from side to side as far as they could go, and the glaring +eyes turned a little further. A creeping fear came over them. They +trembled. They turned pale. That could be easily seen through the +paint. My mother saw it! She became more courageous and sang out in +her most pathetic strain. The Indians wept. That was quite visible. +My mother saw it. Her great object was to delay the attack until our +men had time to arrive. She tried a war-song, but that was not so +successful. It was too commonplace. Besides, in her energy she shook +the branches, and that drew attention to the tree. My mother thought +that she was in danger then; but fortune favoured her. It always +favours the brave. I know this from experience. + +"She had just come to a terrific whoop in the war-song when she slipped +off her branch and the whoop increased to a death-yell as she went +crashing headlong through the branches and down into the stream at the +foot of the precipice. + +"Water! water!" exclaimed La Certe at this point, holding out both +hands. "I can never pass this part of my story without burning thirst!" + +A mug of water was handed him. + +"Poor fellow--have some brandy in it," said a sympathetic hearer, +hastily getting out his bottle. + +La Certe held out his mug impatiently for the brandy, drained the mug, +and cleared his voice. + +"Was--was your mother killed?" asked the sympathiser, earnestly. + +"Killed? No. Impossible! My mother could not be killed because her +destiny was not yet fulfilled. No: there was a deep pool right under +the tree. She fell into that with a plunge that echoed from cliff to +cliff. The Indians were profoundly superstitious. All Indians are not +so, but these Indians were. They waited not for more. They turned and +fled as if all the evil spirits in the Rocky Mountains were chasing +them. They reached their wigwams breathless, and told their squaws that +one of the spirits of a mountain stream had sat among the branches of a +tree and sung to them. It had told them that the right time for +attacking their foes had not yet come. Then it sang them a war-song +descriptive of their final victory, and, just after uttering a +tremendous war-whoop, it had dived back into its native stream." + +"Well done!" exclaimed an enthusiastic Canadian. + +"But what became of your mother?" asked Morel. + +"Oh! she swam ashore. My mother was a splendid swimmer. I know it, for +she taught me." + +"Was it a long swim?" asked a sceptical sailor, who was one of the +emigrants. + +"How?--what mean you?" demanded La Certe, sternly. + +"I only want to know if she took long to swim ashore out o' that pool," +said the sceptic, simply. + +La Certe cast on him a glance of suspicion, and replied that his mother +had found no difficulty in getting out of the pool. + +"Is the old lady alive yet?" asked the pertinacious sceptic. + +"Of course not. She died long long ago--thirty years ago." + +"What! before you was born? That's strange, isn't it?" + +"No, but you not understand. I suppose my speech is not plain to you. +I said _three_ years ago." + +"Ah! that's more like it. I only missed what you said," returned the +sceptic, whose name was Fred Jenkins, "for I've lived a while in France, +and understand your lingo pretty well. Pass that goose, Morel, if you +have left anything on it. This air o' the wilderness beats the air o' +the sea itself for givin' a fellow a twist." + +The remarks of Jenkins, while they did not absolutely destroy the +confidence of the Swiss party, shook it enough to show the wily +half-breed that he must do something if possible to re-establish his +credit. He therefore volunteered another song, which was gladly +accepted and highly appreciated; for, as we have said, La Certe +possessed a really good and tuneful voice, and these immigrants were a +musical people. + +While this was going on at the Swiss camp-fires an incident occurred at +the fire round which the McKay-Davidson party was assembled, which +deserves particular notice. + +Old McKay was giving some directions to Fergus; Duncan junior was seated +opposite Dan Davidson, smoking his pipe, and Elspie had gone into her +tent, when Slowfoot, the spouse of La Certe, drew near. + +"Come along, old girl," exclaimed McKay senior. "It iss some baccy you +will be wantin', I'll wager." + +Slowfoot did not reply in words, but the smile upon her face was +eloquent. + +"Come away, then," continued the hospitable Highlander. "You shall hev +a pipe of it, whatever." + +He handed her a large plug of tobacco, and the woman, sitting down close +to young Duncan, produced her pipe, and drew out a knife for the purpose +of cutting up the tobacco. + +"Hallo!" exclaimed Duncan, "where did you get hold o' my knife?" + +He stopped abruptly--a little confused in spite of himself. For the +moment he had quite forgotten that the knife had been left in the camp +where he had slain Perrin, and the sudden sight of it had thrown him off +his guard. It was now too late to unsay the words, but not too late to +mislead his hearers. + +"I got it from Marie Blanc," said Slowfoot with a look of surprise. +"Does the knife belong to Cloudbrow?" + +"I think it does. I'm almost sure it iss mine. Let me see it," +returned Duncan, taking the knife from the woman's hand, and examining +it with cool and critical deliberation. + +"No," continued he, "it iss not mine, but very like one that I lost--so +like that I felt sure at first it wass mine." + +Men who lie, usually overact their part. Duncan glanced suspiciously at +Dan to see how he took the explanation as he returned the knife to +Slowfoot, and Dan observed the glance, as being uncalled for-- +unnatural--in the circumstances. + +Dan was by no means of a suspicious nature, nevertheless the glance +haunted him for many a day after that. Suspicion once aroused is a +ghost which is not easily laid. He tried to shake it off, and he +carefully, loyally, kept it confined in his own breast; but, do what he +would, he could not banish entirely from his mind that Duncan McKay--the +brother of his Elspie--had some sort of guilty knowledge of the murder +of poor Henri Perrin. + + + +CHAPTER THIRTEEN. + +DIFFICULTIES OF VARIOUS KINDS OVERCOME. + +When the bright warm days and cool starry nights of the Indian summer +gave place to the sharp days and frosty nights of early winter--when +young ice formed on the lakes and rendered canoeing impossible, and the +ducks and geese had fled to warmer climes, and the Frost King had sent +his first messengers of snow to cover the wilderness with a +winding-sheet and herald his return to the Winter Palace--then it was +that the banished Red River settlers began to feel the pinch of poverty +and to understand the full extent of the calamity that had befallen +them. + +We have not space to follow them through all the details of that winter +at Jack River. Some died, all suffered more or less; but they had to +endure it, for escape from the country to the civilised world was even +more difficult and hopeless than escape from the dreaded wilds of +Siberia. The men hunted, fished under the ice, trapped, and sustained +themselves and their families in life during the long, dreary winter; +the only gain being that they became more or less expert at the +Red-man's work and ways of life. + +Only two of the Indians remained with them to help them over their +difficulties--namely, Okematan and Kateegoose, with their respective +squaws. These last were invaluable as the makers of moccasins and +duffle socks and leathern coats, without which existence in such a +climate would have been impossible. They also imparted their knowledge +in such matters to the squaws of the white men. + +There was one friend, however, who did not remain with the settlers when +things began to look dismal around them. This was the amiable, musical, +story-telling La Certe. That tender-hearted man could not endure the +sight of human distress. If he could not relieve it, he felt +constrained to shut his eyes to it and to flee from it. At the first +indication of the approach of winter he had come to old McKay with that +peculiarly mild, humble, deprecatory expression of countenance with +which he was wont to preface an appeal for assistance of some sort. + +"What iss it you will be wantin' _now_?" demanded the old man, rather +testily, for he had an aversion to the half-breed's sneaking ways. +"Surely you will not be wantin' more powder an' shot efter the supply I +gave you last week?" + +O no! nothing could be further from the mind of La Certe. He had plenty +of ammunition and provisions. He had only come to say that he was going +back to--to--Red River. + +"Weel, weel," returned the Highlander, "there is no call for hesitation, +man, in tellin' me that. I will not be breakin' my heart when ye are +gone. I suppose that now ye hev got the best the season can supply, ye +think the comforts o' the Settlement will be more to your taste." + +The remonstrative expression on La Certe's face deepened. The idea of +his own taste or comfort had not once entered his head: but he had a +wife and child whom he was bound to consider, and he had a hut--a home-- +in Red River which he felt constrained to look after. Besides, he had +social duties of many kinds which claimed attention. + +"I've no doubt ye hev," said McKay, with a short sarcastic laugh, "an' +ye will attend to them too--I'll be bound. But ye did not come here, I +suppose, to take a tender farewell o' me. What iss it you will be +wantin'? Oot wi' it, man!" + +"There is a canoe--" said La Certe, with some hesitation. + +"There iss many a canoe!" returned McKay with a peculiar grin. + +"True, but there is one on the shore now, close to the flat rock +which--" + +"My own canoe!" interrupted the other, "what will ye be wantin' wi' +that?" + +La Certe did not wish to appear greedy, but the season was late, and his +own canoe was not in a very fit condition to carry a family round the +shores of a lake so large as Lake Winnipeg. Would the white father lend +his canoe to him? It could not be wanted much longer that Fall, and the +one he would leave behind him was an excellent canoe for ordinary +fishing and hunting purposes. He would be quite willing to hire the +canoe or to pay the full price for it if any accident should happen to +it. + +"No," said McKay, firmly. "No, La Certe; your hiring means borrowing, +and your payin' means owin' a debt for the remainder o' your natural +life. I will see you at the bottom o' Lake Winnipeg before I will be +lending you my canoe." + +La Certe smiled sadly, and gazed at the cap with which his hands played, +as if appealing to it for sympathy. + +With an aspect of the profoundest resignation he made his bow and left +the Presence. + +But La Certe was not in the least put out by this failure. He went to +his tent, and recounted the interview to his squaw, who, when he +entered, was in the act of giving her child, a creature of about four +years of age, one or two draws of her pipe, to let it taste how nice it +was. + +Smoking in calm placidity, the amiable pair discussed the subject. The +conclusion they came to was, as usual, harmonious. + +"I think he will agree to lend it next time I go to him," said La Certe, +hopefully. + +"He will give in," replied Slowfoot, decidedly. + +The four-year-old could not understand the subject, and made no comment; +but it howled for another smoke, and got it. + +La Certe was wrong, and his wife was right--as usual. Old McKay did not +agree to "lend" his canoe the "next time," or the next again, but he did +"give in" at last, more, perhaps, to get rid of the half-breed's +importunity than because of good-will, and sold the canoe to him--on +credit. + +When that winter was over, the Hudson's Bay Company again encouraged the +settlers to return, under promise of protection, and the spring found +the persevering people, in spite of all difficulties and previous +failures, busy putting into the ground what little seed they possessed, +and otherwise cultivating the soil. + +Some of them there were, however, who, after lending a hand in this +work, determined to provide second strings to their bows by following +the buffalo-hunters to the plains. These were chiefly the young and +strong men, such as Dan Davidson and his brother Peter, Fergus McKay, +Antoine Dechamp, and Jacques Bourassin, among many others. + +La Certe also went, as well as his squaw and the four-year-old. He +managed the thing characteristically thus. + +When the half-breeds were making preparations for their spring hunt, he +paid a visit to Duncan McKay, who was busy at the time helping his +father and brother to rebuild their house. Indeed the edifice was +almost rebuilt, for the erection of small wooden houses does not usually +take long. + +"You've come to beg, borrow, or steal, no doubt," said Cloudbrow, who +was worthy of his nickname, for he was as short of temper as Duncan +senior. + +No, La Certe had come to do none of these things, he said, with a +conciliatory smile. + +"Well, then, you can't have come to buy or to ask advances," growled +Duncan; "for you see that our store and all we possessed has been burnt +by your precious countrymen." + +La Certe knew this, and professed himself profoundly grieved as well as +indignant with his countrymen. No, he did not come to buy or to borrow, +but to hire. The McKays had still some horses left, and carts. Could +they not spare a horse and cart to him on hire? + +"No, we can do nothing of the sort," said Duncan shortly, resuming his +axe and work. "You can go to the Company. Perhaps they will trust +you--though they are fools if they do." + +La Certe was regretful, but not cast down. He changed the subject, +commented on the building that was going on, the prospects of a good +harvest, and finally took refuge in that stale old subject, the weather. +Then he said in a casual way--as if it had just occurred to him-- + +"By the way--that knife that my wife got from Marie Blanc--" + +Young McKay stopped, and looked quickly up for a moment, with a slight +flush, but instantly resumed work. + +"Well," he said, quietly, "what about the knife?" + +"Would you like to have it--my wife bade me inquire?" + +"Why should _I_ like to have it?" he asked carelessly. + +"Oh! I thought it was yours," said La Certe. + +"You are mistaken. I said it was very like mine. But it is _not_ +mine--and I have no wish for what does not belong to me." + +"Of course not. Well, I must be going," said the half-breed, preparing +to leave. "I wished much to have your horse and cart, for they are both +good, and I would offer you 4 pounds for the trip, which, you know, is +double the usual charge, for I never grudge a good price for a good +thing." + +"Yes, all the more when you hev no intention to pay it," said McKay with +a laugh. "However, since you seem so anxious, and offer so good a +price, I am willing to oblige you this time, in the hope that you are +really becoming an honest man!" + +The half-breed was profuse in his thanks, and in his assurance that +Cloudbrow's hopes would certainly not be disappointed. + +Having thus attained his chief object, our arch-beggar went off to +obtain provisions. Those which had been supplied him the previous +autumn by young McKay had been quite consumed by himself and his +friends--for the man, you see, had a liberal heart and hand. + +But his first attempts were unsuccessful. He wanted ammunition. To go +to the plains without ammunition was obviously useless. He wanted +food--sugar, tea, flour, pork. To go to the plains without these would +be dreary work. But men knew La Certe's character, and refused him. +One after another he tried his friends. Then he tried them again. Then +he tried comparative strangers. He could not try his enemies, for, +strange to say, he had none. Then he went over them all again. + +At last, by indomitable perseverance, he managed to wear out the +patience of one of his friends, who believed in the restoration of the +incorrigible, and he found himself fully equipped to take the field with +his hard-working comrades. + +It may be remarked here that the buffalo runners generally went on the +credit system, trusting to a successful hunt to pay off their debts, and +leave them supplied with food for the winter. But, then, most of these +men were in earnest, and meant to pay off their debts loyally. Whereas +La Certe--good, humorous, easy-going man--had not the slightest +intention of paying his debts at all! + + + +CHAPTER FOURTEEN. + +TREACHERY IN THE AIR. + +At this time the half-breeds of the colony of Red River formed a small +party compared with the numbers to which they multiplied in after years, +and the band of hunters who annually went to the plains to chase the +buffalo was proportionally small. Nevertheless, they were numerous +enough to constitute a formidable band, capable of holding their own, +when united, against any band of wandering Indians who might feel +disposed to attack them. They were a brave, hardy race of men, but of +course there were some black sheep among them like La Certe. + +About sixty or a hundred miles from the Settlement, the party, under +command of Antoine Dechamp, found the buffalo, and preparations were at +once made to attack them. It was dusk, however, when the herds were +discovered, so that the hunt had to be postponed to the following day. + +A small clump of bushes afforded wood enough for camp-fires. The carts +were ranged in a circle with the trains outward. Sentries were posted; +the horses were secured; the kettles put on; pipes lighted; and noise, +laughter, song and story, mingled with the shrill voices of children, +were heard far on into the night. + +Among the children, if we may venture so to class them, were Archie and +Billie Sinclair--though we suspect that Archie would have claimed, and +with some reason, to be classed with the men. They belonged to the +camp-fire, which formed a centre to the party composed of Dan and Peter, +Fergus, Dechamp, and Fred Jenkins the sailor. The latter, who it was +thought had come out to the country by way of a skylark rather than as a +settler, had followed the hunters, bent, he said, on firing a broadside +into a buffalo. He had brought with him a blunderbuss, which he averred +had been used by his great-grandfather at the battle of Culloden. It +was a formidable old weapon, capable of swallowing, at one gulp, several +of the bullets which fitted the trading guns of the country. Its powers +of scattering ordinary shot in large quantity had proved to be very +effective, and had done such execution among flocks of wild-fowl, that +the Indians and half-breeds, although at first inclined to laugh at it, +were ultimately filled with respect. + +"I doubt its capacity for sending ball straight, however," remarked Dan +to Jenkins, who was carefully cleaning out the piece, "especially if +charged with more than one ball." + +"No fear of it," returned the sailor, with a confident air. "Of course +it scattered the balls about six yards apart the only time I tried it +with a lot of 'em, but that was at fifty yards off, an' they tell me +that you a'most ram the muzzle against the brutes' sides when chasin' +buffalo. So there's no room to scatter, d'ee see, till they get inside +their bodies, and when there it don't matter how much they scatter." + +"It's well named a young cannon by La Certe," said Peter Davidson, who, +like the seaman, was out on his first buffalo-hunt. "I never heard such +a roar as it gave that time you brought down ten out of one flock of +ducks on the way up here." + +"Ay, Peter, she barked well that time," remarked the sailor, with a +grin, "but, then there was a reason. I had double-shotted her by +mistake." + +"An' ye did it too without an aim, for you had both eyes tight shut at +the time," remarked Fergus. "Iss that the way they teach ye to shoot at +sea?" + +"In course it is," replied Jenkins, gravely. "That's the beauty o' the +blunderbuss. There's no chance o' missin', so what 'ud be the use o' +keepin' yer eyes open, excep' to get 'em filled wi' smoke. You've on'y +got to point straight, an' blaze away." + +"I did not know that you use the blunderbuss in your ships at all," said +Dechamp, with a look of assumed simplicity. + +"Ho yes, they do," said Jenkins, squinting down the bell-mouthed barrel, +as if to see that the touch-hole was clear. "Aboard o' one man-o'-war +that I sailed in after pirates in the China seas, we had a blunderbuss +company. The first-leftenant, who was thought to be queer in his head, +he got it up. + +"The first time the company was ranged along the deck he gave the order +to load with ball cartridges. There was twenty-six of us, all told. + +"`We've got no cartridges for 'em, sir,' whispered the man nearest him. + +"`If you don't obey orders,' growled the leftenant 'tween his teeth, +`I'll have ye strung up for mutiny every man Jack of you--_load_!' he +repeated in a kind of a yell. + +"We had our or'nary belts and pouches on, so we out wi' the or'nary +cartridges--some three, some four,--an', biting off the ends, poured in +the powder somehow, shoved in the balls anyhow, an' rammed the whole +consarn down. + +"`Present--fire!' roared the leftenant. + +"Bang! went the six an' twenty blunderbusses, an' when the smoke cleared +away there was fourteen out o' the twenty-six men flat on their backs. +The rest o' us was raither stunned, but hearty. + +"`Take these men below,' cried the leftenant, `an' send fourteen strong +men here. We don't want weaklings for _this_ company.' + +"After that we loaded in moderation, an' got on better." + +"And the pirates--what did _they_ think o' the new weapon?" asked Peter +Davidson, with an amused expression. + +"O! they couldn't stand it at all," answered the sailor, looking up from +his work, with a solemnity that was quite impressive. "They stood fire +only once. After that they sheered off like wild-cats. I say, Mistress +La Certe, how long is that lobscouse--or whatever you call it,--goin' to +be in cookin'?" Slowfoot gave vent to a sweet, low giggle, as she +lifted the kettle off the hook, and thus gave a practical answer to the +question. She placed before him the robbiboo, or pemmican, soup, which +the seaman had so grievously misnamed. + +During the time that the hunters were appeasing their appetites, it was +observed that Antoine Dechamp, the leader of the expedition, was +unusually silent and thoughtful, and that he betrayed a slight look of +anxiety. It therefore did not surprise Dan Davidson, when the supper +was nearly ended, that Dechamp should rise and leave the fire after +giving him a look which was a silent but obvious invitation to follow. + +Dan obeyed at once, and his leader, conducting him between the various +camp-fires, led him outside the circle of carts. + +A clear moon lit up the prairie all round, so that they could see its +undulating sweep in every direction. + +"Anything wrong, Antoine?" asked Dan in a low voice, when they were out +of earshot of the camp. + +"Nothing wrong, Dan." + +"Surely," continued the other, while Dechamp paused as if in perplexity, +"surely there can be no chance of Red-skins troubling us on a clear +night like this. I can distinguish every bush for miles around." + +"There is no fear o' Red-skins. No, I am not troubled about them. It +is matters concerning yourself that trouble me." + +"How's that? What do you mean, Antoine?" + +"Is your brother-in-law-to-be, Duncan McKay, coming to join us this +spring?" asked Dechamp. + +"I believe he is--after he has helped his father a bit longer wi' the +farm. Why do you ask?" + +"Well, to say truth, I can't give you a very good reason for my bein' +anxious. Only I can't help havin' my ears open, and I've heard some +talk among the lads that makes me fear for the young man. They say, or +hint, that he knows more about the murder o' poor Perrin than he chooses +to tell. I've not been quite able to find out what makes them suspect +him, but they do suspect him, an' it would be well to warn him not to +come here, for you know there are many opportunities to commit murder on +a buffalo-hunt!" + +The incident of the knife, and of Duncan McKay's significant glance, at +once flashed across Davidson's mind, and he felt a terrible sinking of +the heart when the suspicion, once before roused within him, seemed now +to be confirmed. He resolved, however, to reveal his thoughts to no +one--specially not to Elspie. + +"I think it a shame," he said, "that men should allow such rumours to +circulate, when nothing certain has arisen to rouse suspicion. That +affair of the knife was clearly explained when young McKay declared that +it was not his, though it looked like it. If he knew anything about the +murder, would he not have been certain to have told us long ago? And, +surely, you cannot suppose that Duncan killed Perrin with his own hand? +Speak, Dechamp! Why do you shake your head?" + +"I know nothing," returned the leader. "What right have I to suppose +anything? I only know that men's deeds are often mysterious and +unaccountable, and that our men have strong suspicion. For myself, I +have no opinion. Duncan McKay is probably innocent, for he and Perrin +were not enemies. I hope he is so, but I advise you to stop his coming +to the camp just now if you can. His life may depend on it." + +"I cannot stop him," returned Dan, with a perplexed look. "He is +headstrong, as you know, and if he has made up his mind to come, nothing +will stop him." + +"Perhaps if he knew his life would be in danger--that might stop him." + +"I doubt it; but I will give him the chance. I will ride back to Red +River without delay, and warn him." + +"Good. When will you start?" + +"To-night. The moon is clear and will not set till morning. I shall be +well on my way by that time." + +"Will you ride alone?" + +"No, there may be bad Indians about. I will ask Okematan or Fergus +McKay to ride with me. Why did you not speak to Fergus instead of to +me?" + +"Because he has not been spoken to by any one," answered Dechamp; "and I +would not be the first to put suspicion into his head about his own +brother. Besides, your head is clearer; and your interest in Duncan, +for Elspie's sake, is greater than his, no doubt." + +"Well, you may be right, Antoine. At all events if I take Fergus with +me I shall send him back before reaching the Settlement, and say nothing +whatever about my reason for going there. `Pressing business,' you +know, will be sufficient." + +"I'm not so sure of that," returned Dechamp with a laugh. "Men are apt +to want to know the nature of `pressing business.' However, it may be +as well to take Fergus. At any rate you cannot have Okematan, for he is +not in camp, he left soon after we pitched, and I know has not yet +returned." + +"It matters not. Fergus will do better. He is more companionable." + +Returning to camp, Dan Davidson made the proposal to Fergus McKay. That +worthy was, as he said, ready for anything, and the two were soon +mounted. They were also well armed, for the risk of meeting a party of +hostile Indians was not altogether out of the question, though +improbable. Each horseman carried his blanket and provision wallet, his +gun, a long knife almost equal to an ancient Roman sword, and a cavalry +pistol--revolvers not having been invented at that time: at least they +had not come into general use. Thus provided for all contingencies, +they set forth. + +As we have said, the night was clear and fine, so that the plains were +open to view in all directions, save where a few scattered clumps of +willows and small trees grew like islets in the ocean. + +"It iss this that I like better than farming," said Fergus, as the fresh +horses carried them swiftly and lightly over the prairie waves, and down +into the grassy hollows, now swerving to avoid a badger-hole, or +clearing a small shrub with a little bound. "I do think that man wass +intended to live in the wilderness, an' not to coop himself up in the +cities like rabbits in their holes." + +"Why, Fergus, you should have been born a savage," said Dan. + +"Ay, it iss savitch I am that I wass not born a savitch," returned +Fergus with a grim smile. "What in all the world iss the use of +ceevilisation if it will not make people happy? A man wants nothing +more than a goot supper an' a goot bed, an' a goot shelter over him, an' +it is a not five hunderd pound a year that we will want to buy that-- +whatever." + +"But surely man wants a little more than that, Fergus. He wants +breakfast and dinner usually, as well as supper, and a few comforts +besides, such as tea and sugar--at least the women do--besides pipes an' +baccy--to say nothing of books." + +"Oo ay, I will not be denyin' that. But we've no need for wan half the +luxuries o' ceevilisation. An' ye know ferry weel, Tan, that my sister +Elspie would be content to live wi' you in a ferry small hoose, and the +bare necessaries of life, but here you are forced to put off the +merritch because our hooses wass burnt, and you are obleeged to wait +till you get a sort o' palace built, I suppose, and a grand farm set +a-goin'." + +"Indeed, Fergus, you touch me on a sore point there, but with all your +scorn of luxury, I'm sure you'd be the last man to let his sister marry +a fellow who could take her only to a hut or a wigwam." + +"You are right, Tan. Yet I hev spent many a comfortable night in a hut +an' a wigwam since I came to Red River. I wish the place wass more +peaceable." + +"It will never be more peaceable as long as there are two rival +companies fighting for the furs," said Davidson; "but there's worse than +that goin' on, for some of the Indians, it seems, are mad at the +agreement made between them and Lord Selkirk." + +"Wow! that iss a peety. Where heard ye that?" + +"I heard it from La Certe, whose wife Slowfoot, you know, is a Cree +Indian. It seems that the Crees have always claimed Red River as their +lands; but when Lord Selkirk came to make a treaty with the natives he +found some Saulteaux livin' on the soil, an' his lordship, in ignorance, +gave them an interest in the treaty, though they were mere visitors--an' +indeed don't even claim to be owners of the soil--their lands lying far +to the east of Red River." + +"Well," continued Dan, guiding his horse carefully down the next hollow, +for the moon had gone behind a cloud just then, "when the Crees found +out what had been done, they were naturally very angry--an' I don't +wonder--an' they threaten now to expel the Saulteaux from Red River +altogether, an' the white men along wi' them, unless the names of the +Saulteaux chiefs are wiped out o' the contract, an' the annual payment +made to the Crees alone." + +"That iss bad, Taniel, ferry bad," said Fergus, as they reached the +bottom of the hollow and began to ascend the succeeding undulation, "an' +I am all the more sorry to hear it because our goot frund Okematan is a +Cree." + +"Ay, Fergus, he is a great chief of the Crees, and a man of considerable +influence among his people. I should not like to have him for an +enemy." + +"Stop!" said Fergus in a whisper at that moment, laying his hand on +Davidson's arm. + +Dan drew rein at once and looked at his friend, but could not clearly +see his face, for the moon was still behind thick drifting clouds. + +They had just risen high enough on the prairie wave, which they had been +ascending, to be able to see over it, and Dan could perceive by the +outstretched neck of his companion that he was gazing intently at +something directly in front. + +"What do you see, Fergus?" he asked in a low voice. + +"Do you see nothin', Taniel?" was the Highlander's reply. + +"Why, yes. I see the plains stretching away to the horizon--an' dark +enough they are, too, at this moment. I also see a few small clumps +that look like bushes here an' there." + +"Don't you see the clump that's nearest to you--right foment your nose?" +said the other. + +"Of course I do," and he stopped abruptly, for at that moment he saw a +spark in the clump referred to--a spark so small that it might have been +taken for a glow-worm, had such a creature existed there. + +"Savitches!" whispered the Highlander. "Let's get into the hollow as +fast as we can." + +This retrograde movement was soon effected, and the friends dismounted. + +"Now, Fergus, what's the best thing to be done?" + +"I will be leavin' that to you, Taniel, for you've a clearer head than +mine." + +"We dare not ride forward," said Dan, as if communing with himself, "an' +it would be foolish to make a long detour to escape from something until +we know there is something worth escaping from. My notion is that we +hobble or picket our horses here, and go cautiously forward on foot to +see what it is." + +"You'll be doin' what ye think best, Captain Taniel, an' you will find +that private Fergus will back you up--whatever." + +This being settled, the two men picketed their steeds in the hollow, +fastened their guns to the saddles, as being too cumbrous for a creeping +advance, and, armed only with their long knives and pistols, reascended +the prairie wave. With feet clothed in soft moccasin, and practised by +that time in the art of stealthy tread, they moved towards the summit +noiseless as ghosts. + +On gaining the ridge they sank slowly down into the tall grass and +disappeared. + +After a prolonged and somewhat painful creep on hands and knees the two +men reached the edge of the clump of bushes already referred to. + +Before reaching it they discovered, from the sound of voices, that a +party of some kind was encamped there; but, of course, as they knew not +who, it became needful to proceed with extreme caution. When they +gained the edge of the clump, and raised their heads over a low +bush-covered bank, they beheld a sight which was not calculated to cheer +them, for there, in the centre of the bush, encircling a very small +fire, sat a war-party of about fifty painted and befeathered braves of +the Cree Indians. They were engaged in council at the moment. + +A creeping sensation about their scalps was experienced by the two +eavesdroppers on observing that they had passed not a hundred yards from +a sentinel who occupied a low knoll on their left. + +Neither Dan nor Fergus dared to speak--not even to whisper. Still less +did they dare to move; for a few moments after they reached the bank +just referred to, the moon came out from behind the clouds and flooded +the whole scene as with the light of day. + +There was nothing left for it, therefore, except to lie still and +listen. But this gave them small comfort; for, although quite within +earshot of the war-party, the language spoken was utterly unintelligible +to either of them. + +Their eyes, however, were not so useless as their ears, for they could +clearly see each warrior as he rose to harangue his comrades, and, from +the vindictive expression of their faces as well as their frequent +pointing in the direction of the buffalo-hunters it was abundantly +evident that an attack upon them was being discussed. + +At last, after many braves had spoken, a chief of tall and noble mien +arose. His back was towards the two spies, but the moment they heard +his voice they turned their heads and gazed at each other in speechless +amazement, for the voice was quite familiar. + +No word did they dare to utter, but Fergus made formations with his lips +of a most extravagant nature, which, however, clearly spelt "Okematan." +When he had finished, he nodded and turned his gaze again on the Crees. + +Both men now understood that treachery was in the wind, and that a night +attack was highly probable; and, of course, they felt desperately +anxious to jump up and fly back to the camp to warn their comrades--for +their only fear was a surprise. The half-breeds being far more numerous +than the Indians, and well entrenched, there could be no fear for them +if prepared. + +Just then, as if to favour them, the moon retired behind a huge black +cloud. + +Without a moment's hesitation Dan began to creep away back, closely +followed by Fergus. They gave a wide berth of course to the sentinel, +and soon regained the hollow where the horses had been left. Here they +breathed more freely. + +"Who would have thought this of Okematan?" muttered Dan, as he hastily +tightened his saddle-girths. + +"The _rascal_!" exclaimed Fergus, in deep tones of indignation. + +"You must gallop back to camp at once, Fergus," said Dan, as they +mounted. "I will go on to Red River alone." + +"What! will you not be coming with me?" asked the Highlander, in some +surprise. + +"There is no need, for there will be no fighting," returned the other. +"Our fellows far outnumber the Red-skins, and when the latter find that +we have been warned, and are on our guard, they won't attack us, depend +on it. But you'll have to ride fast, for when such fellows make up +their minds to strike they don't usually waste time in delivering the +blow. My business presses, I _must_ go on." + +A minute later, and Dan Davidson was galloping towards the Settlement +alone, while Fergus made the best of his way back to the camp of the +buffalo runners. + + + +CHAPTER FIFTEEN. + +A FRIEND IN NEED IS A FRIEND INDEED. + +Whether or not Okematan was as thorough a rascal as Fergus McKay thought +him will be best shown by harking back, and setting down a little of +what was said by some of the Cree braves at the time that Fergus and Dan +were eavesdropping. + +Standing in a dignified attitude worthy of an ancient Roman, with his +blanket thrown toga-fashion over one shoulder, one of the braves looked +round on the warrior band with a dark scowl before he began. His +comrades were evidently impressed by his looks. Whether owing to a +freak of fancy, a spice of eccentricity, or simple vanity, we know not, +but this brave had, among other ornamental touches to his visage, +painted his nose bright red. The effect on his brother braves was +solemnising. It was not so impressive to his white observers, as it +suggested to them the civilised toper. + +"The great white chief," began Rednose, with a slow deliberation that +was meant to convey a settled and unalterable conviction, "is a fool!" + +"Waugh!" exclaimed the audience with emphasis, for the language was +strong, and uttered with intense vigour, and that quite accorded with +their tastes, so they agreed with the sentiment without regard to its +signification. This species of rhetoric, and its effects, are sometimes +observed in connection with civilised gatherings. + +The great white chief thus irreverently referred to, we regret to say, +was Lord Selkirk. + +"The great white chief," continued Rednose, availing himself of the +force of emphatic repetition, "is a fool! He is a child! He knows +nothing! He comes across the great salt lake from the rising sun, with +the air and aspect of an owl, thinking to teach us--the great Cree +nation--wisdom!" + +"Waugh!" from the audience, one of whom, having a cold in his head, +sneezed inadvertently, and was scowled at by the orator for full two +minutes in absolute silence. If that Cree warrior--he was on his first +war-path--possessed anything akin to the feelings of the Paleface he +must have suffered martyrdom. + +"Every one knows," continued the orator, resuming, "that the Crees are +wise. They can tell a fox from a buffalo. They understand the +difference between fire and water. No Paleface sage needs to come from +the rising sun to tell them to eat when they are hungry--to drink when +they are dry. But this Paleface chief comes with the eyes of the great +northern owl, and says he comes to do us good. And how does he begin to +do us good?" + +Here there was a very decided "Waugh!" as though to say, "Ay, that's the +question," and then a solemn pause for more--during which the man with +the cold drew the reins very tight. + +"How does he begin to do us good?" proceeded the orator. "By entering +into an agreement with _us_ for the use of _our_ lands--and asking our +enemies the Saulteaux to take part in that agreement!" + +The sounds of indignation and ferocity that followed this statement are +not translatable. After a gaze of unutterable meaning round the circle +Rednose went on-- + +"This, _this_ is the way in which the owl-eyed chief of the Palefaces +begins to do us good! If this is the way he begins, in what way will he +continue, and,"--here his voice deepened to a whisper--"_how will he +end_?" + +The ideas suggested by his question were so appalling that for some +minutes the orator appeared unable to find words to go on, and his +audience glared at him in dread anticipation, as though they expected +him to explode like a bomb-shell, but were prepared to sit it out and +take the consequences. And he did explode, after a fashion, for he +suddenly raised his voice to a shout that startled even the sentinel on +the distant knoll, and said-- + +"I counsel war to the knife! The great white chief--the owl-eyed +fool!--will not blot from our agreement the names of the Saulteaux +chiefs--chiefs! there are no Saulteaux chiefs. All their braves are +cowards, on the same dead level of stupidity, and their women are--are +nothing, fit for nothing, can do nothing, and must soon come to nothing! +What then? The duty of Cree warriors lies before us. We will drive +the Saulteaux into Lake Winnipeg and the Palefaces off the face of the +earth altogether! Waugh!" + +Having thus given vent to the opinions and feelings that consumed him, +Rednose sat down, his audience breathed freely, the distant sentinel +recovered his composure, and the young novitiate brave with the cold in +his head sneezed with impunity. + +It would be tedious to recount all that was said at that council of war. +The next brave that rose to "address the house" very much resembled the +first speaker, both in sentiment and personal appearance, except that he +had chosen sky-blue for his nose instead of red. The only additional +matter that he contributed worth noting was the advice that they should +begin their bloody work by an immediate attack, in the dead of night, on +the camp of the buffalo runners. + +This advice was hailed with a good many "Waughs," as well as approving +nods and looks, and it seemed as if the plan were about to be carried +into action without delay, when, as we have seen, Okematan arose to +address the assemblage. + +Okematan was a great chief--much greater in the estimation of his tribe +than the whites with whom he had been associating in Red River were +aware of. He had purposely reserved his address till near the +conclusion. + +"The Cree warriors," he said, with an air of quiet dignity that was far +more effective than the more energetic tones and gestures of the +previous speakers, "know very well that the Cree nation considers itself +the wisest in creation. Far be it from Okematan to say otherwise, for +he does not know. Okematan is a child! His eyes are only beginning to +open!" + +He paused at this point, and looked round with solemn dignity; and the +braves, unaccustomed to such self-depreciative modes of address, gazed +at him with equal solemnity, not unmingled with surprise, though the +latter feeling was carefully concealed. + +"When the last great palaver of the Cree braves was held on the +Blue-Pine Ridge," continued Okematan, "the chiefs chose me to go to Red +River, and learn all that I could find out about the Palefaces and their +intentions. I went, as you know. I attached myself to a family named +Daa-veed-sin, and I have found out--found out much about the Palefaces-- +much more that I did not know before, though I _am_ a chief of the Cree +nation." + +Okematan looked pointedly at Rednose as he said this. After a brief +pause he continued-- + +"The great white chief," (meaning Lord Selkirk), "is _not_ a fool. It +is true that he is not a god; he is a man and a Paleface, subject to the +follies and weaknesses of the Palefaces, and not quite so wise as it is +possible to be, but he is a good man, and wishes well to the Indian. I +have found weaknesses among the Palefaces. One of them is that their +chiefs plan--sometimes wisely, sometimes foolishly--but they leave the +carrying out of their plans to other men, and sometimes these other men +care for nobody but themselves. They tell lies, they mislead the great +white chief, and tell him to do what is wrong. + +"So it was when our agreement came to be made. The great white chief +found, when he came to Red River, a few families of Saulteaux whom we +had permitted to hunt on our lands. He thought the land belonged to the +Saulteaux as well as to the Crees. He was mistaken, ignorant; he knew +no better, and the Palefaces who did know, did not put light into him; +so the names of Saulteaux chiefs were put in the writing. Then the +great white chief went away across the great salt lake to the lands of +the rising sun, leaving his small chiefs to carry out his plans. Some +of these are _very_ small chiefs, unfit to carry out any plans. Others +are bad small chiefs, that will carry out only such plans as are sure to +benefit themselves. It is these men with whom we have to deal. It is +these who deserve to be swept off the face of the earth." + +A number of emphatic nods and "waughs" at this point showed that +Okematan had at last touched a key-note with which his braves could +shout in harmony. + +"But," resumed the chief impressively, "we cannot sweep them off the +earth; we cannot even sweep them off the banks of Red River. We might +easily sweep the Saulteaux into Lake Winnipeg if we thought it worth +while to try, but the Palefaces--never! Okematan has travelled far to +the south and seen the Palefaces there. They cannot be counted. They +swarm like our locusts; they darken the earth as our buffaloes darken +the plains. They live in stone wigwams. I have seen one of their +wigwams that was big enough to hold all the Crees' wigwams bundled +together. If we killed or scalped all the Palefaces in Red River the +great white chief would come over the great salt lake with an army that +would swallow us up as the buffalo swallows up a tuft of grass. + +"Besides," continued Okematan, with a slight touch of pathos in his +tone, "there are good and bad men among the Palefaces, just as there are +good and bad among ourselves. I have dwelt for many moons with a tribe +called Scosh-min. Okematan loves the Scosh-min. They speak a wonderful +language, and some of them are too fond of fire-water; but their braves +fear nothing, and their squaws are pretty and work hard--almost as hard +as our squaws--though they are not quite as good-looking as ours. They +are too white--their faces are like buffalo fat!" + +A "Waugh," which might be translated "Hear, hear," greeted this +statement of opinion. + +"Now," continued our chief, "if we swept away all the people of Red +River, we would sweep away the good Scosh-min, which would be foolish, +and we would gain nothing in the end, but would bring worse trouble on +our heads. My counsel, therefore, is for peace. I advise that we +should let the buffalo runners and the people of Red River alone; send a +message with our grievances to the great white chief; ask him to come +back over the great salt lake to put things right, and, in the meantime, +wait with patience; attend to our own business; hunt, fish, eat, drink, +sleep, and be happy." + +Having delivered his harangue, Okematan sat down amid murmurs of mingled +applause and disapprobation. It was evident that he had created a +serious division of opinion in the camp, and it seemed as if on the +impression made by the next speaker would depend the great question of +peace or war. + +Presently an old warrior arose, and a profound silence followed, for +they held him in great respect. + +"My braves," said the old man sententiously, "I have lived long, and my +fighting days are nearly over. If wisdom has not accumulated on my head +it must be my own fault, for I have had great experience both of war and +peace--more of war, perhaps, than of peace. And the opinion that I have +come to after long and very deep consideration is this: if there is +something to fight for, fight--fight well; if there is nothing to fight +for, don't fight--don't fight at all." + +The old man paused, and there were some "Waughs" of approval, for the +truth contained in his profound conclusion was obvious even to the +stupidest Red-skin of the band--supposing that a stupid brave among +Crees were possible! + +"I have also lived to see," continued the old man, "that revenge is +nothing--nothing at all, and therefore not worth fighting for." + +As this was flying straight in the face of the most cherished of +Red-skins' beliefs, it was received in dead though respectful silence. + +"My young braves do not believe this. I know it. I have been young +myself, and I remember well how pleasant revenge was to me, but I soon +found that the pleasure of revenge did not last. It soon passed away, +yet the deed of revenge did not pass away, and sometimes the deed became +to my memory very bitter--insomuch that the pleasantness was entirely +swallowed up and forgotten in the bitterness. My young braves will not +believe this, I know. They go on feeling; they think on feeling; they +reason on feeling; they trust to feeling. It is foolish, for the brain +was given to enable man to think and judge and plan. You are as foolish +as if you were to try to smell with your mouth and eat with your nose. +But it is the way of youth. When experience teaches, then you will come +to know that revenge is not worth fighting for--its pleasantness will +pass away, but the bitter it leaves behind will never pass away. + +"What is the meaning of revenge?" continued this analytical old savage. +"What is the use of it? Does it not mean that we give up all hope of +getting what we want, and wildly determine to get what pleasure is still +possible to us by killing those who have thwarted us? And when you have +killed and got all the pleasure there is, what does it come to? Your +enemy is dead, and scalped. What then? He does not know that he is +dead. He does not care that he is dead and scalped. You cannot keep +him alive for ever killing and scalping him. But you have made his wife +and children miserable. What of that? It was not his wife and children +who opposed you, therefore you have revenged yourself on the wrong +persons. He does not know that you have rendered his wife and children +miserable, and does not care; therefore, I ask, why are you pleased? If +your enemy was a good man, your revenge has only done him a kindness, +for it has sent him to the happy hunting grounds before his time, where +you will probably never meet him to have the pleasure of being revenged +on him there. If he was a bad man, you have sent him to the world of +Desolation, where he will be waiting to receive you when you get there, +and where revenge will be impossible, for men are not allowed to kill or +scalp there. At least if they are I never heard of it--and I am an old +man now. + +"There is nothing, then, to fight for with the Palefaces of Red River, +and my counsel is, like that of Okematan, that we should decide on +peace--not war." + +Whatever may have been the private opinion of the braves as to this new +and very unexpected style of address, the effect of it was pacific; for, +after a little more palaver, the peace-party carried the day--or, rather +the night--and, next morning, the Cree warriors went back to their tents +and hunting avocations, leaving Okematan to return to the camp of his +friends the buffalo runners. + + + +CHAPTER SIXTEEN. + +AN EVENING IN THE CAMP. + +It was daybreak when Fergus McKay galloped into camp with the startling +news that an attack by hostile Indians might be expected that day or the +following night. He was, of course, unaware of the fact that the +peace-making Okematan had been unwittingly following his tracks at a +more leisurely pace. + +Some readers may think that the Indian, with his traditional power of +following a trail, should have observed and suspected the fresh track of +the hunter, but it must be remembered that some hundreds of buffalo +runners had passed over the same track a day or two previously, and that +Hawkeye, or Pathfinder himself, would have become helpless in the midst +of such trampled confusion. Besides, Okematan had no reason to suspect +that he had been followed; still less that the camp of the war-party had +been accidentally discovered. + +"Now, boys," said Fergus, after detailing his adventures during the +night, "we will hev to give up all notion o' buffalo runnin' this day +an' putt the camp in a state o' defence." + +There was a good deal of grumbling at this, especially among some of the +younger men; for they were very keen to commence the sport, and had not +much belief in the power of a small band of savages to do them harm. +Some of them even suggested that half of their number should remain +behind to guard the camp while the other half should go after the +buffalo. This proposal, however, was not received with favour, as it +would certainly be a matter of disagreement which half was to go out, +and which to remain behind! + +"Where is Kateegoose?" asked Dechamp at this crisis. + +"Stuffin' 'imself, of course!" said Fred Jenkins, amid a general laugh. +"I've noticed, since we set sail on this trip, that Kateegoose always +turns out at daybreak, lights the galley fire, an' begins the dooties o' +the day by stuffin' 'imself." + +"Ay, and I've noticed," observed one of the young hunters, "that it +takes a deal o' stuffin' to fill him out properly, for he keeps on at it +most part o' the day." + +"Except," remarked another, "when he stops to smoke what o' the stuffin' +has been already shoved down." + +"Moreover," added the seaman, "I've noticed that Francois La Certe +always keeps 'im company. He's a sympathetic sort o' man is Francois, +fond o' helpin' his mates--specially when they're eatin' an' smokin'." + +At this moment Kateegoose, having been called, came forward. He was an +ill-favoured savage, with various expressions on his ugly visage which +were not so much Nature's gifts as the result of his own evil passions. +Jealousy was one of them, and he had often turned a green eye on +Okematan. There were indications about his mouth and fingers, as he +came forward, that justified the commentaries on his habits, and +betrayed recent acquaintance with fat pork. + +"You hear the reports that have just been brought in?" said Dechamp. + +"Kateegoose hears," was the laconic answer. + +"Kateegoose is a Cree," continued Dechamp; "he knows the spirit that +dwells in the hearts of his tribe. What does he think?" + +"The thoughts of the Indian are many and deep. He has for many moons +watched the behaviour of Okematan, and he has long suspected that the +heart of the serpent dwells in the breast of that chief. Now he is +sure." + +"But what about your people?" demanded the camp-chief. "They are not at +war with us. Are they all villains because one among them turns out to +be bad?" + +Kateegoose drew himself up with a look of dignity, and pouted his greasy +lips as he replied-- + +"The Crees have always been a brave and true and upright people. They +never attack friends until, by their conduct, these friends have become +enemies. But the Crees are human. They are not perfect--neither are +the Palefaces. There are bad men among them--a few; not many--as well +as young men and foolish. Sometimes, when on the war-path, a clever bad +man can reason with them till he blinds them, and they are ready to do +wrong. It may be so now. Okematan is clever. Kateegoose does not know +what to advise." + +"Kateegoose was not asked to advise," returned Dechamp sternly. "He may +return to his tent." + +Thus summarily dismissed, this hanger-on or camp-follower returned to +his pork and pipe with a feeling that somehow he had failed to make the +exact impression on the leader that he desired. La Certe, however, +consoled him, and helped him to continue the duties of the day. + +"Come with me, McKay," said Dechamp, after giving all needful directions +regarding the safety of the camp. "I don't believe that rascal +Kateegoose. He's a greedy idler, something like La Certe, but by no +means so harmless or good-natured. Moreover, I find it hard to believe +that Okematan has turned traitor." + +"I agree with you," said Fergus. "It iss ferry hard to believe that a +man who has been so long among us, and got such a good character, should +suddenly turn against us--an' that, too, without provocation. But what +will you be sayin' to what Taniel and myself has seen with our two +eyes?" + +"It looks bad, I confess," answered Dechamp, as they paced to and fro in +a retired part of the camp; "but you must remember that your two eyes +are not your two ears, and that you heard nothing that you could +understand." + +"Fery true, Dechamp. But the language of the eye is sometimes as clear +and understandable as the language of the ear. No wan could mistake the +meanin' o' some o' the warriors when they scowled an' pointed in the +direction of our camp here, an' gripped the handles o' their scalpin' +knives and tomahawks. Moreover, Okematan also pointed in the same +direction, though I am bound to say he did not grip his knife. Whether +he scowled or not I do not know, for he was standin' wi' his back to +us." + +"Well, I cannot tell. I'm not willin' to believe Okematan a traitor; +but what you have seen is enough to make me put the camp in defence +instead of startin' out to hunt--" + +At that moment the sharp click of a gun was heard as a neighbouring +sentry put his piece on full cock. + +Dechamp and Fergus hastened towards him. + +"Have a care, Andre; don't be too quick with your gun," said the former. +"I see only one man coming. He can do us no harm." + +As the approaching figure drew near, it was seen to be that of an Indian +on horseback. He rode carelessly at a jog-trot. + +"It looks like Okematan!" said Dechamp, glancing at his companion in +surprise. + +"It iss Okematan," returned Fergus. + +Before another word could be spoken, a shot was heard in the camp, and +horse and man were seen to roll upon the ground. The latter rose +immediately, but the horse lay stiff--evidently shot dead. For a few +seconds profound silence followed the incident, as if men were too much +taken by surprise to think and act. Then, when the dismounted Indian +was seen to walk leisurely, as if unhurt, towards them, there was a +hubbub in the camp, while men, women, and boys ran towards the spot +whence the shot seemed to have been fired, but no one was to be found +there. Only a very faint puff of smoke overhead told where the marksman +had stood. It had been a well-chosen spot, where a low bush or two +mingled with several carts that had been rather carelessly drawn up, and +several horses had been picketed together. These had afforded +concealment enough for at least a few moments. + +The tent of La Certe was not far from this corner. At the time the shot +was heard, the self-indulgent half-breed was inside, recumbent on his +back in the enjoyment of a pipe. + +"That's odd," he said to Slowfoot, who was seated opposite to her lord +scraping the remnants of something out of a tin kettle with the point of +a scalping-knife. "Somebody's gun gone off by accident, I suppose. I +hear some one at our fire. Look out, Slowfoot, and ask what has +happened." + +Slowfoot finished the scraping of the kettle before obeying; then lifted +the curtain that closed the opening of their tent, and peeped out. + +"It is Kateegoose--loading his gun, I think." + +La Certe got up, with a sigh of regret at the necessity for exertion, +and, lifting the curtain-door, stepped out. + +"What are they firing at, Kateegoose?" + +The Indian did not know. Some one, he thought, might have let off his +gun by accident. He thought it wise, however, to be ready, and had just +sent the ramrod down the barrel of his gun to make sure that it was +loaded with ball. To make still surer that all was ready, the Indian +shook the priming out of the pan of his gun, wiped it, and re-primed. +Then he laid the weapon down by his side, and resumed the pipe which he +had apparently laid down to enable him to perform these operations more +conveniently, and, at the same time, with more safety. + +At that moment Dechamp walked smartly towards the fire in front of La +Certe's tent. + +"Does Kateegoose know who fired that shot?" he asked with a keen glance, +for his suspicions had been aroused. + +"Some one over there," answered the Indian languidly, as he pointed in +the right direction. + +"It does not need a medicine-man to tell me that," said Dechamp, +sternly. "I heard the shot, and saw the smoke. Have you any idea who +fired it, La Certe?" + +"I have not," replied the half-breed. "I was lying in my tent when I +heard it. Kateegoose was smoking beside the fire. We both thought it +was an accident, or some one trying his gun, till we heard the shouting +and running. Then I jumped up, seized my gun, and sprang out to see +what it was all about. I found Kateegoose equally on the _qui vive_. +He was shoving his ramrod down to make sure his gun was loaded when you +came up. What is it all about?" + +"Only that the horse of Okematan has been shot under him by some one, +and that there is a would-be murderer in the camp." + +"Okematan! Has the traitor ventured to return?" exclaimed Kateegoose, +with an expression of surprise that was very unusual in an Indian. + +"Ay, he has ventured," responded Dechamp, "and some one has ventured to +fire at him with intent to kill. By good luck he was a bad shot. He +missed the man, though he hit and killed the horse. But I shall find +the rascal out before long--he may depend on that!" + +So saying, the commandant left the spot. + +"Do you know anything about this?" asked La Certe, turning full on the +Indian. + +"Kateegoose is not a medicine-man. He cannot be in two places at once. +He knows nothing." + +For a sly man La Certe was wonderfully credulous. He believed the +Indian, and, returning to his tent, lay down again to finish the +interrupted pipe. + +"Kateegoose was trying his gun to see if it was loaded," he said to his +better half. + +"That's a lie," returned Slowfoot, with that straightforward simplicity +of diction for which she was famous. + +"Indeed! What, then, was he doing, my Slowfoot?" + +"He was _loading_ his gun--not trying it." + +"Are you sure?" + +"Am I sure that our little child loves tobacco?" + +"Well, I suppose you are. At any rate, the child often asks you for a +pipe, and gets it too. Hm! if Kateegoose fired that shot he must be a +bad man. But our chief is sure to find it out--and--it is no business +of mine. Fetch me the tobacco, Slowfoot." + +That same morning, Archie Sinclair was seated beside his brother, Little +Bill, in the tent that was shared by Fred Jenkins and several young +half-breeds. He was alone with his brother, Jenkins having gone out +with the blunderbuss to assist, if need be, in the defence of the camp. +He was manufacturing a small bow for his brother to amuse himself with +while he should be away "seein' the fun," as he said, with the hunters. +The instant the sailor left, however, he looked at Billie mysteriously +and said, in a low voice-- + +"Little Bill, although you're not good for much with your poor little +body, you've got a splendid headpiece, and are amazing at giving advice. +I want advice just now very bad. You've heard what they've all been +saying about this shot that was fired at Okematan, and some o' the men +say they think it must have been Kateegoose that did it. Now, Billie, I +am _sure_ that it was Kateegoose that did it." + +"Oh!" exclaimed Little Bill, making his eyes and mouth into three round +O's. "How d'ye know that? Did you see him do it?" + +"No--it's that that bothers me. If I had seen him do it I would have +gone straight and told Dechamp, but I didn't quite see him, you see. I +was in Lamartine's cart at the time, rummagin' about for a piece o' wood +to make this very bow, an' the moment I heard the shot I peeped out, an' +saw--nothing!" + +"That wasn't much," remarked Little Bill, innocently. + +"Ay, but I soon saw something," continued Archie, with increasing +solemnity; "I saw Kateegoose coming slinking round among the carts, as +if he wanted not to be seen. I saw him only for a moment--gliding past +like a ghost." + +"It's a serious thing," said Little Bill, musing gravely, "to charge a +man with tryin' to kill another man, if that's all you've got to tell, +for you know it's a way the Red-skins have of always glidin' about as if +they was for ever after mischief." + +"But that's not all, Little Bill," returned his brother, "for I'm almost +certain that I saw a little smoke comin' out o' the muzzle of his gun as +he passed--though I couldn't exactly swear to it." + +Archie had overrated his brother's powers in the way of advice, for, +although they talked the matter over for some time, they failed to +arrive at any satisfactory conclusion. + +Meanwhile Okematan, having entered the camp, was met by Dechamp, and led +by him to a retired part. + +"You have an enemy here, Okematan," he said, inquiringly. + +"It would seem so," returned the Indian gravely. "Friends do not shoot +each other's horses; and if the poor horse had not tossed his head when +the shot was fired, his rider would have bit the dust." + +"I fear it looks something like that," said Dechamp; "but I hope +Okematan believes that _I_ know nothing of the matter--nor can I tell +who the cowardly villain is that did it." + +"Okematan knows that," answered the Indian, sternly. "No half-breed +fired the shot." + +"There is no Indian in the camp but Kateegoose," rejoined the other, +quickly; "surely you don't think that a man of your own tribe would try +to kill you?" + +"I know not. Kateegoose hates me. No other man in the camp hates me." + +"It is strange--unaccountable," returned Dechamp. "If the Indian did +it, he shall forfeit his horse and leave the camp. But tell me,"--here +the half-breed commandant turned a searching gaze on his companion, "why +did Okematan leave us, and spend all night alone on the prairie? Did he +spend the night in conversation with the buffalo--or in the company of +his departed forefathers?" + +No sign of surprise, or of any other emotion, was visible on the +countenance of the Red-man as he replied: "Okematan went out to meet a +party of his tribe on the war-path." + +Dechamp was not so successful in concealing his own surprise at this +answer. + +"Does the Cree chief," he asked, with something of doubt in his tone and +look, "choose the hours of night to consult with warriors about secret +assaults and surprises on friends?" + +"He does not!" answered the Indian, decidedly but calmly--though he was +unquestionably astonished at being questioned so pointedly and correctly +as to his recent proceedings, and felt that he must have been followed. +He was not the man, however, to betray his feelings, or to commit +himself in any way; therefore he took refuge in silence. + +"Come now, Okematan," said his companion in a confidential tone. "Don't +let a misunderstanding arise between you and me. What is this that I +have heard? You spent last night, as you admit, with a party of Crees +on the war-path. You were seen and heard, and the men of the camp think +you have turned traitor, and they are even now expecting an attack from +this war-party. Is it true that we are to be attacked?" + +"You say I was _heard_," answered the Indian, looking the half-breed +straight in the face. "If so, those who heard must know what I said." + +"Nay, they did indeed hear, but they did not understand, for they know +not your language; but they know the language of signs, and, by the +looks and gestures of the warriors, they guessed what was said and +planned." + +"Is it likely," asked the Indian in a low voice, "that Okematan would +return to your camp alone, and put himself in your power, if an attack +was intended?" + +"True, true," returned Dechamp with a hearty air; "and, to say truth, I +myself did not--do not--believe you false. If you tell me the truth, +Okematan, and give me your word that this report is a mistaken one, I +will believe you and trust you." + +The Indian seemed pleased with the assurance thus heartily given, but +still maintained his dignified gravity, as he said-- + +"Okematan _always_ tells the truth. He had hoped that the folly of some +young braves of his tribe should never have been known to any one; but +since it has been found out, he will tell all he knows to his pale-faced +brother." + +Hereupon he related all that had transpired at the council of war, and +the final success of his own speech, with that of the old warrior, in +producing a peaceful solution. + +"But are you sure they will follow your advice?" asked Dechamp. + +"Yes, Okematan is quite sure." + +"Well, then, as I said, I will trust you," returned Dechamp, extending +his hand, which the Indian gravely grasped; "and I will give you +undeniable proof, by giving my young men orders to start after the +buffalo at once--without further delay." + + + +CHAPTER SEVENTEEN. + +THE BUFFALO-HUNT. + +In accordance with the assurance given to Okematan Antoine Dechamp at +once gave orders to make preparation for an immediate start after the +buffalo--much to the satisfaction of the hunters, especially the young +ones. + +Buffaloes--or, to speak more correctly, bisons--roamed over the North +American prairies at the time we write of in countless thousands; for +the Indians, although extremely wasteful of animal life, could not keep +their numbers down, and the aggressive white-man, with his deadly gun +and rifle, had only just begun to depopulate the plains. Therefore the +hunters had not to travel far before coming up with their quarry. + +In a very brief space of time they were all drawn up in line under +command of their chosen leader, who, at least up to the moment of giving +the signal for attack, kept his men in reasonably good order. They had +not ridden long when the huge ungainly bisons were seen like black +specks on the horizon. + +Still the horsemen--each armed with the muzzle-loading, +single-barrelled, flint-lock gun of the period--advanced cautiously, +until so near that the animals began to look up as if in surprise at the +unwonted intrusion on their great solitudes. + +Then the signal was given, the horses stretched out at the gallop, the +buffalo began to run--at first heavily, as if great speed were +impossible to them; but gradually the pace increased until it attained +to racing speed. Then the hunters gave the rein to their eager steeds, +and the long line rushed upon the game like a tornado of centaurs. + +From this point all discipline was at an end. Each man fought for his +own hand, killing as many animals as he could, so that ere long the +plain was strewn with carcases, and the air filled with gunpowder smoke. + +We have said that all the hunters set out, but this is not strictly +correct, for three were left behind. One of these had fallen sick; one +had sprained his wrist, and another was lazy. It need scarcely be told +that the lazy one was Francois La Certe. + +"There is no hurry," he said, when the hunters were assembling for the +start; "plenty of time. My horse has not yet recovered from the +fatigues of the journey. And who knows but the report of the buffalo +being so near may be false? I will wait and see the result. To-morrow +will be time enough to begin. Then, Slowfoot, you will see what I can +do. Your hands shall be busy. We will load our cart with meat and +pemmican, pay off all our debts, and spend a happy winter in Red River. +What have you got there in the kettle?" + +"Pork," answered Slowfoot with characteristic brevity. + +"Will it soon be ready?" + +"Soon." + +"Have you got the tea unpacked?" + +"Yes." + +"Send me your pipe." + +This latter speech was more in the tone of a request than a command, and +the implied messenger from the opposite side of the fire was the baby-- +Baby La Certe. We never knew its name, if it had one, and we have +reason to believe that it was a female baby. At the time, baby was +quite able to walk--at least to waddle or toddle. + +A brief order from the maternal lips sent Baby La Certe toddling round +the fire towards its father, pipe in hand; but, short though the road +was, it had time to pause and consider. Evidently the idea of justice +was strongly developed in that child. Fair wage for fair work had +clearly got hold of it, for it put the pipe which was still alight, in +its mouth and began to draw! + +At this the father smiled benignly, but Slowfoot made a demonstration +which induced a rather prompt completion of the walk without a +reasonable wage. It sucked vigorously all the time, however, being +evidently well aware that Francois was not to be feared. + +At that moment the curtain of the tent lifted, and little Bill Sinclair +limped in. He was a favourite with La Certe, who made room for him, and +at once offered him the pipe, but Billie declined. + +"No, thank you, La Certe. I have not learned to smoke yet." + +"Ha! you did not begin young enough," said the half-breed, glancing +proudly at his own offspring. + +We may explain here once for all that, although he had lived long enough +in the colony to understand French, Billie spoke to his friend in +English, and that, although La Certe understood English, he preferred to +speak in French. + +"What have you been doing?" he asked, when the boy had seated himself. + +"I've been shooting at a mark with my bow and arrow--brother Archie made +it for me." + +"Let me see--yes, it is very well made. Where is brother Archie?" + +"Gone after the buffalo." + +"What!--on a horse?" + +"He could not go very well after them on foot--could he?" replied the +boy quietly. "Dan Davidson lent him a horse, but not a gun. He said +that Archie was too young to use a gun on horseback, and that he might +shoot some of the people instead of the buffalo, or burst his gun, or +fall off. But _I_ don't think so. Archie can do anything. I know, for +I've seen him do it." + +"And so he has left you in camp all by yourself. What a shame, Billie!" + +"No, Francois, it is not a shame. Would you have me keep him from the +fun just because I can't go? _That_ would indeed be a shame, wouldn't +it?" + +"Well, perhaps you're right, Billie." + +"I know I'm right," returned the boy, with a decision of tone that would +have been offensive if it had not been accompanied with a look of +straightforward gentleness that disarmed resentment. "But, I say, +Francois, why are you not out with the rest?" + +"Oh, because--because--Well, you know, my horse is tired, and--and, I'm +not quite sure that the buffalo really have been seen as near as they +say. And I can go to-morrow just as well. You see, Billie, there is no +need to hurry oneself." + +"No, I don't see that. I think there's always need for hurry, specially +with men like you. I know the reason you don't go out better than +yourself, Francois." + +"Yes--what is it?" asked the half-breed with a slight laugh. + +"It's laziness. That's what it is, and you should be ashamed of +yourself." + +The large mild eyes and low voice, and pale earnest face of the +plain-spoken invalid were such that it would have been impossible for +any one to be offended with him, much less La Certe, whose spirit of +indignation it was almost impossible to arouse. He winced a little at +the home-thrust, however, because he knew it to be true. + +"You're hard on me, Little Bill," he said with a benignant look, as he +picked a stick from the fire and inserted its glowing end in his pipe. + +"No, I'm not hard," returned the boy gravely. Indeed he was always +grave, and seldom laughed though he sometimes smiled faintly at the +jokes and quips of his volatile brother and Fred Jenkins the seaman: +"I'm not half hard enough," he continued; "I like you, Francois, and +that's the reason why I scold you and try to get you to mend. I don't +think there's such a lazy man in the whole Settlement as you. You would +rather sit and smoke and stuff yourself with pork all day than take the +trouble to saddle your horse and get your gun and go out with the rest. +Why are you so lazy, Francois?" + +"I'm sure I don't know, Little Bill, unless it be that I'm born to be +lazy. Other people are born, I suppose, to be active and energetic. +They like activity and energy, and so they do it. I like repose and +quiet, and--so I do that. Not much difference after all! We both do +what we like best!" + +Little Bill was perplexed. Although philosophical in tendency he had +not had sufficient experience in sophistical reasoning to enable him to +disentangle the sinuosities of bad logic. But he was a resolute little +fellow, and not easily quelled. + +"What would happen," he asked, "if everybody in the world did as you +do?" + +"Well, I suppose everybody would enjoy themselves. There would be no +more fightings or wars, or any trouble of that sort, if everybody would +only take things easy and smoke the pipe of peace." + +"Hm! I don't know about that," returned the boy, doubtfully; "but I'm +quite sure there would not be much pemmican in Red River this winter if +all the hunters were like you. I wonder you're not ashamed, Francois. +Sometimes I think that you're not worth caring about; but I can't help +it, you know--we can't force our likings one way or other." + +La Certe was a good deal taken aback. He was not indeed unaccustomed to +plain speaking, and to the receipt of gratuitous abuse; but his +experience invariably was to associate both with more or less of a stern +voice and a frowning brow. To receive both in a soft voice from a +delicate meek-faced child, who at the same time professed to like him, +was a complete novelty which puzzled him not a little. + +After a few minutes' profound consideration, he put out his pipe and +arose quickly with something like an appearance of firmness in his look +and bearing. + +Slowfoot, whose utter ignorance of both French and English prevented her +understanding the drift of the recent conversation, was almost startled +by the unfamiliar action of her lord. + +"Where go you?" she asked. + +"To follow the buffalo," answered La Certe, with all the dignity of a +man bursting with good resolutions. + +"Are you ill?" asked his wife, anxiously. + +To this he vouchsafed no reply, as he raised the curtain and went out. + +Little Bill also went out, and, sitting down on a package, watched him +with his large solemn eyes, but said never a word until the half-breed +had loaded his gun and mounted his horse. Then he said: "Good luck to +you, Francois!" + +La Certe did not speak, but with a grave nod of his head rode slowly out +of the camp. Little Bill regarded him for a moment. He had his bow and +a blunt-headed arrow in his hand at the time. Fitting the latter +hastily to the bow he took a rapid shot at the retreating horseman. The +arrow sped well. It descended on the flank of the horse with +considerable force, and, bounding off, fell to the ground. The result +was that the horse, to La Certe's unutterable surprise, made a sudden +demivolt into the air--without the usual persuasion--almost unseated its +rider, and fled over the prairie like a thing possessed! + +A faint smile ruffled the solemnity of Little Bill at this, but it +vanished when he heard a low chuckle behind him. Wheeling round, he +stood face to face with Slowfoot, whose mouth was expanded from ear to +ear. + +"Clever boy!" she said, patting him on the back, "come into the tent and +have some grub." + +She said this in the Cree language, which the boy did not understand, +but he understood well enough the signs with which the invitation was +accompanied. Thanking her with an eloquent look, he re-entered the tent +along with her. + + + +CHAPTER EIGHTEEN. + +ADVENTURES OF ARCHIE AND THE SEAMAN. + +Meanwhile the buffalo-hunt progressed favourably, and the slaughter of +animals was considerable. + +But there were two members of that hunt whose proceedings were not in +exact accord with the habits and laws of the chase, as usually conducted +on the Red River plains. These were the seaman Jenkins and Archie +Sinclair. + +A mutual attachment having sprung up between these two, they had +arranged to keep together during the chase; and when the signal for +attack was given by Dechamp, as before related, they had "set sail," +according to Jenkins, fairly well with the rest. But they had not gone +more than a few hundred yards when the boy observed that his nautical +friend was hauling at both reins furiously, as if desirous of stopping +his horse. Having a gun in one hand he found the operation difficult. + +Archie therefore reined in a little. + +"Bad luck to it!" growled Jenkins, as his young friend drew near, "the +jaws o' this craft seem to be made o' cast-iron, but I'll bring him to +if I should haul my arms out o' the sockets. Heave-to, my lad! Maybe +he'll be willin' to follow a good example." + +Archie pulled up, and, as the seaman had hoped, the hard-mouthed steed +stopped, while the maddened buffalo and the almost as much maddened +hunters went thundering on, and were soon far ahead of them. + +"What's wrong, Jenkins?" asked Archie, on seeing the sailor dismount. + +"Not much, lad; only I want to take a haul at the main brace. Here, +hold my gun a bit, like a good chap; the saddle, you see, ain't all +right, an' if it was to slew round, you know, I'd be overboard in a +jiffy. There, that's all right. Now, we'll up anchor, an' off again. +I know now that the right way to git on board is by the port side. When +I started from Red River I was goin' to climb up on the starboard side, +but Dan Davidson kep' me right--though he had a good laugh at me. All +right now. Hand me the gun." + +"Do you mean to say, Jenkins, that you never got on a horse till you +came to Red River?" asked Archie, with a laugh, as they galloped off in +pursuit of the hunters, who were almost out of sight by that time. + +"Well, you've no occasion to laugh, lad," returned the seaman. "I've +bin at sea ever since I was a small shaver, scarce half as long as a +handspike, so I ain't had many opportunities, d'ee see, for we don't +have cavalry at sea, as a rule--always exceptin' the horse marines. + +"Then I'm afraid you'll find runnin' the buffalo somewhat difficult," +returned the boy. "Not that I know anything about it myself, for this +is the first time I've been out; an' even now Dan won't let me use a +gun; but I've often heard the men talkin' about it! an' some o' them +have complained that they have found it uncommon difficult to load when +at full gallop--specially when the horse is hard in the mouth." + +"I make no manner o' doubt you're right, lad, but I've got my sea-legs +on now, so to speak; leastwise I've got used to ridin' in the trip out +here, as well as used to steerin' wi' the tiller-ropes in front, which +seems to me right in the teeth o' natur', though I couldn't see how it +could well be otherwise. But I confess that my chief difficulty is the +ordnance, for it interferes a good deal wi' the steerin'. +Hows'ever--`never ventur' never win,' you know. I never expected to +take up a noo purfession without some trouble." + +As he spoke, the seaman's horse--a large brown chestnut--put its foot in +a hole, and plunged forward with great violence, barely escaping a fall. + +"Hold on!" shouted Archie in alarm. + +"Hold on it is!" sang out the sailor in reply. + +And hold on it was, for he had the chestnut round the neck with both +arms. Indeed he was sitting, or lying, on its neck altogether. + +"It ain't an easy job," he gasped, while he struggled to regain the +saddle, "when a fellow gets hove on to the bowsprit this way, to git +fairly back on the main-deck again. But a Jenkins never was beaten in +fair fight. That's all right. Now then, Archie, you're an obleegin' +cove. Do git down an' pick up the gun for me. You see, if I git down +it's a tryin' job to git up again--the side o' this here craft bein' so +steep an' so high out o' the water. Thank'ee; why, boy, you jump down +an' up like a powder-monkey. It ain't broke, is it?" + +"No. It seems all right," answered the boy, as he handed the gun to its +owner. "But if you let it go like that often, it won't be much worth +when the run's over." + +"Let it go, boy?" repeated the sailor. "It was either let it or myself +go, an' when it comes to a toss up o' that sort, Fred Jenkins knows how +to look arter number one." + +It will be seen from all this that our seaman was not quite so much at +home on the prairie as on the sea. Indeed, if the expression be +permissible, he was very much at sea on that undulating plain, and did +not take so kindly to the green waves of the rolling prairie as to the +heaving billows of the restless ocean; but, as Archie remarked, he was +fast getting broke in. + +The incidents which we have mentioned, however, were but the +commencement of a series of disasters to poor Jenkins, which went far to +cure him of a desire to excel in the "noo purfession," and to induce a +somewhat violent longing for a return to his first love, the ocean. + +"I can't think what ever could have made you want to come out here," +said Archie, as they continued to follow up the still distant hunters. + +"What was it made yourself want to come out, lad?" asked the sailor. + +"It wasn't me that wanted to come. It was father, you know, an' of +course I had to follow," said the boy in a tone which induced his friend +to say hastily, and in a tone of sympathy-- + +"Ah, poor lad, I forgot you was a orphing. Well, you see, I think it +must ha' bin a love o' change or a love o' discontent, or suthin' o' +that sort, as brought me cruising in these here waters, for I can't say +what else it was. You see I was born a sort o' ro-oh--" + +"Look out! a badger-hole!" shouted the boy. + +His warning would have been too late, but the chestnut fortunately +leaped over the danger instead of stumbling into it, and its rider was +only partially shaken out of his seat. + +"It's well," he said, when fairly settled down again to an easy gallop, +"that the tiller-ropes are stout else I'd ha' bin over the starn this +time instead of out on the bowsprit. Let me see, what was I sayin' of?" + +"Somethin' about your bein' born a sort of `ro-oh--,' though what _that_ +may be I haven't a notion." + +"Ah! jist so--I was born a sort o' rover (when this long-legged brute +took the badger-hole), an' I've bin to every quarter o' the globe +a'most, but if I'd lived to the age o' Methooslum I'd never ha' thought +o' comin' here,--for the good reason that I knowed nothin' o' its +existence,--if I hadn't by chance in a furrin port fallen in wi' Andre +Morel, an' took an uncommon fancy to him. You see, at the time, I was-- +well, I was no better nor I should be; p'raps a deal wuss, an' Morel he +meets me, an' says--`Hallo, my lad,' says he, `where away?' + +"I looked at him gruff-like a moment or two, for it seemed to me he was +raither too familiar for a stranger, but he's got such a pleasant, +hearty look with him--as you know--that I couldn't feel riled with 'im, +so `I'm goin' on the spree,' says I. + +"`All right,' says he, `I'm with 'ee, lad. D'ye know the town?' + +"`No more than a Mother Carey's chicken,' says I. `Come along, then,' +says he; `I'll tak' 'ee to a fust-rate shop.' + +"So off we went arm in arm as thick as two peas, an' after passin' +through two or three streets he turns into a shop that smelt strong o' +coffee. + +"`Hallo! mate,' says I, `you've made some sort o' mistake. This here +ain't the right sort o' shop.' + +"`O yes, it is,' says he, smilin', quite affable-like. `The best o' +tipple here, an' cheap too. Come along. I've got somethin' very +partikler to say to you. Look here, waiter--two cups o' coffee, hot an' +strong, some buttered toast, an' no end o' buns, etceterer.' + +"Wi' that he led me to a seat, an' we sat down. I was so took aback an' +amused that I waited to see what would foller an' what he'd got to say +that was so partikler--but, I say, Archie, them buffalo runners has got +the wind o' us, an' are showin' us their heels, I fear." + +"Never fear," returned the boy, rising in his stirrups and shading his +eyes to look ahead. "They do seem to be leavin' us a bit, but you see +by the dust that the buffalo are holdin' away to the right, so if we +keep still more to the right an' cut round that knoll, I think we'll be +safe to catch them up. They're doin' good work, as the carcasses we've +passed and the rattle o' shots clearly show. But get on wi' your story, +Jenkins." + +"Well, it ain't much of a story, lad. What Morel had to say was that +he'd arranged wi' an agent o' Lord Selkirk to come out to this country; +an' he was goin' out wi' a lot o' his relations, an' was beatin' up for +a few good hands, an' he liked the look o' me, an' would I agree to go +wi' him? + +"Well, as you may believe, this was a poser, an' I said I'd think over +it, an' let him know next day. You see, I didn't want to seem to jump +at it too eager-like, though I liked the notion, an' I had neither wife, +nor sweetheart, nor father or mother, to think about, for I'm a orphing, +you see, like yourself, Archie--only a somewhat bigger one. + +"Well, when we'd finished all the coffee, an' all the buns, an' all the +etceterers, he began to advise me not to ha' nothin' more to do wi' +grog-shops. I couldn't tell 'ee the half o' what he said--no, nor the +quarter--but he made such a impression on me that I was more than +half-convinced. To say truth, I was so choke-full o' coffee an' buns, +an' etceterers, that I don't believe I could ha' swallowed another drop +o' liquor. + +"`Where are ye goin' now?' says he, when we'd done. + +"`Back to my ship,' says I. + +"`Come an' ha' tea to-morrow wi' me an' my sister,' says he, `an' we'll +have another talk about Rupert's Land.' + +"`I will,' says I. + +"`Six o'clock, sharp,' says he. + +"`Sharp's the word,' says I. + +"An', sure enough, I went to his house sharp to time next day, an' there +I found him an' his sister. She was as pretty a craft as I ever set +eyes on, wi' a modest look an' long fair ringlets--just borderin' on +nineteen or thereaway--but you know her, Archie, so I needn't say no +more." + +"What! is that the same woman that's keeping house for him now in Red +River?" + +"Woman!" repeated the sailor, vehemently; "she's not a woman--she's a +angel is Elise Morel. Don't speak disrespectful of her, lad." + +"I won't," returned Archie with a laugh; "but what was the upshot of it +all?" + +"The upshot of it," answered the seaman, "was that I've never touched a +drop o' strong drink from that day to this, an' that I'm now blown +entirely out o' my old courses, an' am cruisin' arter the buffalo on the +plains o' Rupert's Land." + +At this point, their minds being set free from the consideration of past +history, they made the discovery that the buffalo runners were nowhere +to be seen on the horizon, and that they themselves were lost on the +grassy sea. + +"What _shall_ we do?" said the boy, when they had pulled up to consider +their situation. "You see, although I came out here a good while before +you did," he added, half apologetically, "I've never been out on the +plains without a guide, and don't know a bit how to find the way back to +camp. The prairie is almost as bad as the sea you're so fond of, with a +clear horizon all round, and nothing worth speaking of to guide us. An' +as you have never been in the plains before, of course you know nothing. +In short, Jenkins, I greatly fear that we are lost! Why, what are you +grinning at?" + +The terminal question was induced by the fact that the tall seaman was +looking down at his anxious companion with a broad smile on his handsome +sunburnt countenance. + +"So we're lost, are we, Archie?" he said, "like two sweet babes on the +prairie instead of in the woods. An' you think I knows nothin'. Well, +p'r'aps I don't know much, but you should remember, lad, that an old +salt wi' a compass in his wes'kit-pocket is not the man to lose his +reck'nin'. I've got one here as'll put us all right on that score, for +I was careful to take my bearin's when we set sail, an' I've been +keepin' an eye on our course all the way. Make your mind easy, my boy." + +So saying, the sailor pulled out the compass referred to, and consulted +it. Then he pulled out a watch of the warming-pan type, which he styled +a chronometer, and consulted that also; after which he looked up at the +clouds--seamanlike--and round the horizon, especially to windward, if we +may speak of such a quarter in reference to a day that was almost quite +calm. + +"Now, Archie, boy, the upshot o' my cogitations is that with a light +breeze on our starboard quarter, a clear sky overhead, an' a clear +conscience within, you and I had better hold on our course for a little +longer, and see whether we can't overhaul the runners. If we succeed, +good and well. If not, why, 'bout-ship, and homeward-bound is the +sailin' orders. What say 'ee, lad?" + +"I say whatever you say, Jenkins. If you're sure o' the way back, as +I've no doubt you are, why, there couldn't be greater fun than to go +after the buffalo on our own account. And--I say, look there! Isn't +that somethin' like them on the top o' the far bluff yonder? A fellow +like you, wi' sharp sailor-eyes, ought to be able to make them out." + +"You forget, lad, that I ain't a buffalo runner, an' don't know the cut +o' the brutes' jibs yet. It does look like somethin'. Come, we'll go +an' see." Putting their horses to the gallop, the two curiously matched +friends, taking advantage of every knoll and hollow, succeeded in +getting sufficiently near to perceive that a small herd was grazing +quietly in a grassy bottom between two prairie waves. They halted at +once for consultation. + +"Now, then, Archie," said the sailor, examining the priming of his gun, +"here we are at last, a-goin' to begin a pitched battle. There's this +to be said for us, that neither you nor me knows rightly how to go to +work, both on us havin' up to this time bin trained, so to speak, on +hearsay. But what o' that? In the language o' the immortial Nelson, +`England expec's every man to do his dooty.' Now it seems to me my +dooty on the present occasion is to lay myself alongside of a buffalo +an' blaze away! Isn't that the order o' battle?" + +"Yes. But don't go for a bull, and don't go too close for fear he turns +sharp round an' catches you on his horns. You know the bulls are apt to +do that sometimes." + +"Trust me, lad, I'll keep clear o' the bulls." + +"And you understand how to re-load?" asked the boy. + +"O yes, all right. Dan put me thro' the gunnery practice on the way +out, an' I went through it creditably. Only a slight hitch now and +then. Two or three balls in the mouth ready to spit into the gun--" + +"Not all at once, though, Jenkins." + +"In course not, lad: one at a time: no ramming; hit the butt on the +saddle; blaze away; one down, another come on--eh?" + +"That's it," said Archie, eager for the fray. "How I wish Dan had let +me have a gun!" + +"Safer not, lad. An' keep well in rear, for I may be apt to fire wide +in the heat of action." + +With this final caution, the mariner put his gun on full cock, shook the +reins, and trotted quietly forward until he saw that the buffalo had +observed him. Then, as he afterwards expressed it, he "clapped on all +sail-stuns'ls alow and aloft, and sky-scrapers--and went into action +like a true blue British tar, with little Archie Sinclair full sail +astern." + +He did not, however, come out of action with as much _eclat_ as he went +into it, but justice obliges us to admit that he came out victorious. + +We cannot do better than give his own description of that action as +related beside the camp-fire that night, to a circle of admiring +friends. + +"Well, you must know," he began, after finishing his supper and lighting +his pipe, "that long-legged frigate o' mine that Dan calls a chestnut-- +though a cocoanut would be more like the thing, if you take size into +account--he's as keen for the chase as a small boy arter a butterfly, +an' before I could say `Jack Robinson,' a'most, he had me into the +middle o' the herd an' alongside o' the big bull. Any one could tell it +was him, in spite o' the dust we kicked up, by reason o' the side-glance +o' his wicked little eye, his big hairy fore'id, an' his tail stickin' +out stiff like a crook'd spankerboom. + +"In course I was not a-goin' to fire into him, so I gave the frigate a +dig wi' my heels--tho' I'd got no irons on 'em--an' tried to shove up +alongside of a fat young cow as was skylarkin' on ahead. As we went +past the bull he made a vicious dab wi' his horn, and caught the frigate +on her flank--right abaft the mizzen chains, like. Whew! you should ha' +seen what a sheer she made right away to starboard! If it hadn't bin +that I was on the look-out, I'd ha' bin slap overboard that time, but I +see'd the squall comin', an', seizin' my brute's mane, held on like a +monkey wi' hand an' leg. + +"Well, before I knew where I was, the cocoan--I mean the chestnut, had +me alongside the cow. I stuck the muzzle a'most into her ribs, and let +drive. Down she went by the head, fairly scuttled, an' I could hear +young Archie givin' a wild cheer astern." + +"`That's the way to go it, Jenkins!' he yelled. `Load again.' + +"But it was easier said than done, I can tell you. You see, I've bin +brought up to cartridges all my life, an' the change to pullin' a +stopper out o' a horn wi' your teeth, pourin' the powder into your left +hand, wi' the gun under your left arm, an' the pitchin' o' the frigate, +like as if it was in a cross sea, was raither perplexin'. Hows'ever, it +had to be done, for I was alongside of another cow in a jiffy. I nigh +knocked out two o' my front teeth in tryin' to shove the stopper in my +mouth. Then, when I was pourin' the powder into my hand, I as near as +could be let fall the gun, which caused me to give a sort of gasp of +anxiety, when two o' the three bullets dropped out o' my mouth, but I +held on to the third wi' my teeth. Just then a puff o' wind blew the +powder out o' my hand into the buffalo's eyes, causin' her to bellow +like a fog-horn, an' obleegin' me to pour out another charge. I did it +hastily, as you may well believe, an' about three times what I wanted +came out. Hows'ever, I lost a deal of it in pourin' it into the gun; +then I spat the ball in, gettin' another nasty rap on the teeth as I did +so, but I'd bit the ball so that it stuck half-way down. + +"It was no time to think o' trifles. I gave the butt an extra bang on +the pommel to send the ball home, shoved the muzzle right in among the +hair an' pulled the trigger. There was a bang that sounded to me as if +the ship's magazine had blown up. It was followed by a constellation o' +fire-works and--Archie Sinclair must tell you what happened arter that, +for I misremember the whole on it. The fire-works closed the scene to +me." + +Archie, nothing loath, and with glistening eyes, took up the narrative +at this point, while the hero of the hour rekindled his pipe. + +"The fact is," he said, "the gun had burst--was blown to atoms; not a +bit o' the barrel left, and a great lump o' the stock struck Jenkins on +the head, stunned him, and tumbled him off his horse." + +"That was the magazine explosion and fire-works," explained Jenkins. + +"But the queer thing was," continued Archie, "that the buffalo fell +dead, and, on examining it, we found that a bit o' the barrel had been +driven right into its brain." + +"Ay, boy, but it was queerer still that none o' the pieces struck me or +my horse 'cept that bit o' the stock. An' I'm none the worse, barrin' +this lump on the head, that only serves to cock my hat a little more to +one side than seems becomin' to a sober-minded man." + +"We were sorry to be able to bring away so little o' the meat," said +Archie, with the gravity of an old hunter; "but, you see, it was too +late to send a cart for it after we got back." + +"Never mind," said Dan Davidson, when the narrative was brought to a +close, "you have done very well for a beginning." + +"Moreover," added Fergus, "it iss a goot feast the wolves will be havin' +on the plains this night, an' so, Archie, I'll be wishin' ye better luck +next time." + + + +CHAPTER NINETEEN. + +BRIGHT HOPES TERMINATE IN FURIOUS WAR. + +Turning once again to the colony at Red River, we introduce the reader +to the Scotch settlers in the autumn of the year--at a time when there +was some appearance of the commencement of a season of prosperity, after +all the troubles that had befallen and surrounded, and well-nigh +overwhelmed them in time past. + +The Davidson and McKay families had re-established themselves on their +farms, rebuilt their houses and planted their fields, and splendid crops +of all kinds were now flourishing, ready for spade and sickle. + +The soil was found to be excellent. In after years, forty-fold was no +uncommon return. In one case, for a bushel of barley sown, fifty-six +bushels were reaped; and from a bushel of seed potatoes were obtained +one hundred and forty-five bushels! Industry, however, had not at that +time been rewarded with such encouraging results, but there was +sufficient to indicate cheering prospects in the near future, and to +gladden the hearts of the pioneer settlers. + +As a good number of these had, under the depressing influence of +disappointment and failure in the past, neglected to sow extensively, +not a few families were forced again to winter at Pembina, and draw +their supplies from the chase to avoid consuming all the seed which +alone ensured them against famine. Among these were the Swiss families, +most of whom, being watch and clock makers, pastry-cooks, mechanics and +musicians, were not well adapted for agricultural pursuits. Perhaps +they were as ill-adapted for the chase, but seed takes time to sow and +grow, whereas animals need no prolonged nursing--at least from man--and +are quickly killed if one can shoot. + +The young leader of the Switzers, however, Andre Morel, soon left his +party at Pembina under the care of his lieutenant, and returned to Red +River Settlement, bent on mastering the details of husbandry, so as to +be able afterwards to direct the energies of his compatriots into a more +profitable occupation than the chase. + +For this purpose, he sought and obtained employment with the Davidsons +in the new and enlarged edition of Prairie Cottage. His sister, Elise, +was engaged by old McKay to act as companion and assistant to his +daughter Elspie. Both the curly-haired Andre and the fair, blue-eyed +Elise, proved to be invaluable acquisitions in the households in which +they had found a home, for both were lively, intelligent companions, +hard workers at whatever they undertook, and were possessed of sweet +melodious voices. Andre also performed on the violin, an instrument +which has played a prominent part in the wild Nor'-West ever since the +white-man set down his foot there. + +"What do you think, Elspie, of my brother's plan, of taking the farm +just below this one, after he has had enough experience to be able to +work it himself?" asked Elise. + +"It will be very nice to have him settled so near us. Do you think he +will take the whole of it?" + +"I think so. You see, the terms on which the Earl has granted the land +are so easy, and the supplies of goods, oatmeal, clothing, and farm +implements sent us so generous, that Andre finds he will have money +enough to enable him to start. Then, that strong, good-natured seaman, +Fred Jenkins, has actually agreed to serve as a man on the farm for a +whole year for nothing, except, of course, his food and lodging. Isn't +it generous of him?" + +"Do you know why he is going to serve him for nothing?" asked Elspie, +with a quick look and smile. + +"No--I do not," returned fair little Elise with an innocent look. "Do +you?" + +"O no--of course I don't; I can only guess," replied her companion with +a light laugh. "Perhaps it is because he knows his services as a farm +servant can't be worth much at first." + +"There you are wrong," returned Elise, stoutly. "No doubt he is +ignorant, as yet, about sowing and reaping and the like, but he is +wonderfully strong--just like a giant at lifting and carrying-and he has +become quite knowing about horses, and carting, and such things. All +that he stipulates for is that he shall board in our house. He says +he'll manage, somehow, to make enough money to buy all the clothes he +wants." + +"What a delightful kind of servant," said Elspie, with an arch look, +which was quite thrown away on Elise, "and so disinterested to do it +without any reason." + +"O! but he must have some reason, you know," rejoined Elise. "I +shouldn't wonder if it was out of gratitude to my brother who was very +kind to him--so he says--the first time they met." + +"Did he say that was his reason?" asked Elspie quickly. + +"No, he did not say so, but he has said more than once that he feels +very grateful to my brother, and it has just occurred to me that that +may be his reason. It would be very natural--wouldn't it?" + +"Oh, very natural!--very!" returned the other. "But d'you know, Elise, +I don't like your brother's plan at all." + +"No! why?" + +"Because, don't you see, foolish girl, that it will take you away from +me? You will, of course, want to keep house for your brother, and I +have become so used to you, short though our intercourse has been, that +I don't see how I can get on at all without you?" + +"Never mind, Elspie, dear. It will be a long while before Andre is +ready to take the farm. Besides, by that time, you know, you and Dan +will be married, so you won't miss me much--though I confess I should +like you to miss me a little." + +Elspie sighed at this point. "I suspect that our marriage will not be +so soon as you think, Elise," she said. "Dan has tried to arrange it +more than once, but there seems to be a fate against it, for something +_always_ comes in the way!" + +"Surely nothing will happen this time," said the sympathetic Elise. +"Everything begins to prosper now. The crops are beautiful; the weather +is splendid; the house is ready to begin to--all the logs are cut and +squared. Your father is quite willing, and Dan wishing for the day-- +what more could you desire, Elspie?" + +"Nothing; all seems well, but--" She finished the sentence with another +sigh. + +While the two friends were thus conversing in the dairy, old McKay and +Dan Davidson were talking on the same subject in the hall of Ben Nevis. + +"It iss a curious fact, Taniel," said the old man, with a pleased look, +"that it wass in this fery room in the old hoose that wass burnt, and +about the same time of the year, too, that you would be speakin' to me +about this fery thing. An' I do not think that we will be troubled this +time wi' the Nor'-Westers, whatever--though wan never knows what a tay +may bring furth." + +"That is the very reason, sir," said Davidson, "that I want to get +married at once, so that if anything does happen again I may claim the +right to be Elspie's protector." + +"Quite right, my boy, quite right; though I must say I would like to +wait till a real munister comes out; for although Mr Sutherland iss a +fery goot man, an' an elder too, he iss not chust exactly a munister, +you know, as I have said before. But have it your own way, Tan. If my +little lass is willin', old Tuncan McKay won't stand in your way." + +That night the inhabitants of Red River lay down to sleep in comfort and +to dream, perchance, of the coming, though long delayed, prosperity that +had hitherto so often eluded their grasp. + +Next day an event occurred which gave the poor settlers new cause for +grief amounting almost to despair. + +Dan Davidson and Elspie were walking on the verandah in front of Ben +Nevis at the time. It was a warm sunny afternoon. All around looked +the picture of peace and prosperity. + +"Does it not seem, Dan, as if all the troubles we have gone through were +a dark dream--as if there never had been any reality in them?" said +Elspie. + +"It does indeed seem so," responded Dan, "and I hope and trust that we +shall henceforth be able to think of them as nothing more than a +troubled dream." + +"What iss that you will be sayin' about troubled dreams?" asked old +McKay, coming out of the house at the moment. + +"We were just saying, daddy, that all our troubles seem--" + +"Look yonder, Tan," interrupted the old man, pointing with his pipe-stem +to a certain part of the heavens. "What iss it that I see? A queer +cloud, whatever! I don't remember seein' such a solid cloud as that in +all my experience." + +"It is indeed queer. I hope it's not what Fred Jenkins would call a +`squall brewin' up,' for that wouldn't improve the crops." + +"A squall!" exclaimed Jenkins, who chanced to come round the corner of +the house at the moment, with a spade on his shoulder. "That's never a +squall--no, nor a gale, nor a simoon, nor anything else o' the sort that +I ever heard of. Why, it's growin' bigger an' bigger!" + +He shaded his eyes with his hand, and looked earnestly at the object in +question, which did indeed resemble a very dense, yet not a black, +cloud. For some moments the four spectators gazed in silence. Then old +McKay suddenly dropped his pipe, and looked at Dan with an expression of +intense solemnity. + +"It iss my belief," he said in a hoarse whisper, "that it is them wee +deevils the grasshoppers!" + +A very few minutes proved old McKay's surmise to be correct. Once +before, the colony had been devastated by this plague, and the memory of +the result was enough to alarm the most courageous among the settlers +who had experienced the calamity, though the new arrivals, being +ignorant, were disposed to regard the visitation lightly at first. +McKay himself became greatly excited when the air became darkened by the +cloud, which, ever increasing in size, rapidly approached. + +"Haste ye, lads," he cried to some of the farm-servants who had joined +the group on the verandah, "get your spades, picks, an' shovels. Be +smart now: it is not possible to save all the crops, but we may try to +save the garden, whatever. Follow me!" + +The garden referred to was not large or of great importance, but it was +a favourite hobby of the Highlander, and, at the time, was in full +bloom, luxuriant with fruit, flower, and vegetable. To save it from +destruction at such a time, McKay would have given almost anything, and +have gone almost any lengths. On this occasion, not knowing what to do, +yet impelled by his eagerness to do something, he adopted measures that +he had heard of as being used in other lands. He ordered a trench to be +cut and filled with water on the side of his garden nearest the +approaching plague, which might--if thoroughly carried out--have been of +some use against wingless grasshoppers but could be of no use whatever +against a flying foe. It would have taken an army of men to carry out +such an order promptly, and his men perceived this; but the master was +so energetic, so violent in throwing off his coat and working with his +own hand at pick and shovel, that they were irresistibly infected with +his enthusiasm, and set to work. + +Old Duncan, did not, however, wield pick or shovel long. He was too +excited for that. He changed from one thing to another rapidly. Fires +were to be kindled along the line of defence, and he set the example in +this also. Then he remembered that blankets and other drapery had been +used somewhere with great effect in beating back the foe; therefore he +shouted wildly for his daughter and Elise Morel. + +"Here we are, father: what can we do?" + +"Go, fetch out all the blankets, sheets, table-cloths, an' towels in the +house, girls. It iss neck or nothin' this tay. Be smart, now! Take +men to help ye." + +Two men were very busy there piling up little heaps of firewood, namely, +Dan Davidson and Fred Jenkins. What more natural than that these two, +on hearing the order given about blankets and table-cloths, etcetera, +should quit the fires and follow Elspie and Elise into the house! + +In the first bedroom into which they entered they found Archie and +Billie Sinclair, the latter seated comfortably in an arm-chair close to +a window, the former wild with delight at the sudden demand on all his +energies. For Archie had been one of the first to leap to the work when +old McKay gave the order. Then he had suddenly recollected his little +helpless brother, and had dashed round to Prairie Cottage, got him on +his back, run with him to Ben Nevis Hall, placed him as we have seen in +a position to view the field of battle, and then, advising him to sit +quietly there and enjoy the fun, had dashed down-stairs to resume his +place in the forefront of battle! + +He had run up again for a moment to inquire how Little Bill was getting +on, when the blanket and sheet searchers found them. + +"All right," he exclaimed, on learning what they came for; "here you +are. Look alive! Don't stir, Little Bill!" + +He hurled the bedding from a neighbouring bedstead as he spoke, tore +several blankets from the heap, and tumbled rather than ran down-stairs +with them, while the friends he had left behind followed his example. + +By that time all the inmates and farm-servants of Prairie Cottage had +assembled at Ben Nevis Hall, attracted either by sympathy or curiosity +as to the amazing fracas which old McKay was creating. Of course they +entered into the spirit of the preparations, so that when the enemy at +last descended on them they found the garrison ready. But the defenders +might as well have remained quiet and gone to their beds. + +Night was drawing near at the time, and was, as it were, precipitated by +the grasshoppers, which darkened the whole sky with what appeared to be +a heavy shower of snow. + +The fires were lighted, water was poured into the trench, and the two +households fought with blanket, sheet, counterpane, and towel, in a +manner that proved the courage of the ancient heroes to be still +slumbering in men and women of modern days. + +But what could courage do against such overwhelming odds? Thousands +were slaughtered. Millions pressed on behind. + +"Don't give in, lads," cried the heroic and desperate Highlander, +wielding a great green blanket in a way that might have roused the +admiration if not the envy of Ajax himself. "Keep it up, Jenkins!" + +"Ay, ay, sir!" responded the nautical warrior, as he laid about him with +an enormous buffalo robe, which was the only weapon that seemed +sufficiently suited to his gigantic frame; "never say die as long as +there's a shot in the locker." + +Elise stood behind him, lost in admiration, and giving an imbecile flap +now and then with a towel to anything that happened to come in front of +her. + +Elspie was more self-possessed. She tried to wield a jack-towel with +some effect, while Dan, Fergus, Duncan junior, Bourassin, Andre Morel, +and others ably, but uselessly, supported their heroic leader. La +Certe, who chanced to be there at the time, went actively about +encouraging others to do their very best. Old Peg made a feeble effort +to do what she conceived to be her duty, and Okematan stood by, calmly +looking on--his grave countenance exhibiting no symptom of emotion, but +his mind filled with intense surprise, not unmingled with pity, for the +Palefaces who displayed such an amount of energy in attempting the +impossible. + +That self-defence, in the circumstances, was indeed impossible soon +became apparent, for the enemy descended in such clouds that they filled +up the half-formed ditch, extinguished the fires with their dead bodies, +defied the blanket-warriors, and swarmed not only into the garden of old +Duncan McKay but overwhelmed the whole land. + +Darkness and exhaustion from the fight prevented the people of Ben Nevis +Hall and Prairie Cottage from at first comprehending the extent of the +calamity with which they had thus been visited, but enough had been seen +to convince McKay that his garden was doomed. When he at last allowed +the sad truth to force itself into his mind he suffered Elspie to lead +him into the house. + +"Don't grieve, daddy," she said, in a low comforting tone; "perhaps it +won't be as bad as it seems." + +"Fetch me my pipe, lass," he said on reaching his bedroom. + +"Goot-night to you, my tear," he added, on receiving the implement of +consolation. + +"Won't you eat--or drink--something, daddy dear?" + +"Nothing--nothing. Leave me now. We hev had a goot fight, whatever, +an' it iss to bed I will be goin' now." + +Left alone the old man lay down in his warrior-harness, so to speak, +lighted his pipe, smoked himself into a sort of philosophical contempt +for everything under the sun, moon, and stars, and finally dropped his +sufferings, as well as his pipe, by falling into a profound slumber. + +Next morning when the people of Red River arose, they became fully aware +of the disaster that had befallen them. The grasshoppers had made what +Jenkins styled a clean sweep from stem to stern. Crops, gardens, and +every green herb in the settlement had perished; and all the sanguine +hopes of the long-suffering settlers were blighted once more. + +Before passing from this subject it may be as well to mention that the +devastating hosts which visited the colony at this time left behind them +that which turned out to be a worse affliction than themselves. They +had deposited their larvae in the ground, and, about the end of the June +following, countless myriads of young grasshoppers issued forth to +overrun the fields. They swarmed in such masses as to be two, three, +and--in some places near water--even four inches deep. Along the rivers +they were found in heaps like sea-weed, and the water was almost +poisoned by them. Every vegetable substance was devoured--the leaves +and even bark of trees were eaten up, the grain vanished as fast as it +appeared above ground, everything was stripped to the bare stalk, and +ultimately, when they died in myriads, the decomposition of their dead +bodies was more offensive than their living presence. + +Thus the settlers were driven by stress of misfortune once again to the +plains of Pembina, and obliged to consort with the Red-men and the +half-breeds, in obtaining sustenance for their families by means of the +gun, line, trap, and snare. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY. + +LITTLE BILL BECOMES A DIFFICULTY. + +We must now pass over another winter, during which the Red River +settlers had to sustain life as they best might--acquiring, however, in +doing so, an expertness in the use of gun and trap and fishing-line, and +in all the arts of the savages, which enabled them to act with more +independence, and to sustain themselves and their families in greater +comfort than before. + +Spring, with all its brightness, warmth, and suggestiveness had returned +to cheer the hearts of men; and, really, those who have never +experienced the long six-or-eight-months' winter of Rupert's Land can +form no conception of the feelings with which the body--to say nothing +of the soul--opens up and expands itself, so to speak, in order to +receive and fully appreciate the sweet influences of spring. + +For one thing, seven or eight months of cold, biting, steely frost +causes one almost to forget that there ever was such a thing as summer +heat, summer scents, summer sounds, or summer skies. The first thaw is +therefore like the glad, unexpected meeting of a dear old friend; and +the trumpet voice of the first goose, the whirring wing of the first +duck, and the whistle of the first plover, sounds like the music of the +spheres to one's long unaccustomed ears. Then the trickle of water +gives one something like a new sensation. It may be but a thread of +liquid no thicker than a pipe-stem faintly heard by an attentive ear +tinkling in the cold depths far under the ice or snow, but it is liquid, +not solid, water. It is suggestive of motion. It had almost been +forgotten as a sound of the long past which had forsaken the terrestrial +ball for ever. + +It does not take a powerful imagination to swell a tiny stream to a +rivulet, a river, a lake, a mighty ocean. Shut your eyes for a moment, +and, in memory, the ice and snow vanish; the streams flow as in the days +of old; flowers come again to gladden the eyes and--but why trouble you, +good reader, with all this? We feel, sadly, that unless you have tasted +the northern winter no description, however graphic, will enable you to +drink in the spirit of the northern spring. + +About this time Okematan, the Cree chief, took it into his head that he +would go a-hunting. + +This last word does not suggest to a dweller in the wilderness that +crossing of ploughed lands on horseback, and leaping of hedges, +etcetera, which it conveys to the mind of an Englishman. The Cree +chief's notion of spring-hunting was, getting into a birch-bark canoe, +with or without a comrade, and going forth on the lakes and rivers of +the wilderness with plenty of powder and shot, to visit the native home +of the wild-goose, the wild-duck, the pelican, the plover, and the swan. + +For such a trip not much is essential. Besides the gun and ammunition +referred to, Okematan carried a blanket, a hatchet, several extra pairs +of moccasins, a tin kettle in which to boil food, a fire-bag for steel, +flint, and tinder, with a small supply of tobacco. + +On hearing of his intention, Dan Davidson resolved to accompany him. +Dan had by that time associated so much with the chief that he had +learned to speak his language with facility. Indeed nearly all the +settlers who had a turn for languages had by that time acquired a +smattering more or less of Indian and French. + +"You see," said Dan to the chief, "there is not much doing on the farm +just now, and I want to see a little of the country round about, so, if +you don't object to my company, I'd like to go." + +"The Cree chief will be proud to have the company of the Paleface +chief," replied the Indian, with grave courtesy. + +Dan wanted to say "All right," but was ignorant of the Cree equivalent +for that familiar phrase; he therefore substituted the more sober and +correct, "It is well." + +"But," said he, "you must not call me a Paleface chief, for I am only an +ordinary man in my own land--what you would call one of the braves." + +"Okematan is thought to have a good judgment among his people," returned +the Indian, "though he has not the snows of many winters on his head, +and he thinks that if Dan'el had stayed in the wigwams of his people +beyond the Great Salt Lake, he would have been a chief." + +"It may be so, Okematan, though I doubt it," replied Dan, "but that is a +point which cannot now be proved. Meanwhile, my ambition at present is +to become a great hunter, and I want you to teach me." + +The chief, who was gratified by the way in which this was put, gladly +agreed to the proposal. + +"There is another man who would like to go with us," said Davidson. "My +friend, Fergus McKay, is anxious, I know, to see more of the lands of +the Indian. You have no objection to his going, I suppose?--in another +canoe of course, for three would be too many in your small canoe." + +Okematan had no objection. + +"Three would not be too many in the canoe," he said, "but two are better +for hunting." + +"Very good. But we will want a fourth to make two in each canoe. Whom +shall we invite?" + +"Okematan's counsel is," answered the chief, "to take a brave who is +young and strong and active; whose eye is quick and his hand steady; +whose heart never comes into his throat when danger faces him; whose +face does not grow pale at the sight of approaching death; whose heart +is as the heart of the grisly bear for courage, and yet tender as the +heart of a Paleface squaw; whose hand can accomplish whatever his head +plans, and whose tongue is able to make a sick man smile." + +Davidson smiled to himself at this description, which the chief uttered +with the sententious gravity that would have characterised his speech +and bearing in a council of war. + +"A most notable comrade, good Okematan; but where are we to find him, +for I know nobody who comes near to that description." + +"He dwells in your own wigwam," returned the chief. + +"In Prairie Cottage?" exclaimed the other with a puzzled air. "You +can't mean my brother Peter, surely, for he is about as grave as +yourself." + +"Okematan means the young brave who loves his little brother." + +"What! Archie Sinclair?" exclaimed Dan, with a surprised look. "I had +no idea you had so high an opinion of him." + +"Okematan has seen much of Arch-ee: has watched him. He sees that he +thinks nothing of himself; that he thinks always for the sick brother, +Leetle Beel, and that he will yet be a great chief among the Palefaces." + +"Well, now you come to mention it, there _is_ something about Archie +that puts him high above other boys; and I suppose his unselfishness has +much to do with it; but don't you think he's too young, and hardly +strong enough?" + +"He is not young. He is fifty years old in wisdom. He is very strong +for his size, and he is _willing_, which makes his strength double." + +"But he will never consent to leave Little Bill," said Dan. + +"Okematan had fears of that," returned the Indian, with, for the first +time, a look of perplexity on his face. "If Arch-ee will not go without +Leetle Beel, Leetle Beel must go too." + +It was found, on inquiry, that they were right in their surmise. When +the proposal was made to Archie that afternoon by Dan, the boy's eyes +seemed to light up and dance in his head at the prospect. Then the +light suddenly went out, and the dancing ceased. + +"Why, what's the matter, Archie?" asked his friend. + +"Can't go. Impossible!" said Archie. + +"Why not?" + +"Who's to look after Little Bill, I should like to know, if I leave +him?" + +"Elspie, of course," said Dan, "and Elise, to say nothing of Jessie, +mother, and brother Peter." + +Archie shook his head. + +"No," he said, "no! I can't go. Elspie is all very well in her way, +and so is Elise, but _they_ can't carry Little Bill about the fields and +through the bush on their backs; and Peter wouldn't; he's too busy about +the farm. No--ever since mother died, I've stuck to Little Bill through +thick and thin. So I _won't_ go." + +It was so evident that Archie Sinclair's mind was made up and fixed, and +also so obvious that a delicate little boy would be a great encumbrance +on a hunting expedition that Dan thought of attempting the expedient of +winning Little Bill himself over to his side. He had no difficulty in +doing that, for Billie was to the full as amiable and unselfish as his +brother. After a short conversation, he made Billie promise to do his +very best to induce Archie to go with the hunters and leave him behind. + +"For you know, Little Bill," said Dan in conclusion, and by way of +consoling him, "although nobody could take such good care of you as +Archie, or make up to you for him, Elspie would take his place very well +for a time--." + +"O yes, I know that well enough," said the poor boy with some +enthusiasm; "Elspie is always very good to me. You've no notion how +nice she is, Dan." + +"Hm! well, I have got a sort of a half notion, maybe," returned Dan with +a peculiar look. "But that's all right, then. You'll do what you can +to persuade Archie, and--there he is, evidently coming to see you, so +I'll go and leave you to talk it over with him." + +Billie did not give his brother time to begin, but accosted him on his +entrance with--"I'm so glad, Archie, that you've been asked to go on +this hunting expe--" + +"O! you've heard of it, then?" + +"Yes, and I want you to go, very very much, because--because--" + +"Don't trouble yourself with _becauses_, Little Bill, for I won't go. +So there's an end of it--unless," he added, as if a thought had suddenly +occurred to him, "unless they agree to take you with them. They might +do worse. I'll see about that." + +So saying, Archie turned about, left the room as abruptly as he had +entered it, and sought out Okematan. He found that chief sitting in La +Certe's wigwam, involved in the mists of meditation and tobacco-smoke, +gazing at Slowfoot. + +That worthy woman--who, with her lord and little child, was wont to +forsake her hut in spring, and go into the summer-quarters of a wigwam-- +was seated on the opposite side of a small fire, enduring Okematan's +meditative gaze, either unconsciously or with supreme indifference. + +"Hallo! Oke,"--thus irreverently did Archie address the chief--had any +one else ventured to do so, he might possibly have been scalped--"Hallo! +Oke, I've been huntin' for you all round. You're worse to find than an +arrow in the grass." + +It may be said, here, that Archie had learned, like some of the other +settlers, a smattering of the Cree language. How he expressed the above +we know not. We can only give the sense as he would probably have given +it in his own tongue. + +"Okematan's friends can always find him," answered the Indian with a +grave but pleased look. + +"So it seems. But I say, Oke, I want to ask a favour of you. Dan +Davidson tells me you want me to go a-hunting with you. Well, I'm your +man if you'll let me take Little Bill with me. Will you?" + +"Leetle Beel is not strong," objected the Indian. + +"True, but a trip o' this sort will make him strong perhaps. Anyhow, it +will make him stronger." + +"But for a sick boy there is danger," said the chief. "If Arch-ee +upsets his canoe in a rapid, Arch-ee swims on shore, but Leetle Beel +goes to the bottom." + +"Not as long as Arch-ee is there to hold him up," returned the boy. + +"Waugh!" exclaimed the Indian. + +"Humph!" remarked the boy. "What d'ye mean by `Waugh,' Oke?" + +"Okematan means much that it is not in the power of the tongue to tell," +replied the Indian with increasing gravity; and as the gravity increased +the cloudlets from his lips became more voluminous. + +"Arch-ee hopes, nevertheless, that the tongue of Oke may find power to +tell him a little of what he thinks." + +This being in some degree indefinite, the chief smoked in silence for a +minute or two, and gazed at Slowfoot with that dreamy air which one +assumes when gazing into the depths of a suggestive fire. Apparently +inspiration came at last--whether from Slowfoot or not we cannot tell-- +for he turned solemnly to the boy. + +"Rain comes," he said, "and when sick men get wet they grow sicker. +Carrying-places come, and when sick men come to them they stagger and +fall. Frost often comes in spring, and when sick men get cold they die. +Waugh!" + +"Humph!" repeated the boy again, with a solemnity quite equal to that of +the Red-man. + +"When rain comes I can put up an umbrella--an _umbrella_. D'you know +what that is?" + +The Indian shook his head. + +"Well it's a--a thing--a sort of little tent--a wigwam, you know, with a +stick in the middle to hold on to and put it up. D'you understand?" + +An expression of blank bewilderment, so to speak, settled on the chief's +visage, and the lights of intelligence went out one by one until he +presented an appearance which all but put the boy's gravity to flight. + +"Well, well, it's of no use my tryin' to explain it," he continued. +"I'll show it to you soon, and then you'll understand." + +Intelligence began to return, and the chief looked gratified. + +"What you call it?" he asked--for he was of an inquiring disposition--"a +bum-rella?" + +"No, no," replied the other, seriously, "an um_brella_. It's a clever +contrivance, as you shall see. So, you see, I can keep the rain off +Little Bill when he's in the canoe, and on shore there are the trees, +and the canoe itself turned bottom up. Then, at carryin' places, I can +carry Little Bill as well as other things. He's not heavy and doesn't +struggle, so we won't leave him to stagger and fall. As to frost--have +we not hatchets, and are there not dead trees in the forest? Frost and +fire never walk in company, so that Little Bill won't get cold and die, +for we'll keep him warm--waugh!" + +When human beings are fond of each other disagreement seldom lasts long. +Okematan had taken so strong a fancy to Archie that he felt it +impossible to hold out; therefore, being a man of strong common sense, +he did not attempt the impossible. + +Thus it came to pass that, two days later, a couple of birch-bark canoes +were launched on the waters of Red River, with Dan Davidson in the stern +of one and Fergus McKay acting as his bowman. Okematan took the stern +of the other, while Archie Sinclair wielded the bow-paddle, and Little +Bill was placed in the middle on a comfortable green blanket with the +celebrated "bum-rella" erected over him to keep off, not the rain, but, +the too glorious sunshine. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY ONE. + +AN AUSPICIOUS BEGINNING AND SUSPICIOUS ENDING. + +Let loose in the wilderness! How romantic, how inexpressibly +delightful, that idea seems to some minds! Ay, even when the weight of +years begins to stiffen the joints and slack the cords of life the +memory of God's great, wild, untrammelled, beautiful wilderness comes +over the spirit like a refreshing dream and restores for a time +something like the pulse of youth. + +We sometimes think what a joy it would be if youth could pass through +its blessings with the intelligent experience of age. And it may be +that this is to be one of the joys of the future, when man, redeemed and +delivered from sin by Jesus Christ, shall find that the memory of the +sorrows, sufferings, weaknesses of the past shall add inconceivably to +the joys of the present. It may be so. Judging from analogy it does +not seem presumptuous to suppose and hope that it will be so. + +"Sufficient unto the day," however, is the joy thereof. + +When the two canoes pushed off and swept rapidly over the fair bosom of +Red River, the heart of Archie Sinclair bounded with a feeling of +exultant joy which it would have been very hard indeed to convince him +was capable of increase, while the bosom of his invalid brother was +filled with a sort of calm serenity which constituted, in his opinion at +the time being, a quite sufficient amount of felicity. + +When we add that the other hunters were, in their several ways, pretty +much in the same condition as the boys, we have said enough to justify +the remark that their circumstances were inexpressibly delightful. + +Proceeding some distance up stream they finally diverged into a minor +tributary which led to waters that were swarming with water-fowl and +other game. + +"This is a grand burst, Little Bill," said Archie, as he plied his +paddle vigorously, and glanced over his shoulder at the invalid behind +him. + +"Prime!" answered Billie. "Isn't it?" he added, with a backward glance +at Okematan. + +"Waugh!" replied the reticent savage. + +"Ay, `Waugh!' that's all you'll get out of him when he's puzzled," said +Archie; "though what he means by it is more than I know. You must speak +respectable English to a Red-skin if you want to convince him. Why, if +he had understood you literally, you know--and obeyed you--he'd have had +something to do immediately with the lock of his gun." + +"I have often wondered, Archie," returned his brother with a languid +smile, "what a lot you manage to say sometimes with nothing in it." + +"Ha! ha!--ho! ho! what a wag you're becoming, Little Bill. But I thank +'ee for the compliment, for you know it's only philosophers that can say +an awful lot without a'most sayin' anything at all. Look at Oke there, +now, what a depth of stupidity lies behind his brown visage; what +bucketsful of ignorance swell out his black pate, but he expresses it +all in the single word `Waugh!' because he's a philosopher. If he was +like La Certe, he'd jabber away to us by the hour of things he knows +nothin' about, and tell us long stories that are nothin' less than big +lies. I'm glad you think me a philosopher, Little Bill, for it takes +all the philosophy I've got to keep me up to the scratch of goin' about +the world wi' you on my back. Why, I'm a regular Sindbad the Sailor, +only I'm saddled with a young man o' the plains instead of an old man of +the sea. D'ee understand what I'm saying, Oke?" + +The chief, who understood little more than that his own name and that of +La Certe were mentioned, nodded his head gravely and allowed the corners +of his mouth to droop, which was his peculiar way of smiling--a smile +that might have been unintelligible to his friends had it not been +relieved and interpreted by a decided twinkle in his eyes. + +While they were conversing, the two canoes had rounded a rocky point and +swept out upon a lake-like expanse in the river, which was perfectly +smooth and apparently currentless. Several islets studded its calm +breast and were reflected in the clear water. These were wooded to the +water's edge, and from among the sedges near their margin several flocks +of wild-fowl sprang up in alarm and went off in fluttering confusion. + +It chanced that just then a trumpet-like note was heard overhead, as a +flock of wild geese passed the spot and came suddenly close within range +of the canoes which had been concealed from them by the bushes that +fringed the river. + +Guns were seized at once by the bowmen in each canoe, but Archie was +smarter than Fergus. Before the Highlander had got the weapon well into +his hands the boy fired and one of the flock fell into the river with a +heavy plunge. + +Little Bill signalised the successful shot with a high-toned cheer, and +the Indian with a low-toned "Waugh," while Fergus made a hurried and +therefore bad, shot at the scared flock. + +"That wass a fery good shot, Archie," remarked Fergus, as the canoes +ranged up alongside of the dead bird. + +"Yours was a very good one, too, Fergus," returned the boy; "only not +quite straight." + +The smile on the face of Okematan proved that he understood the drift of +the reply, and that this was the style of humour he appreciated so +highly in his young friend. We civilised people may wonder a little at +the simplicity of the savage, but when we reflect that the chief had +been born and bred among the solemnities of the wilderness, and had been +up to that time wholly unacquainted with the humours and pleasantries +that sometimes accompany juvenile "cheek," our wonder may perhaps be +subdued. + +"This would be a splendid place to camp for the rest of the day," +suggested Davidson, while they rested on their paddles after the goose +had been secured. "We must lay in a small stock of fresh provisions, +you know, if we are to push on to-morrow or next day to our hunting +ground. What say you, Okematan?" he added in Cree, turning to their +guide. + +"The will of the Paleface chief is the wish of Okematan. Let him +speak." + +"Well, then, I vote for encamping on the small island over there, in the +middle o' the lake--for it's far more like a lake than a river +hereabouts--that one over which the hawk is hovering." + +"I vote for it too," said Archie. + +"So do I," chimed in Little Bill. + +"I will be sayin' ditto to that," put in Fergus. + +"Moreover," suggested Dan, "I vote for roasting the goose at once." + +"Ay, and eating him right away," said Archie. As the invalid followed +this up with a feeble cheer, the proposal was carried into effect +without delay. + +The islet was low and flat, and so thickly covered with bush that it +afforded a most enticing spot for a night-encampment. There was also +plenty of dead wood on it, with which to replenish the fire, and various +peeps through sundry openings afforded exquisite views of woodland and +river with which to charm the eyes. Over all, the sun was pouring his +noontide rays in a glorious flood. + +We need not waste time in going into the details of the feast that +followed: how the goose was delightfully plump and tender--especially +tender to teeth that would have scarcely observed the difference if it +had been tough--how, in addition to the goose, they had wild-ducks +enough--shot earlier in the day--to afford each one a duck to himself, +leaving a brace over, of which Okematan ate one, as well as his share of +the goose, and seemed to wish that he might eat the other, but he +didn't, for he restrained himself; how they drank tea with as much gusto +and intemperance as if it had been a modern "afternoon"; and how, after +all was over, the Red-man filled the pipe-head on the back of his iron +tomahawk and began to smoke with the air of a man who meant business and +regarded all that had gone before as mere child's-play. + +The afternoon was well advanced when the feast was concluded, for +appetites in the wilderness are not easily or soon satisfied. + +"I feel tight," said Billie with a sigh and something of pathos in his +tone, when he at last laid down his knife--we cannot add fork, for they +scorned such implements at that time. + +"That's right, Little Bill," said Archie, "try another leg or wing--now, +don't shake your head. We've come on this trip a-purpose to make you +fat an' strong. So you must--here, try this drum-stick. It's only a +little one, like yourself, Billie." + +"True, Archie, but I'm too little to hold it. I feel like an egg now." + +"Hallo! Oke, are you overcome already?" asked Archie. + +"The sun sinks to rest at night and the birds go to sleep. If we intend +to hunt we must begin now." + +"It's always the way," returned the boy with an air of discontent; +"whenever a fellow gets into a state of extreme jollity there's sure to +be something bothersome to come and interrupt us. Obfusticate your +faculties with some more smoke, Oke, till Billie and I finish our tea. +We can't shoot with half-empty stomachs, you know." + +"They must be three-quarters full by this time--whatever," remarked +Fergus, wiping his clasp-knife on the grass. + +Just then, Dan Davidson, who had gone to explore the islet, returned +with the information that some hunters must have recently visited the +same place, for he had discovered the remains of an encampment at the +extreme eastern side, which looked as if it had been recently occupied, +for bones of wild-fowl were scattered about, the meat on which was +neither dried nor decayed. + +On hearing this, Okematan rose quickly, put out his pipe, and stuck the +tomahawk in his belt. The sluggish good-natured air of contentment with +which he had been smoking vanished; the half-sleepy eyes opened, and a +frown rested on his brow as he said, shortly-- + +"Okematan goes to look." + +"May I go with you?" asked Dan. + +"No. Okematan goes alone. It is known that a band of Saulteaux have +been seen. They are roused just now by the actions of the great white +chief and the words of my Nation. Rest here till I come. Go on eating. +If they are here they may be watching us now." + +"D'ee hear that, Little Bill? You've got to go on eating," said Archie. +"Our guide commands it. If you disobey, the rascally Saulteaux will +come down upon us somehow." + +But Archie's light-heartedness was not shared by his older companions. +They knew too well that the disturbed state of the country at the time, +and especially the ill-will engendered between the Crees and Saulteaux +by the ill-advised action of Lord Selkirk's agents, rendered an +explosion not improbable at any time, and a certain feeling of +disappointment came over them when they reflected that the hunting +expedition, which they had entered on with so much enthusiastic hope, +might perhaps be brought to an abrupt close. + +"If there's to be any fighting I shall only be in your way," said the +invalid in a tone in which there was much of sadness, though none of +fear. + +"Not a bit of it, Little Bill," returned Dan, quickly. "You'll be in +nobody's way in the canoes. You're as light as a feather. If we had +even to take to the bush, Archie could run with you; an' when he gets +tired, Fergus and I would think no more o' you than a grasshopper." + +"Iss it carryin' him you will be taalkin' of?" said Fergus. "Ay, ay! I +would be forgettin' that he wass on my back if I had him there." + +As he spoke, the Indian returned to the camp with the cat-like tread so +characteristic of the Red-man. + +"A big band has been here," he said. "They slept on the island last +night, and the signs show that they do not come as friends." + +"Are you sure of that?" asked Dan. + +"Okematan is sure of nothing. Even the sun may not rise to-morrow." + +"Had we not better, then, return at once to the Settlement, and tell +what we have seen?" said Dan. + +"If we did, the Saulteaux would see us and give chase. Their canoes are +big and have strong men in them. They would overtake us soon and our +scalps would be swinging at their belts to-morrow." + +"Not pleesant to think of--whatever," said Fergus. + +"What, then, do you advise?" asked Dan. "You understand the ways of the +wilderness, and we will follow your lead." + +The chief appeared to think for a few moments. + +"We will remain where we are," he said; "only we will send the boys off +in one of the canoes, as if to shoot some ducks for us. The Saulteaux +will think that we are lazy, idle men, who like to lie in camp and sleep +or smoke while the boys hunt for us. When night comes we will escape in +the dark and go down the river to warn the settlers." + +"But what if they attack us before night comes on?" asked Dan. + +"They will not do that," answered the Indian, gravely. "They know that +we are well supplied with powder and shot. They know that some one must +lead in every attack, and that such leaders would be doomed to death. +Saulteaux do not love death. They prefer life. They will not come till +it is dark." + +"Ha! ha!" laughed Fergus, who seemed greatly tickled with the latter +part of the chief's observation, "fery goot! ho! fery goot!--they do not +love death, an' it iss life they will be preferrin'. Ay, ay! It iss +the Heelandman that will be of much the same opeenion, only, when +fightin' hes got to be done, he's not afraid to do it in daylight." + +"He may not be afraid, Fergus," said Dan, "yet I suspect that the +Red-man's tactics are often the wisest, for what would be the use of +making an attack in daylight, at the cost of several lives, when the +attack might be made quite as well, if not better, at night, without the +loss, perhaps, of any life at all?" + +"I will not be sayin'," returned Fergus, who was of an argumentative +disposition, "anything at all about attackin' by day or by night. I +will only be remarkin' that the Heelandman iss like the savitch in that +he prefers life to death." + +"Come along to the fire, Fergus," said Dan, laughing; "I will argue that +out with you." + +"It will be difficult to argue, then, for there iss no argument in it at +all. It is only a statement of opeenion." + +"Well, but surely it is possible to controvert your opinion! Besides, +we are somewhat exposed where we stand. Even an arrow might reach us +from the near bank." + +"Never you fear, Tan. They will not be so foolish as to fire now, +instead of attack at night. They are sly--whatever." + +While the two friends were thus conversing, the Cree chief was arranging +the smaller of the canoes for the use of the young hunters--that is, he +took out all the lading, making it so light that it would skim over the +water like an egg-shell with the slightest impulse of the paddle. + +"You'll have to put a big stone in the stern, Oke," said Archie, "to +make up for Little Bill's lightness--" + +"For your heaviness, you mean," interrupted the invalid. + +"No; I mean what I say, Billie, for you are light-headed as well as +light-hearted--a sort o' human balloon, ready to go up like a rocket at +any time--so that even an or'nary man like me weighs you down. Besides, +Oke, he steers better than me and I shoot better than him. Also, I like +the hardest work, so I always take the bow." + +Arranging things according to directions, the Indian held the canoe +steady while the brothers stepped carefully in--for they had learned +from experience that the birch-bark canoe, besides being easily broken, +is apt to overturn on small provocation. + +"Let not Arch-ee go near the river-bank on either side," said the chief +in a warning voice, as he was about to shove the frail bark out upon the +glassy water. "The Saulteaux might catch him. And let him not go far +up or down stream. Let him keep among the reeds round the island. +There are many ducks there. Shoot plenty, as if Arch-ee had no +suspicion--no fear of Indians." + +"I say, Oke," demanded the lad, with what was meant for an overwhelming +frown, "do you mean to hint that I _have_ any fear of the Indians?" + +"Okematan has the belief that Arch-ee never knew fear at all," returned +the chief, earnestly; "that he has the courage of the young +buffalo-bull." + +"Well, I'm not quite so sure o' that," returned the boy, with a modest +look. "I would not myself put it quite so strong, you know. But you're +a wise chief, and I hope you've got a lot of brothers as wise as +yourself. Good-bye, Oke--shove off. Now, then, mind how you steer, +Little Bill." + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY TWO. + +CIRCUMVENTING THE RED-SKINS. + +For some time the brothers paddled about the sedgy shore of the small +islet on which the camp had been pitched, now setting up a flock of +ducks and then slipping into the heart of some reeds and concealing +themselves until a good chance was obtained at a passing flock of geese. + +Archie Sinclair soon laid in enough provision to serve the party for a +few meals, for his hand was steady and his eye true. + +"Little Bill," he said, looking back after one of his successful shots, +"you must take a shot now. We will go right-about-face, and convert the +bow into the stern in the usual way. See, catch hold of the gun." + +"No, Arch-ee, as Oke calls you, I won't; I'm quite content to look on, +for your gun kicks like a Mexican mule. Besides, it's easy work to +steer, and seeing you panting and toiling in the bow makes it seem all +the easier. Just you keep blazin' away, old man. But, I say, where +shall I steer to now? I'm tired o' steering among the reeds. Let us +push out into the clear water." + +"You heard what Oke said," objected Archie; "we must keep well clear o' +both shores." + +"I know that," returned Billie, "but he did not forbid us to try the +reeds round the other islands; there's a much bigger one, not a quarter +of a mile up stream. I think there are some beautiful sedges there +where geese are likely to live. I'm sure I would choose to live in such +a place if I was a goose." + +"O! then, we must go, Little Bill, for I think it would be hard to keep +any one out of his native home." + +So saying, he dipped his paddle with vigour, and the light bark shot +swiftly over the glancing water. + +The sun was beginning to descend towards the western horizon when they +drew near to the island, and several flocks of water-fowl had already +sprung alarmed from the reeds, when Archie caught sight of a +black-and-red-painted visage peering at him from among the bushes. + +The boy's heart seemed to bound into his throat and his first impulse +was to turn the canoe and fly, but Archie's mind was quicker even than +his hand or eye. All he had ever heard or read of the cool stoicism of +the Red-man seemed to flash across his memory, and, with a violent +effort, he crushed back the shout that rose to his lips. He could not +indeed suppress the look of sudden surprise that swept across his +expressive face, but he cleverly adapted it to circumstances. + +"Look, look! Little Bill," he exclaimed, eagerly, pointing right over +the Indian's head at a flock of geese that opportunely appeared at the +moment in the far distance. "Crouch, Bill, lie low, I'll call them. +Steer a little more to the left and keep her so." + +Thereupon he began a vociferous imitation of the sounds with which +Indians are wont to call to geese that may chance to be flying past at a +distance. The obedient Billie steered as directed, and thus the canoe +was slowly sheered off a little from the shore. It was cleverly done. +Whether the savage was deceived or not we cannot tell, but he showed no +sign of intention to move or act, though he was within easy range of the +boys. + +"Little Bill," said Archie, in a low voice, such as one might use when +anxious not to alarm game, "can you do what you're bid _at once_ and +_exactly_?" + +"I can try," was the quiet answer. + +"Well, then, try your best, Little Bill; for our lives may depend on our +action now. Keep your eyes fixed on that flock o' geese as long as +they're in sight. _Don't_ look at the shore, whatever I do or say. +Look at anything you like, but _not at the shore_. There's a Red-skin +there. I've seen him, though he thinks I haven't. Now, steer right +round and go back the way we have just come, only keep always edging a +little off-shore." + +As he said this Archie raised himself from his crouching attitude, laid +down his gun and resumed his paddle, and in his ordinary free-and-easy +tones exclaimed-- + +"We've lost that chance, Little Bill--more's the pity." + +"Never mind," answered Billie in the same tone, being resolved to act +his part well, "there's lot's more where these came from. Better luck +next time. Where away now?" + +"Keep her just as you go, you're far enough out now. We should start +some ducks here." + +Thus speaking, and with the air of a leisurely man enjoying himself-- +with infinite contentment on his ruddy countenance, and with much +concern in his agitated soul--Archie took the canoe straight past the +very spot where the Indian lay concealed. He felt that audacity was the +safest line of action, for he knew that if the savage meant mischief, to +pretend absolute ignorance of his existence would be less likely to draw +a shot than sudden flight--which, however swiftly carried out, could by +no means equal the flight of a bullet. Besides, it was of the utmost +importance that he should reach the encampment and report what he had +seen without the Indian becoming aware that he had been discovered. + +In order to effect his purpose, he not only repassed the hiding-place of +the savage but actually shot and picked up another duck while still +within range of the enemy's gun. Then he directed his brother to steer +still more off the island, but very slowly. + +"We're in no hurry, you see, Little Bill; you haven't looked at the +shore, I hope?" + +"Never once." + +"Ha! ha!" laughed Archie in high glee at the success of this his first +experiment in backwoods warfare; "you're a trump, Little Bill!" + +"I'd rather be a trump than a trumpet, Archie. If there are more +Red-skins about, laughing like that will be sure to rouse them." + +"Never fear, Billie, my boy. You do as I tell 'ee. We must keep up the +game a bit longer yet. It won't do to hurry back till the sun is lower, +so we'll go over to that small island there an' have a try for another +duck. There's sure to be nobody on such a small island as that. +Afterwards we'll drop down in an off-hand, idle-like way to the +encampment. It'll be natural to do this when the evenin's beginning to +set in, an' so we'll stump them Red-skins at their own game. D'ee +understand?" + +"Yes. You're a clever chap, Archie." + +In pursuance of this deeply laid plan, the brothers crossed over to the +small islet referred to, and, after apparently amusing themselves there +for a short time, dropped down stream in a leisurely way, reaching the +encampment before the evening had fairly set in. + +A council of war was immediately held. + +"You were right in your guess, Okematan," said Davidson. "The reptiles +will be down on us to-night no doubt. What course does the Cree chief +advise?" + +"Okematan advises that the kettle be boiled, the duck roasted, and a +good big supper eaten." + +"It iss fery pleasant advice, no doubt," said Fergus with a broad and +rather sarcastic grin, "but it iss not warlike!" + +"It seems not a bad preparation for war, anyhow," said Dan; "and what +after that?" + +"The two boys will sleep and rest while food is preparing," continued +the chief. "The moon will set before we have done eating, and it will +be very dark. The Saulteaux will not attack while the light lasts. +When it is quite dark we will go." + +"If we fix to leave and they chance to attack at the same time, it iss +meetin' them we will be, Okematan," said Fergus. + +To this remark the Indian vouchsafed no reply. + +"Well, well, Muster Okematan, it iss your own business; you will know +best yourself. I will see to stowin' away my supper--whatever." + +By the time supper was over, the moon had descended into a bank of black +clouds on the horizon, and profound darkness brooded over land and +water. It was a night such as an attacking party would hail as being +most suitable for its work, and of course was proportionately unsuitable +for the attacked. The Indian chief displayed no more concern about it +than if nothing unusual were pending. After supper, however, he +directed that the canoes should be launched and loaded. At the same +time he gathered together as much wood as he could, and heaped it on the +fire. + +"You seem determined to give them plenty of light to do their work," +remarked Davidson. + +"They will wait till our fire burns low," said the chief. "By that time +they will think we are asleep. A sleeping foe is not dangerous. They +will come--slowly; step by step; with wide eyes glancing from side to +side, and no noise, sly as foxes; timid as squaws! But by that time we +will be far on our way back to Red River!" + +"Ay--if we do not meet them comin' to attack us," said Fergus. + +"And how shall we proceed!" asked Dan. + +"As we came," answered the chief. "Okematan, with the two boys, will +lead. Dan-ell an' Fergus will follow. Come." + +Led by their guide, the party passed out of the firelight into the dense +thicket by which the spot was encompassed almost completely, so that the +only visible sign of the encampment from outside was the forks of flame +and sparks which rose high above the bushes. + +On reaching the shore they found the two boys holding the canoes, close +to the land. So intense was the darkness that they could not see the +boys or canoes at all till close beside them. Without uttering a word, +or making a sound with their moccasined feet, they stepped into the +canoes, pushed gently off and glided, ghost-like, into the vast +obscurity. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY THREE. + +A MIDNIGHT CHASE, AND DAN IN EXTREMITY. + +For some time they advanced in absolute silence, dipping their paddles +so as to make no noise whatever; Dan following as close as possible in +the wake of the chief, for it was one of those nights which people +describe as being so dark that one cannot see one's hand before one's +face. + +On reaching the lower end of the lake-like expansion where the river +narrowed suddenly and the stream began to be felt, it was discovered +that the enemy was in advance of them--that, anticipating some such +attempt at escape, they had stationed an ambush at the narrows to cut +off their retreat. + +Archie was naturally the first to make this discovery, being in the bow +of the canoe. He heard no sound, but suddenly there loomed out of the +darkness another canoe close to them--so close that they were on the +point of running into it when the sharp-witted boy saw it, and, with an +adroit turn of his paddle prevented a collision. Then he ceased to +paddle, and held his breath. Not knowing what to do next he wisely did +nothing, but left matters to Oke and fate! + +As they passed, the steersman in the strange canoe uttered something in +a low tone. Evidently he mistook them for his friends. + +"Sh!" was Okematan's prompt reply--or the Indian equivalent for that +caution. + +They glided silently and slowly past, but the suspicion of the strange +Indian had obviously been aroused, for the paddles of his canoe were +heard to gurgle powerfully. Hearing this, Okematan made a stroke that +sent his canoe ahead like an arrow, and Archie, who appreciated the +situation, seconded the movement. + +"Stop!" exclaimed the strange Indian, in the Saulteaux tongue, but the +Cree chief did not feel the duty of obedience strongly upon him just +then. On the contrary, he put forth all his strength, but quietly, for +he remembered that Dan Davidson was behind. + +As there was now no need for concealment, the pursuer uttered a shrill +war-whoop which was immediately answered and repeated until the woods +rang with the fiendish sound, while half-a-dozen canoes dashed out from +the banks on either side, and sought to bar the river. + +"Now, Arch-ee," said the Cree chief in a low voice, "paddle for your +life and be a man!" + +"I'll be two men, if you like, Oke," answered the boy, whose courage was +of that type which experiences something almost like desperate glee in +the presence of imminent danger. + +The canoe, obedient to the double impulse and the power of the current, +was soon out of hearing of the pursuers. + +"O! if I only had a paddle I might help you," said Little Bill eagerly. + +"Yes, an' bu'st your biler, or explode your lungs, or something o' that +sort," said his brother. "No, no, Little Bill; you sit there like a +lord or an admiral, an' leave men like Oke an' me to do all the dirty +work." + +While he spoke thus flippantly it is but justice to say that Archie was +never more anxiously in earnest in his life, and that he strained at his +paddle with a degree of energy that made him, perhaps, more than equal +to many an average man. So that the canoe forged well ahead of the +pursuers and finally got to a part of the river where three islets +divided it into several channels, rendering further pursuit in the dark +useless if not impossible. + +Their comrades, however, were not so fortunate. Left behind by the +sudden spurt of his leader, Davidson and his companion exerted +themselves to overtake him, but the canoes of the enemy, which were just +too late to cut off the retreat of Okematan, were in time to intercept +the second canoe. In this emergency Dan swerved aside, hoping to get to +the bank before the Saulteaux could discover his exact whereabouts. His +intentions were thwarted by the want of caution in his companion. + +"Iss it to the land ye are going?" asked Fergus. + +"Yes--it's our only chance," whispered Dan. + +"It iss my opeenion--" murmured the Highlander. + +"Hush!" ejaculated Dan. + +But the caution came too late. A listening Red-skin overheard the +sounds, and, with a sudden dash was alongside of them. He did not, +however, know the vigour of the men with whom he had to deal. While he +was in the very midst of a triumphant war-whoop, Dan cut him over the +head with the paddle so violently that the instrument became splinters, +and the whoop ceased abruptly. At the same time Fergus caught hold of +the bow of the enemy's canoe with an iron grasp, and, giving it a heave +that might have put Samson to shame, fairly overturned it. + +"Ye can wet your whustle now--whatever," he muttered. + +As he spoke, the canoe ran with extreme violence against the invisible +bank. At the same moment a random volley was fired from the canoes in +rear. Fear lest they should wound or kill a comrade probably caused +them to send the whizzing bullets rather high, but for one instant the +flame revealed the position of the fugitives, and those who had reserved +their fire took better aim. + +"Take to the bush, Fergus!" cried Dan, as he grasped his gun and leaped +into the shallow water. + +The Highlander stooped to lay hold of his weapon, which lay in the bow +of the canoe, just as another volley was fired. The act was the means +of saving his life, for at least half-a-dozen bullets whizzed close over +his head. Before he could recover himself a strong hand grasped his +neck and flung him backwards. Probably a desperate hand-to-hand fight +would have ensued, for Fergus McKay had much of the bone, muscle, and +sinew, that is characteristic of his race, but a blow from an unseen +weapon stunned him, and when his senses returned he found himself bound +hand and foot lying in the bottom of a canoe. He could tell from its +motion, that it was descending the river. + +Meanwhile Dan Davidson, under the impression that his comrade was also +seeking safety in the bush, did his best to advance in circumstances of +which he had never yet had experience, for, if the night was dark on the +open bosom of the river, it presented the blackness of Erebus in the +forest. Dan literally could not see an inch in advance of his own nose. +If he held up his hand before his face it was absolutely invisible. + +In the haste of the first rush he had crashed through a mass of small +shrubbery with which the bank of the stream was lined. Then on passing +through that he tumbled head over heels into a hollow, and narrowly +missed breaking his gun. Beyond that he was arrested by a tree with +such violence that he fell and lay for a minute or two, half-stunned. +While lying thus, experience began to teach him, and common sense to +have fair-play. + +"A little more of this," he thought, "and I'm a dead man. Besides, if +it is difficult for me to traverse the forest in the dark, it is equally +difficult for the savages. My plan is to feel my way step by step, with +caution. That will be the quietest way, too, as well as the quickest. +You're an excited fool, Dan!" + +When a man begins to think, and call himself a fool, there is some hope +of him. Gathering himself up, and feeling his gun all over carefully, +to make sure that it had not been broken, he continued to advance with +excessive caution, and, in consequence, was ere long a considerable +distance from the banks of the river, though, of course, he had but a +hazy idea as to what part of the country he had attained, or whither he +was tending. + +As the first excitement of flight passed away, Dan began to feel uneasy +prickings of conscience at having so hastily sought safety for himself, +though, upon reflection, he could not accuse himself of having deserted +his comrades. Okematan and the boys, he had good reason to believe--at +least to hope--had succeeded in evading the foe, and Fergus he supposed +had landed with himself, and was even at that moment making good his +escape into the forest. To find him, in the circumstances, he knew to +be impossible, and to shout by way of ascertaining his whereabouts he +also knew to be useless as well as dangerous, as by doing so he would +make his own position known to the enemy. + +He also began to feel certain pricking sensations in his right leg as +well as in his conscience. The leg grew more painful as he advanced, +and, on examination of the limb by feeling, he found, to his surprise, +that he had received a bullet-wound in the thigh. Moreover he +discovered that his trousers were wet with blood, and that there was a +continuous flow of the vital fluid from the wound. This at once +accounted to him for some very unusual feelings of faintness which had +come over him, and which he had at first attributed to his frequent and +violent falls. + +The importance of checking the haemorrhage was so obvious, that he at +once sat down and did his best to bind up the wound with the red cotton +kerchief that encircled his neck. Having accomplished this as well as +he could in the dark, he resumed his journey, and, after several hours +of laborious scrambling, at last came to a halt with a feeling of very +considerable, and to him unusual, exhaustion. + +Again he sat down on what seemed to be a bed of moss, and began to +meditate. + +"Impossible to go further!" he thought. "I feel quite knocked up. +Strange! I never felt like this before. It must have been the tumbles +that did it, or it may be that I've lost more blood than I suppose. +I'll rest a bit now, and begin a search for Fergus by the first streak +of dawn." + +In pursuance of this intention, the wearied man lay down, and putting +his head on a mossy pillow, fell into a profound sleep, which was not +broken till the sun was high in the heavens on the following day. + +When at last he did awake, and attempted to sit up, Dan felt, to his +surprise and no small alarm, that he was as weak as a child, that his +leg lay in a pool of coagulated gore, and that blood was still slowly +trickling from the wound in his thigh. + +Although disposed to lie down and give way to an almost irresistible +tendency to slumber, Dan was too well aware that death stared him in the +face to succumb to the feeling without a struggle. He therefore made a +mighty effort of will; sat up; undid the soaking bandage, and proceeded +to extemporise a sort of tourniquet with it and a short piece of stick. + +The contrivance, rude as it was, proved effectual, for it stopped the +bleeding, but Dan could not help feeling that he had already lost so +much blood that he was reduced almost to the last stage of exhaustion, +and that another hour or two would probably see the close of his earthly +career. Nothing, perhaps, could have impressed this truth upon him so +forcibly as his inability to shout when he tried to do so. + +In the faint hope that Fergus might be within call, he raised his voice +with the full knowledge that he ran the risk of attracting a foe instead +of a comrade. The sound that complied with the impulse of his will +would have made him laugh if he had not felt an amazing and +unaccountable disposition to cry. Up to that period of his life--almost +from his earliest babyhood--Dan Davidson's capacious chest had always +contained the machinery, and the power, to make the nursery or the +welkin ring with almost unparalleled violence. Now, the chest, though +still capacious, and still full of the machinery, seemed to have totally +lost the power, for the intended shout came forth in a gasp and ended in +a sigh. + +It was much the same when he essayed to rise. His legs almost refused +to support him; everything appeared to swim before his eyes, and he sank +down again listlessly on the ground. For the first time, perhaps, in +his life, the strong man had the conviction effectually carried home to +him that he was mortal, and could become helpless. The advantage of +early training by a godly mother became apparent in this hour of +weakness, for his first impulse was to pray for help, and the resulting +effect--whether men choose to call it natural or supernatural--was at +least partial relief from anxiety, and that degree of comfort which +almost invariably arises from a state of resignation. + +After a brief rest, the power of active thought revived a little, and +Dan, again raising himself on one elbow, tried to rouse himself to the +necessity of immediate action of some sort if his life was to be saved. + +The spot on which he had lain, or rather fallen down, on the preceding +night happened to be the fringe of the forest where it bordered on an +extensive plain or stretch of prairie land. It was surrounded by a +dense growth of trees and bushes, except on the side next the plain, +where an opening permitted of an extensive view over the undulating +country. No better spot could have been chosen, even in broad daylight, +for an encampment, than had been thus fallen upon by the hunter in the +darkness of night. + +But the poor man felt at once that this advantage could be of no avail +to him, for in the haste of landing he had thought only of his gun, and +had left his axe, with the bag containing materials for making fire, in +the canoe. Fortunately he had not divested himself of his powder-horn +or shot-pouch, so he was not without the means of procuring food, but of +what use could these be, he reflected, if he had not strength to use +them? + +Once again, in the energy of determination, he rose up and shouldered +his gun with the intention of making his way across the plain, in the +hope that he might at all events reach the wigwam of some wandering +Indian, but he trembled so from excessive weakness that he was obliged +to give up the attempt, and again sank down with feelings akin to +despair. + +To add to his distress, hunger now assailed him so violently that he +would have roasted and eaten his moccasins--as many a starving man had +done before him, though without much benefit--but even this resource was +denied him for the want of fire, and raw moccasin was not only +indigestible but uneatable! + +Still, as it seemed his only hope, he gathered a few dry twigs and +sticks together, drew the charge from his gun and sought to kindle some +mossy lichen into flame by flashing the priming in the pan of the lock. +Recent rains had damped everything, however, and his attempts proved +abortive. Fortunately the weather was warm, so that he did not suffer +from cold. + +While he was yet labouring assiduously to accomplish his purpose, the +whir of wings was heard overhead. Glancing quickly up, he perceived +that a small flock of willow-grouse had settled on the bushes close to +him. He was not surprised, though very thankful, for these birds were +numerous enough and he had heard them flying about from time to time, +but that they should settle down so near was exceedingly opportune and +unexpected. + +With eager haste and caution he rammed home the charge he had so +recently withdrawn--keeping his eyes fixed longingly on the game all the +time. That the birds saw him was obvious, for they kept turning their +heads from side to side and looking down at him with curiosity. By good +fortune grouse of this kind are sometimes very stupid as well as tame. +They did not take alarm at Dan's motions, but craned their necks and +seemed to eye him with considerable curiosity. Even when he tried to +take aim at them their general aspect suggested that they were asking, +mentally, "What next?" + +But Dan found that he could not aim. The point of the gun wavered +around as it might have done in the hands of a child. + +With a short--almost contemptuous--laugh at his ridiculous incapacity, +Dan lowered the gun. + +Stupid as they were, the laugh was too much for the birds. They spread +their wings. + +"Now or never!" exclaimed Dan aloud. He pointed his gun straight at the +flock; took no aim, and fired! + +The result was that a plump specimen dropped almost at his feet. If he +had been able to cheer he would have done so. But he was not, so he +thanked God, fervently, instead. + +Again the poor man essayed to kindle a fire, but in trying to do this +with gunpowder he made the startling discovery that he had only one more +charge in his powder-horn. He therefore re-loaded his gun, wiped out +the pan and primed with care, feeling that this might be the last thing +that would stand between him and starvation. It might have stood +between him and something worse--but of that, more hereafter. + +Starving men are not particular. That day Dan did what he would have +believed to have been, in him, an impossibility--he drank the blood of +the bird and ate its flesh raw! + +"After all," thought he, while engaged in this half-cannibalistic deed, +"what's the difference between raw grouse and raw oyster?" + +It is but right to add that he did not philosophise much on the subject. +Having consumed his meal, he lay down beside his gun and slept the +sleep of the weary. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY FOUR. + +A DESPERATE SITUATION. + +Awaking next morning much refreshed, but with a keen appetite for more +grouse, Dan Davidson sat up and reflected. He felt that, although +refreshed, the great weakness resulting from excessive loss of blood +still rendered him almost helpless, and he knew that making new blood +was a process that required good feeding and considerable time. What, +then, was to be done? + +He had scarcely asked himself the question when a rustle in the bushes +near him caused him to look quickly round and seize his gun. But the +noise was not repeated, and nothing could be seen to justify alarm. +Still Dan felt that the sound justified caution; he therefore kept his +gun handy, and loosened in its sheath the scalping-knife which he always +carried in his belt--for eating purposes, not for scalping. + +Thus he sat for nearly an hour with an uncomfortable sensation that +danger of some sort lurked near him, until he almost fell asleep. Then, +rousing himself he proceeded to breakfast on the bones and scraps of the +previous night's supper. + +While thus engaged he tried to make up his mind what course he ought to +pursue--whether to remain where he was until his friends should have +time to find him--for he felt sure that Okematan would escape and reach +the Settlement, in which case a search for him would certainly be set on +foot--or whether he should make a desperate effort to stagger on, and +ultimately, if need be, creep towards home. The pain of his wound was +now so great as to render the latter course almost impossible. He +therefore resolved to wait and give his friends time to institute a +search, trusting to another shot at willow-grouse for a supply of food. + +He had scarcely made up his mind to this plan when the rustling in the +bushes was repeated again. Seizing his gun, which he had laid down, Dan +faced round just in time to see the hindquarters and tail of a large +grey wolf disappearing in the bushes. + +To say that he felt considerable alarm when he saw this is not to stamp +him with undue timidity, for he would have rejoiced to have had the wolf +in his clutches, then and there, and to engage in single combat with it, +weak though he was. What troubled him was his knowledge of the fact +that the mean spirited and sly brute was noted for its apparent sagacity +in finding out when an intended victim was growing too feeble to show +fight--either from wounds or old age--and its pertinacity and patience +in biding the time when an attack could be made with safety. + +Had this horrible creature discerned, by some occult knowledge, that the +sands in his glass were running low? Was it to be his fate to face his +glaring murderer until he had not vital power left to grapple with it, +or to guard his throat from its hideous fangs? These were questions +which forced themselves upon him, and which might well have caused the +stoutest heart to shrink from the threatened and terrible doom. + +In the strength of his emotion he had almost fired at a venture at the +spot where the brute had disappeared; but luckily the remembrance that +it was his last charge of ammunition came to him in time, and he had the +resolution to restrain himself even when his finger was on the trigger. + +Dan now perceived that he must not venture to remain on the spot where +he had passed the night, because, being surrounded on three sides by +shrubbery, it afforded his grisly foe an opportunity to approach from +any quarter, and spring on him the moment he should find him off his +guard. + +There was a natural bank of earth out on the plain about three or four +hundred yards off, with neither trees nor bushes near it. The bank was +not more than four feet high, and the top slightly overhung its base, so +that it afforded some slight protection from the sun. To this spot Dan +resolved to betake himself, and immediately began the journey--for a +journey it surely was, seeing that the hunter had to do it on hands and +knees, lifting his gun and pushing it before him, each yard or so, as he +went along. The inflammation of his wound rendered the process all the +slower and more painful, and a burning thirst, which he had no means of +slaking, added to his misery. + +By the time he had passed over the short distance, he was so much +exhausted that he fell at the foot of the bank almost in a swoon. + +Evidently the wolf imagined that its time had now come, for it sneaked +out of the wood when the hunter fell, and began cautiously to advance. +But Dan saw this, and, making a desperate effort, arose to a sitting +posture, leaned his back against the bank, and placed his gun across his +knees. + +Seeing this, the wolf sat down on its haunches, and coolly began to bide +its time. + +"Ha! you brute!" muttered Dan, "I could easily stop your mischief if my +strength wasn't all gone. As it is, I dare not give you my last shot +till you are so close that you can look down the barrel o' my gun." + +From this point a watch of endurance began on both sides--the brute, of +course, unaware of the deadly weapon which its intended victim held, and +the man fully aware of the fact that if he should venture to lie down +and sleep, his doom would be sealed. + +It is impossible for any one who has not had trial of similar +experiences to imagine the rush of thought and feeling that passed +through the brain and breast of Dan Davidson during the long dreary +hours of that terrible day. Sometimes he fell into a half-dreamy +condition, in which his mind leaped over forests and ocean to bonnie +Scotland, where his days of childhood were spent in glorious revelry on +her sunny banks and braes. At other times the memory of school-days +came strong upon him, when play and lessons, and palmies were all the +cares he had; or thoughts of Sabbaths spent with his mother--now in the +church, now in the fields, or at the cottage door learning Bible stories +and hearing words of wisdom and the story of the crucified One from her +lips. Then the scene would change, and he was crossing the stormy +ocean, or fighting with Red-skins, or thundering after the buffalo on +the wide prairies. But through all the varied fabric of his thoughts +there ran two distinct threads, one golden, the other black. The first +we need hardly say was Elspie McKay; the second was that awful wolf +which sat there glaring at him with a hang-dog expression, with the red +tongue hanging out of its mouth, and from which he never for a moment +allowed his eyes to wander. + +As evening began to draw on, the situation became terrible, for Dan felt +that the little strength he had left was fast sinking. The efforts by +which he had succeeded in rousing himself in the earlier parts of the +day were failing of their effect. Then a strange and sudden change +occurred, for, while he knew that the end of the trial was rapidly +approaching, he began to experience a feeling of indifference--the +result, no doubt, of excessive weariness--and almost a wish that all was +over. Nevertheless, whenever that wolf moved, or changed its position +ever so little, the instinct of self-preservation returned in full +force, and Dan, pulling himself together, prepared to defend himself +desperately to the last gasp. + +While the two were thus glaring at each other, Dan was startled and +thoroughly aroused from his irresistible lethargy by a loud report. + +Next moment he saw the wolf extended dead upon the plain. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY FIVE. + +ADVENTURES OF FERGUS AND HIS FRIENDS. + +In order to account for the sudden death recorded in the last chapter, +we must turn aside to follow for a little the fortunes of Fergus McKay. + +It will be remembered that the vigorous Highlander, after overturning +the Indian canoe and running his own canoe on shore, was seized by the +neck, while in the act of reaching forward to grasp his gun, and +captured. + +Now, Fergus was of an unusually knowing and wily nature. He possessed +what some would call more than his share of readiness in action and +sagacity in counsel, though his ordinary reticence and sluggishness of +manner concealed those qualities to some extent. + +Being endued, also, with more than the average allowance of that bodily +strength for which his countrymen are famous, his first impulse was to +exert his powers and show fight, but he had been taken suddenly at a +disadvantage and thrown on his back into the bottom of the canoe, and at +least three pair of very muscular hands grasped his throat and other +parts of his person. That they were strong hands he felt; that they +belonged to big strong savages he had every reason to believe--though it +was too dark to see--and that scalping-knives and tomahawks were handy +to them he knew to be highly probable. He therefore promptly made up +his mind as to his course of action, and at once began to play his part. +Making a very feeble resistance--just enough, in short, to deceive--he +begged for mercy in soft, rather tremulous and very abject tones. True, +his language was English--at least that sort of English to which the +mountaineers of Scotland are addicted--but he trusted to the tone and +manner of his speech, not to the sense, which Saulteaux, he knew, could +not be expected to understand. + +"Oh! then, don't be hard on me. Don't kill me, goot shentlemen," he +whined. "It iss a poor worthless thing I am--whatever!" + +These remarks, and a few similar appeals for mercy, were accompanied +with many dismal groans, as his captors were dragging him up the bank of +the stream. Pausing for a moment, one of them produced a cord, with +which they proceeded to bind their cowardly and unresisting prisoner. + +Whether the Indians were deceived by their victim's tones and manner, +and the soft condition of his carefully relaxed muscles, we cannot tell, +but it seemed as if such were the case, for some of the brief remarks +made by his captors had in them a smack of undisguised contempt, and +when the cord was being put round his arms he felt that the grip of his +captors was slightly relaxed. + +Now or never was his chance! Hurling the men on either side of him +right and left, he delivered two random blows in front, one of which +happily took effect on a savage chest, the other on a savage nose, and +cleared the way in that direction. With a bound like that of one of his +own mountain deer, he cleared the bank, and plunged into the river. + +In ordinary circumstances an attempt of this kind would have been worse +than useless, for the Indians would not only have jumped into their +canoes and overtaken the fugitive, but some of them would have run down +the bank of the stream to prevent a landing. Some such attempt was +indeed made on the present occasion, but the intense darkness was in +favour of Fergus, and the searching canoes only ran into each other, +while the searchers on land were still more at a disadvantage. + +Now, Fergus McKay was as much at home in water as an otter or a +musk-rat. Indeed he had been known among his playmates in the old +country as the "Water-rat." When, therefore, he plunged into the river, +as described, he took care to hold his breath as if for a long dive, and +drifted with the current a considerable distance as motionless as a dead +man. The Indians listened intently, of course; for his coming to the +surface; for the breathing, and, it might be, for the splashing that +would be natural after such a leap, but no breathing or splashing met +their ears, for when Fergus put up his head, far down the stream, he +only let out his nose and mouth for a gentle inspiration, and sank +again. + +"It iss circumventin' you at your own trade, fightin' you wi' your own +claymore, that I will be doin'," he thought, as he rose a second time, +and swam softly with the stream. + +Fergus had the advantage of being well acquainted with the river in +which he was swimming, as well as with the lands in its neighbourhood, +and he knew that there was a certain bend in the stream which it would +take the canoe of Okematan a considerable time to traverse. By cutting +across a narrow neck of land there was, therefore, a possibility of his +intercepting the canoe. + +The Saulteaux, of course, might have also taken advantage of this +circumstance, but they could have done so only on foot, and they knew +that without canoes they could not arrest the progress of the fugitives. + +Reaching the spot where he wished to land, by intuition almost, the +Highlander soon found himself on the bank, squeezed the water out of his +garments, and set off as quickly as he dared in such darkness. By good +fortune he happened to cross a hunter's track or path--like a +sheep-run--with which he was familiar, and, by following it, was able to +advance much more rapidly. In a short time he again came out on the +left bank of the river. There he sat down on a boulder to listen. +Profound was his attention to every sound--as profound, almost, as his +anxiety, for he knew that if the canoe should have already passed he +would be obliged to make his way back to the Settlement on foot by a +straight course, which meant a slow, toilsome march, scrambling through +pathless woods, wading morasses, and swimming across rivers. + +He had been seated thus for about half-an-hour, and in his impatience +was giving way to despondency, when the plash of water smote upon his +ear. Cocking the said ear attentively, he was rewarded with another +smite, and, in a few minutes, distinctly heard the sound of paddles. + +He put his hands to his mouth forthwith, and uttered a peculiar cry. + +Instantly the sound of the paddles ceased as Archie Sinclair, looking +over his shoulder, said-- + +"Did you hear that, Oke?" + +Before Oke could reply, the cry was repeated. + +"It is Fer-gus," said the Indian, answering to the cry, and steering in +the direction whence it came. "Are you sure, Oke?" + +"Okematan never speaks till he is sure--waugh!" + +"H'm! I'm not so sure o' _that_," muttered the boy to himself. + +A few seconds put the matter at rest, for the voice of the Highlander +was heard, as they cautiously drew near, saying-- + +"Iss it _you_?" + +"I think it is!" replied Archie; "why, man, where are you? I can see +nothing." + +"Wow! man, but I am gled," said Fergus; "just follow your nose, Archie, +an' you'll be all right." + +Another moment, and the canoe was checked by Fergus, who had stepped +into the water to prevent its being injured against the stones. + +"You better gie me the paddle, Archie, an' sit beside Little Bill. It +iss tired o' paddlin' you will be by now." + +"But where is Dan?" asked Archie as he complied with this request. + +"That iss more than I can tell you, boy, but he's safe enough I doubt +not, for I heard him gie a cheer as he jamp into the wuds, an' it's +beyont the power o' a mortal Red-skin to chase an active man on a night +like this." + +Thereupon Fergus gave a brief account of all that had happened after the +canoes were parted--as far as he knew it--and then an earnest council of +war was held as to what was the best course to pursue in the +circumstances. Being the youngest brave, (for Little Bill was ignored +in this matter), Archie was invited to give his opinion first. This was +well, because, being enthusiastic and irrepressible, he would probably +have given his opinion first at any rate. + +"My opinion is," he said, promptly, "that we turn right-about, and go +back to find Dan, even though we should have to fight the whole +Saulteaux nation!" + +"That iss well spoken," said Fergus with something of sarcasm in his +tone; "but as we hev only two guns amang us, a tomahawk, an' a knife or +two, without any claymores at all, I would like to know what we are to +fecht with? Moreover, what is to become o' Little Bill when we are +fechtin'? It iss _my_ opeenion that we put the command o' our +expeedition in the hands of Okematan, an' leave him to do what he thinks +best." + +"Arch-ee is a true brave," said the Indian, "but he is young. When the +wrinkles of age are on his brow he will be a great chief. Okematan's +heart is with him to turn back and fight, but wisdom says, go to the +Settlement, get men, and return as fast as you can." + +"Then the sooner we set about it the better, for when wan's mind is made +up, talk iss only lost time." + +With that he shoved the canoe off into the stream, and paddling was +resumed with redoubled vigour. + +They proceeded in silence till the blush of rosy day in the east +dispelled the intense darkness. Then, pulling ashore, they kindled a +small fire, and, while the chief re-gummed the seams of the canoe, which +leaked a little, the others prepared and ate a hasty breakfast. + +They were still engaged with this meal, and discussing, not very +hopefully, the possibility of reaching Red River Settlement and +returning in time to render relief to Dan--supposing that he should +require relief--when the sound of fast-dipping paddles was heard beyond +the bend of the river just below them. + +Another moment, and four large canoes, each manned by eight men, swept +into view, their red sides glowing in the morning sun, and their +occupants driving the water behind them in foam by the vigour of their +strokes. + +At first it was supposed that this was another band of Indians +proceeding, possibly, to join that from which they had just escaped; but +the fugitives were speedily undeceived by the appearance of the men as +they drew nearer. + +"I would be thinkin' that the man in the bow o' the first canoe is +Antoine Dechamp," said Fergus, as he stood peering over the bushes at +the advancing brigade. + +"I'm sure it's Dechamp. I'd know him a mile off," said Archie. + +"Ay, an' they hev got sight o' the smoke of our fire, too," added +Fergus. + +"It is Dechamp," said Okematan, decisively, as he stepped into the open +and held up his hand to the new arrivals. + +A cheer was raised by those in the canoes when the Cree chief was +recognised, and the flotilla, coming on at full speed, soon reached the +bank. + +Explanations were speedily exchanged, and our fugitives learned that +news had been carried to the Settlement of the approach of the very band +of Saulteaux whom they had encountered, and a band of fiery young men, +led by Dechamp, had come out to meet them for the purpose of asking them +whether they meant their visit to be friendly, or whether they wished to +measure their strength with the men of Red River; as, if so, a sample +had come out for the express purpose of accommodating them! + +On hearing the news that Okematan and Fergus had to give, the men--most +of whom were half-breeds connected with Cree families--gave a cheer and +voted for an immediate advance against the Saulteaux. This, after very +brief palaver, was unanimously agreed to. + +"You'll not object to return with us, I suppose?" asked Dechamp of +Fergus. + +"Iss it objectin' to a fecht you will mean?" + +"Well--it's not unlikely that there may be something of the sort going +if we meet." + +"Did you ever hear of a McKay objectin' to a fecht, Antoine?" + +Dechamp laughed. + +"Well," he said, "I know Okematan won't object to turn back, and show us +the way to the place where he met the reptiles." + +"Okematan was on his way to seek for help," said the Indian quietly. + +Every one being agreed on this point, the whole band re-embarked, and +proceeded on their way up the river. They advanced rapidly, for +although the stream was against them it was so sluggish as to be +scarcely appreciable, and by keeping near to the banks they were not +delayed by it at all. + +Towards the afternoon the place where the struggle had taken place was +reached, but no Saulteaux were to be seen. They had taken their +departure, and, from the fact that several small things belonging to +them had been left behind, it seemed not unlikely that they had obtained +information of the expedition sent out against them, and had departed in +haste. + +"It iss of no use," said Fergus, when this became evident, "for us to +keep up a stern-chase after them. They have got too much of a start, so +it seems to me, boys, we could not do better than follow up the tracks +of Daniel Davidson an' make sure that he has got clear away from them." + +To this proposal there was much objection at first, for it involved some +of the party quitting the canoes and journeying no one could tell how +far through the woods on foot. + +"Besides," said one, "Dan is quite able to take care of himself, and if +he got off in the dark, as you tell us he did, there's not a man in the +Saulteaux nation could come up with him either in dark or light." + +"That may be all fery true, my frund," returned Fergus, "nevertheless +I'm goin' to follow up his track, for it is sure that he took no +proveesions wi' him, an' it was too dark for me to see if he escaped wi' +his gun. Dan is a strong man, but the strongest man will be findin' +himself in diffeeculties without grub. It iss followin' up his trail I +will be doin', wi' some proveesions on my back, if wan or two o' you +will go wuth me." + +"I will go," said Archie Sinclair, promptly, "if some o' you will +promise to take care o' Little Bill." + +A laugh greeted this offer, and half-a-dozen of the men at once agreed +to take good care of the invalid. + +"Moreover," said Dechamp, "whoever goes need not go further than the +Pine Portage. The party on foot will have found out, before the canoes +reach that, whether Dan has got clear off, and they can rejoin the +canoes at the Portage. So, Fergus, I'll join your party too. Who else +will go?" + +Okematan and Jacques Bourassin here stepped forward, but none of the +others seemed disposed to undertake the tramp. + +"There iss enough of us--whatever," remarked the Highlander as he and +the others put some provisions into their wallets and shouldered their +guns. "You will be our leader, Antoine Dechamp. It iss yourself that +knows the outs an' ins o' the land better than any of us--except +Okematan, may be--but I dar' say he's not as weel acquaint wi' the Red +River woods as wi' the plains." + +The chief bowed a dignified assent to this proposition, which, however, +he hardly understood. + +Dechamp, being accustomed to lead, accepted the position at once, +stepped off on the trail of Dan, which had been made distinctly visible +when he went crashing through the underwood the day before. Fergus +followed, and Bourassin came third. + +"Now, then," said Archie, looking into the chief's face, "come along, +Oke. You and I will form the rearguard, which is the position of danger +and honour in warfare o' this sort--at least if it isn't, it ought to +be. Take care o' yourself, Little Bill. We'll soon find Dan. +Good-bye." + +So saying, the rearguard of the column vanished into the forest, and the +others, returning to their canoes, began to descend the river. + +Archie was nearer the mark than he imagined when he said they would soon +find Dan. The distance which it had taken our hero so long to traverse +in the dark was comparatively short, and the light was only beginning to +fade when they came to the edge of the wood where Dan had spent the +night. + +Dechamp, of course, was first to come upon his encampment, and the +instant he entered it he observed the open space giving a view of the +plain beyond. He also saw the wolf sitting on his haunches about two +hundred yards off. + +Quick as the lightning flash his gun flew to his shoulder. Dechamp was +a first-rate shot. He fired, and, as we have seen, the wolf stretched +himself in death upon the plain. + +Thus was Dan Davidson rescued at almost the eleventh hour. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY SIX. + +HOME-COMING AND BARGAINING. + +The return of the hunting party to Red River Settlement was an +illustration of the uncertainty of all human affairs. They went forth +rejoicing in all the strength of youth and manhood; they returned in +sorrow, with one at least of the strong men reduced to the last stage of +weakness. + +We would not be understood to refer to this in a pessimistic spirit. On +the contrary, the optimistic view suggests the very same idea of +uncertainty, though in a pleasant aspect; for does not many a day that +dawns in cloud and rain progress to brilliant sunshine? while equally +true it is that many a life which begins in sorrow culminates in joy. + +Okematan, who was intensely philosophical and inquisitive, had been +carrying on a semi-speculative conversation with Billie on this very +subject while descending the Red River towards Prairie Cottage--much to +the perplexity of the invalid, who scarce knew how to answer the chief's +queries, and greatly to the interest of Archie, who wondered at Little +Bill's powers of reply. + +"By the way," said Archie, "when you two have settled that knotty point, +will you tell me who is to take the news of Dan's accident to Mrs +Davidson? We'll have to carry him up to the house, you know, on a +blanket 'tween two poles, an' she'll be sure to think that he's dead, or +has been killed, an' that'll half-kill _her_, it'll give her such a +fright. Somebody will have to go on ahead and tell her." + +"I will, if you like," said Billie; "if you'll only carry me up to the +garden gate and set me down, I can easily walk up the path." + +This proposal had just been agreed to when the whole flotilla of canoes +paddled up alongside of the bank close under Prairie Cottage. + +It was evening at the time. The Davidson family was at supper, and as +the canoes had approached very quietly, with Dan in the leading one, no +person stood on the bank to welcome them. + +"It's as well they don't know," said Archie, jumping on shore. "Now, +Little Bill, come along, and I'll carry you to the gate while they're +arranging matters for Dan." + +Seated at the foot of the family table was Peter Davidson. He could see +the garden path through the window. + +"Hallo! mother," he exclaimed, dropping his knife and fork, "there is +Little Bill or his ghost coming up the track." + +"Impossible, Peter," said the good lady, with, however, a look of +anxiety which showed she believed that, or something else, to be quite +possible. + +"Look for yourself, mother," cried Peter, springing up and running out. + +"It _is_ Billie," said Jessie, reflecting her mother's anxiety; "what +can have brought them back so soon?" + +Peter re-entered at the moment with Little Bill in his arms. He set the +boy down and again ran out. + +Taking the widow's trembling hand in both of his, Billie addressed her +as "mother," like the rest of the family. + +"Dan has been hurt," he said, in his soft way, "and he's come home to +get well. They will bring him up directly." + +"Is he too ill to walk?" asked the widow. + +"No, not too ill--but too weak," answered the matter-of-fact Billie. +"Indeed he is not ill at all, but he has lost a _heap_ of blood, for +they shot him." + +Jessie waited to hear no more, but immediately followed Peter, and the +small servant Louise followed suit; leaving the widow in a half-fainting +condition with the boy. But she did not remain long thus, for just then +old Duncan McKay entered by the back-door. + +"It will be bad news you've been hearin', Mrs Davidson," he said, in +some surprise, pouring out a glass of water as he spoke, and +considerately handing it to the widow. + +"Yes--O yes! I've just heard that Dan has been shot." + +"Bless my soul!" exclaimed the horrified old man, almost falling into a +chair. "Iss--iss he tead?" + +"No, thank God--only weak from loss of blood. He'll be here directly." + +"That iss goot news--whatever; for as long as there's life there's +hope." + +Trying to comfort himself, as well as his friend, with this truism, the +old man staggered out of the house in search of those who had gone +before. + +Soon a sad procession was seen coming up the path, led by Archie. Four +men carried Dan on a rudely-extemporised litter. His bloodless face and +lips gave him the appearance of death, but the glow in his eyes told of +still unexhausted life. + +"I'll be all right, mother," he said feebly, as they laid him on his +bed. "I only want food and rest. Thank God--home at last!" + +As he spoke, a quiet step was heard, and Elspie, with a face as pale as +his own, knelt by his bedside and took his hand. + +That touch was the first impulse the youth received towards decided +recovery. Old McKay perceived the change in his countenance. + +"Yes, yes! ay, ay!" he exclaimed, pacing violently up and down the room, +"he wants nothin' but victuals an' rest--steaks an' shops, and plenty o' +whusky an' water--hot. Don't be croodin' about him an' botherin' him. +Come away, and leave him to his mother, an' send for the doctor. Has no +wan gone for him yet?" + +"Yes; Peter has just started. I heard the clatter of his horse's feet," +said Jessie. + +"It iss not the doctor that will put him right, whatever," muttered the +old man, as he left the room, followed by most of the family. + +And the doctor himself held the same opinion; for he said, on returning +to the reception hall after seeing his patient-- + +"It will be a considerable time before he recovers, for the fountain of +life had been well-nigh drained when he fortunately extemporised that +tourniquet. But there's no fear of him: all that he wants is food, +rest, and peace of mind." + +"An' whusky, doctor," added old McKay. "Don't forget the best pheesic; +an' I hev goot store of it, too, in my cellar at Ben Nevis." + +"I'm not so sure about the whisky, Mr McKay," returned the doctor with +a laugh. "I think we shall manage to pull him through without that." + +The other requisites for recovery were applied without stint at Prairie +Cottage; for, despite the misfortune which had attended the cultivation +of the soil, the Davidsons had a little money, which enabled them to buy +provisions and other necessaries, obtainable from the Hudson Bay +Company, and thus tide over the disastrous year in greater comfort than +fell to the lot of many of the other settlers. + +Thus Dan was well looked after. His brother Peter found the food--at +least much of it--on the prairie and in the woods; his sister Jessie +cooked it; Louise helped, looked on, and learned; home afforded rest; +Elspie supplied the peace of mind--at least as much of it as it was +possible for a fellow-mortal to supply; and his mother superintended +all. Add to this that Archie Sinclair cheered him with miscellaneous +gossip; that Little Bill read to him, or entertained him with serious +talk and grave speculation; that Andre Morel and his sister often +entertained him with song; that on such occasions Jenkins, the sailor, +frequently amused him with nautical tales; that old Peg sometimes came +from Ben Nevis to gaze at him tenderly; and that Okematan came to glare +at him more or less affectionately--and we have said enough to warrant +the conclusion that Dan Davidson had a pretty good time of it in spite +of his weak condition. + +Nevertheless Dan was not quite happy. He could not get rid of the +memory of Henri Perrin's murder, and the terrible thought that Elspie's +brother Duncan had some sort of guilty knowledge of it. These thoughts +he buried deep, however, in his own breast, and even tried to forget +them. Vain effort! for does it not stand to reason that the thing we +strive most earnestly to forget is the very thing which, by that effort, +we are fixing with a deeper stamp on memory? + +Francois La Certe was somewhat exercised about the same question, about +the same time. + +That estimable member of the colony was seated one fine day on the banks +of the river fishing for goldeyes--a small fish about the size of a +plump herring. His amiable spouse was helping, or rather fishing with +him. It was a fine healthy, contemplative occupation; one that +admirably suited their tendency to repose, and at the same time filled +them with that virtuous sensation which awaits those who know that they +are engaged in useful occupation--for were not goldeyes the best of +eating? + +Branches of trees were their primitive rods, twine their simple lines, +grasshoppers their bait, and a violent jerk their method. + +"Slowfoot!" said La Certe. + +"My husband!" or some such Indian phrase, answered the woman. + +"I have been wondering for a long time now why--hi!--no! I thought +there was something at my bait--but it was deception. Nothing is so +unreal as the bite of the goldeye--when it is not there. It brings to +mind the lights in the sky of winter, which dance and shoot--and yet +they are not. Hi! ho!--I have him. I was mistaken. I thought the fish +_was_ not--but it was." + +While speaking La Certe sent a small fish with bursting violence on the +grass behind him. Almost at the same moment Slowfoot landed another, +with less violence and more coolness. + +"What was I saying, Slowfoot?" asked the half-breed, when the hooks had +been re-baited, and their eyes were riveted on their respective floats. + +"Nothing that any one could remember," answered his truthful spouse. + +"Now I remember--ho! was that another?" + +"No, it was not," answered his matter-of-fact helpmate. + +"Where is our child?" asked the father, with that wayward wandering of +mind which is a not uncommon characteristic of genius. + +"Smoking in the tent," answered the mother. + +"And with my pipe, no doubt," said the father, laying down his rod and +searching in the bag in which he was wont to carry, among other things, +his pipe and tobacco. + +A cry of pain from the tent in question--which was close behind the +pair--apprised the parents that something was wrong. Immediately their +first and only one issued with a tobacco pipe in one hand and a burnt +finger on the other. It came to the father for sympathy, and got it. +That is to say, La Certe put the burnt finger in his mouth for a moment, +and uttered some guttural expressions of sympathy. Having thus +fulfilled duty and relieved conscience, he exchanged the finger for the +pipe-stem, and began to smoke. The spoiled, as well as despoiled, child +uttered a howl of indignation, and staggered off to its mother; but she +received it with a smile of affectionate indifference, whereupon the +injured creature went back to the tent, howling, and, apparently, howled +itself to sleep. + +Again La Certe broke the piscatorial spell that had settled down on +them, and, taking up the thread of discourse where he had dropped it, +repeated his statement that he had been wondering for a long time why +Cloudbrow, _alias_ young Duncan McKay, was so sharp and fierce in +denying that he knew anything about the murder of Henri Perrin. + +"Hee! hee!" was Slowfoot's significant reply. + +"Can Slowfoot not guess?" he asked, after attending to a hopeful nibble, +which came to nothing. + +"Slowfoot need not guess; she _knows_," said the woman with an air of +great mystery. + +"What does Slowfoot know?" + +The woman's answer to this was a look of exceeding slyness. But this +did not content her lord, who, after repeated questions, and a threat to +resort to extreme measures in case of continued refusal, drew from her a +distinct answer. + +"Slowfoot knows that Cloudbrow _killed_ Perrin." + +"Sh!" exclaimed La Certe, with a look of real concern, "I am not yet +tired of you, Slowfoot; and if old McKay hears you say that he will +shoot you." + +"Slowfoot is not a fool," retorted the woman: "the old man will never +hear her say that. What has Slowfoot got to do with it? She can hold +her tongue!" + +"She can do that, for certain," returned her husband with good-natured +sarcasm. "In that, as in many things, she excels other women. I would +never have married her had it not been so. But how do you come to be so +sure?" + +"I know the knife," returned the woman, becoming more literal as she +went on, "and Marie Blanc knows it. Her husband once got the loan of it +from Cloudbrow, and she looked at it with care, because she had never +seen such a knife before. She knew all its marks. Why does Cloudbrow +deny that it is his? Because it was Cloudbrow who killed Perrin. If it +had been anybody else he would have known it, and he would have said +so--for he was _there_." + +"How know you that he was there?" + +"Marie Blanc knows. She netted the snowshoes that Cloudbrow wore, and +she saw the footprints." + +"But pairs of snowshoes are very like each other," objected La Certe. + +"Very like. Yes; but did ever two shoes have the same mends in the same +places of the netting, where it had been broken, and the same marks on +the frames?" + +"Never. It will go hard with Cloudbrow if this is true." + +"It will go hard with him whether it is true or not," returned the +woman; "for some of the friends of Perrin believe it to be true, and +swear--" + +The disappearance of Slowfoot's float at this moment stopped her +swearing, and brought the conversation to an abrupt end. The landing of +another goldeye prevented its resumption. + +Having caught more than enough for a good supper, this easy-going pair +leaned their rods against a tree, and ascended the bank towards their +tent, which was an ordinary conical Indian wigwam, composed partly of +leather and partly of birch-bark, with a curtain for a door and a hole +in the top for a window; it also served for a chimney. + +On the way they encountered one of the poor Swiss immigrants, who, +having a wife and family, and having been unsuccessful in +buffalo-hunting, and indeed in all other hunting, was in a state which +bordered on starvation. + +"You have been lucky," said the Switzer, eyeing La Certe's fish +greedily. + +"Sometimes luck comes to us--not often," answered the half-breed. "Have +you caught any?" + +"Yes, two small ones. Here they are. But what are these among three +children and a wife? I know not how to fish," said the mountaineer +disconsolately. + +The fact was not surprising, for the poor man was a watchmaker by trade, +and had never handled rod or gun till he was, as it were, cast adrift in +Rupert's Land. + +"I will sell you some of my fish," said La Certe, who on all occasions +had a keen eye for a bargain. + +"Good! I am ready to buy," said the poor fellow, "but I have not much +to spend. Only last week I gave my silver watch for eight gallons of +wheat. I meant it for seed, but my wife and children were starving, so +we were have no seed and only five shillings to spare." + +"Well, my friend," said La Certe, "fish is very scarce just now, but you +may have five goldeyes for your five shillings." + +"O! that is too much," remonstrated the Switzer. + +"No, no," interrupted the half-breed, amiably, "by no means--but if you +really think it too much fish for the money I will give you four +goldeyes!" + +"Come, you know I don't mean that," returned the other, with a cynical +smile. "Make it six, and I will agree. And here is a pinch of snuff in +to the bargain." + +He pulled out a box as he spoke, and opened it. + +"Ha!" said La Certe, helping himself. "I love snuff, and so does my +wife. Do you not?" + +Slowfoot answered, "Hee! hee!" and helped herself to as much as a good +broad finger and thumb could grasp, after which she sneezed with +violence. + +"Now, behold! my friend--a-wheesht!" said La Certe, sneezing a bass +accompaniment to Slowfoot's treble. "I will give you a catfish--a whole +catfish for--a-wheesht!--for that box and snuff." + +The Switzer shook his head. + +"Nay," he said. "The snuff you may have, but the box was the gift of a +friend, and I am loath to part with it. Besides, the box is of little +real value." + +"You may have the head of the catfish for the snuff, and the whole +catfish for the box," said La Certe, with the firmness of a man who has +irrevocably made up his mind--for there are none so firm of purpose as +the weak and vacillating when they know they have got the whip-hand of +any one! "And, behold! I will be liberal," he added. "You shall have +another goldeye into the bargain--six goldeyes for the five shillings +and a whole catfish for the box and snuff--voila!" The poor Switzer +still hesitated. + +"It is a great deal to give for so little," he said. + +"That may be true," said the other, "but I would not see my family +starve for the satisfaction of carrying a snuff-box and five shillings +in my pocket." + +This politic reference to the starving family decided the matter; the +poor Switzer emptied his pockets with a sigh, received the fish, and +went on his way, leaving La Certe and Slowfoot to return to their wigwam +highly pleased with their bargain. As must have been noted by the +reader long ere now, this like-minded couple did not possess a +conscience between them--at least, if they did, it must at that time +have been a singularly shrunken and mummified one, which they had +managed to keep hidden away in some dark and exceedingly un-get-at-able +chamber of the soul. + +Commercially speaking, however, they had some ground for satisfaction; +for at that time the ordinary price of a catfish, which is a little +larger than a haddock, was threepence. + +Awakening the juvenile La Certe to the blissful realisation that a good +"square" meal was pending, Slowfoot ordered it to fill and light the +pipe for the father, while she set about preparing the fish for supper. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY SEVEN. + +VISIT FROM SIOUX BROUGHT TO A DISASTROUS CLOSE. + +Happening to hear of the bargain which we have just described, and being +under the impression that it might be good for La Certe's spirit to +receive a mild reproof, Mr Sutherland paid him a visit. + +The Scotch Elder was, for a long time, the only man fitted to perform +the duties of a minister to his countrymen in that out-of-the-world +colony, and, being a true man of God, he could not hear of gross +injustice, or heartless conduct, without some slight attempt to open the +other's eyes to his sin. + +It may well be understood that, in the nature of things and the state of +the country, the solitary Elder's duties were by no means light or +agreeable. Indeed he would have had no heart to cope with them and with +the difficulties they entailed, had he not remembered that the battle +was not his, but the Lord's, and that he was only an instrument in the +all-powerful hand of the Spirit of God. His own weapons were the Word, +Prayer, and the name of Jesus. + +But it was not given to him to see much fruit of his visit to La Certe +at that time. The half-breed, besides asserting himself to be a +"Catholic," (by which he meant a Roman Catholic), and, therefore, in no +way amenable to Sutherland's jurisdiction, received his remonstrances +with philosophical arguments tending to prove that men were meant to +make the best of circumstances as they found them, without any regard to +principles--which, after all, were not very seriously held or practised +by any one, he thought--especially in Red River. + +As for Slowfoot, she listened with evident interest and curiosity to the +strange teaching and exhortations of the Elder, but when appealed to for +some sort of opinion on the various points touched, she replied with an +imbecile "Hee! hee!" which was not encouraging. + +However, the good man had sown the seed faithfully and kindly. The +watering thereof and the sprouting were, he knew, in the hands of the +Master. + +Rising to take leave, the Elder put his hand in his pocket and pulled +out a large clasp-knife. + +"Why, that's my knife that I lost!" exclaimed La Certe in surprise; +"where did you find it?" + +"I found it on my table at home, where you left it that time you came to +ask for some tobacco. Now, observe, if I did not seriously hold and +practise the principle of honesty, I would have made the best of +circumstances as I found them, and would have put the knife in my pocket +instead of returning it to you." + +La Certe laughed, and Slowfoot said, "Hee! hee!" while the juvenile La +Certe availed itself of the opportunity to draw the pipe gently from its +father's hand and have a whiff. + +"I have a message to you from the Governor," continued the Elder, taking +a piece of paper out of his pocket. + +"For me!" exclaimed La Certe, in surprise. + +"Yes. He heard that you are hard up just now, and that you are going up +the river a considerable distance to hunt--is not that so?" + +"Yes, that is true. We start off to-morrow." + +"Well, then, he gave me this order for some supplies of powder and shot, +twine and hooks, with some cloth, beads, and such like for Slowfoot." + +"That is very good of the Governor--very considerate," said La Certe +with a pleased look. + +"Very good," said Sutherland. "Now, La Certe, suppose it true that men +are meant to make the best of circumstances as they find them, and that +I was a man without any regard to principle, I might have drawn these +supplies from the store for you, and used them myself, and you would not +have been a bit the wiser." + +Again the half-breed laughed, and admitted the truth of the proposition, +while Slowfoot expressed her belief, (whatever it was), in a more than +usually emphatic "Hee! hee!" + +Returning home from his apparently useless errand, Sutherland met Fred +Jenkins with a gun on his shoulder. The seaman was accompanied by +Archie Sinclair. + +"Well, Jenkins," he said, heartily, "you must be like a fish out o' +water in these regions. Don't you feel a longing, sometimes, for the +roar of the gale and the smell o' the salt sea?" + +"Can't say as I does, Mr Sutherland. I've bin used to accommodate +myself to circumstances, dee see, ever since I was a small shaver; so +nothin' comes exactly amiss to me--" + +"O Fred! how can you tell thumpers like that?" interrupted the forward +Archie. "Isn't Elise Morel a miss to you? and Elspie, and Jessie +Davidson?" + +"Clap a stopper on your mug, you young scape grace!" retorted the +seaman, who had some doubt as to whether the boy's putting Elise Morel's +name first was intentional or an accident. "As I was a-going to say, +sir, I was always fond o' changes, an' the rollin' plains come to me as +pleasant, though not quite so familiar, as the rollin' sea." + +"That's a satisfactory state o' mind, anyhow," returned the Elder. "But +where away now?--to cater for the pot, I dare say." + +"Well, no, not exactly--though I've no objection to do that too in the +by-goin'. But we've heard a report that a band o' Sioux are goin' to +visit the Settlement, and as there's a lot o' their enemies, the +Saulteaux, knocking about, I've bin sent to the fort by old McKay to see +if they've heard about the Sioux comin', an' if there's likely to be a +scrimmage, so as we may clear for action, d'ee see?" + +"I see; and I hope there will be no need to clear for action. I'm glad +to see Archie with you too," said Sutherland, "but surprised; for I +don't remember when I saw him without Little Bill on his back or at his +side." + +"O, as to that, Little Bill has forsaken me," said Archie, "or I have +forsaken him--I'm not sure which--since Dan Davidson's accident, for he +does little else but sit at Dan's bedside, readin' to him or talking +with him." + +"The dear little fellow could not be better employed," remarked the +Elder. + +"The dear little fellow could be _much_ better employed," retorted the +boy, with unexpected decision. "He could be rambling about the plains +or in the bush with me, getting strength to his muscles and fresh air to +his lungs, an' health to his body--to say nothing of his soul." + +"Why, you are becoming jealous, lad," said Sutherland, with a laugh. + +"No, I'm not _becoming_ jealous; I'm jealous already," returned the boy, +with an air that was half jocular, half serious. "However, I'll +exercise patience a little longer, but I'm determined not to let Little +Bill be sacrificed for the sake of sick-nursing." + +With this announcement of his unalterable resolve to stand to his guns, +and a "Brayvo, youngster!" from Jenkins, they parted and went on their +several ways. + +It was found, when Fort Garry was reached, that the rumour of a visit +from the Sioux Indians was correct, and that some preparation was being +made for their reception, as well as precautions against any mischief +that might be contemplated, though there was not much to be apprehended +on that score, for the Sioux were believed to be among the bravest as +well as the most powerful of the nations east of the Rocky Mountains, +and less addicted to treachery or cruelty than most other tribes. + +Two days later the Sioux made their appearance. They formed only a +small band of warriors, but were a wild-looking though fine set of men; +erect, muscular, tall fellows, with the free bearing of practised +warriors, and in all the paint, charcoal, feathers, and leather-costume, +bear-claw collars, etcetera, peculiar to the western wilderness. + +Their object, they said, was to smoke the pipe of peace with their +enemies the Saulteaux, and to see with their own eyes the wonderful +things that by report the Palefaces were doing in Red River. + +"The Sioux have heard," said their principal chief, at a palaver with +the Governor, "that the Palefaces are building wooden Wigwams in number +like the stones on the shores of Lake Winnipeg; that they are growing +much grain; that they have set up many strange things which they compel +the wind to work for them, and so grind their grain; that they have +great heaps of powder and ball, and big wigwams that are bursting with +things that the Sioux love to exchange for the meat and skins of the +buffalo and other beasts great and small. We have come to see all this +with our own eyes, for most of us are young men who have only heard of +such things from our fathers. Waugh!" + +Of course everything was said to encourage this laudable desire for +knowledge. The visitors were shown over the fort. Food was given to +them, and tobacco; then the pipe of peace was smoked with a band of +Saulteaux, which chanced to be on a friendly visit to the settlement at +the time, after which, as was customary on such occasions, both parties +mixed together and strolled about to see the settlers. + +One party of them found their way to Prairie Cottage. At some of the +houses nearer the fort they had learned the method of lifting the latch +of a door so as to obtain entrance. Finding no one outside at the +cottage, they entered the central hall with the soft, quiet tread of the +panther. As no one chanced to be there, they continued their +explorations with childlike simplicity, and thus most unexpectedly found +themselves in the bedroom of Dan Davidson, where Little Bill had just +read himself and his brother-invalid into a sound sleep. Both wakened +up at once, and the boy sat bolt upright in blazing astonishment, but +Dan, who had heard of their arrival in the Settlement, received them +with a few words of welcome. + +Fortunately for all parties, Okematan presented himself just then, +having, while at work in the garden, seen the party of Sioux arrive. He +did his best to act the host, explaining to the visitors the cause of +Dan's weakness, and, by Dan's directions, offering them tobacco and +pipes. + +While they were thus engaged, old McKay entered. + +"I saw you comin', lads," he said, heartily. "What cheer? what cheer?" +he added, shaking hands with them all round. + +The Sioux were obviously much pleased with their reception, especially +when Mrs Davidson, Jessie, and Elspie, who had been out walking, +returned and joined the party. + +After showing the Indians everything in the house, old McKay--who +constituted himself their guide,--took them out to see the live stock +and the farm. He led them first into the garden. + +It chanced at this time that there was a "snake in the grass" not far +off. This was no other than the bad Indian Kateegoose. + +Why some people are what we call naturally bad, like Kateegoose, while +others are what we call naturally good, like Okematan, is a mystery the +investigation of which we propose postponing to a more convenient +season. Of course no sane person will maintain that this mystery frees +fallen man from responsibility. If it did, we could no longer hang for +murder. It would be the bounden duty of every judge, in that case, to +acquit every murderer with "Poor fellow, it was his fate; he could not +help it!" and send him away with a pat on the shoulder, and an order for +coffee and buns, perhaps, in his pocket. As none but sane persons, +however, will read my book, it is not necessary to enlarge further on +this head. + +Certain it is that Kateegoose was "bad"--obdurately bad--had been so +from his very cradle, if he ever had one, which is doubtful, and bade +fair to continue so to his grave. Sutherland had button-holed him more +than once, but apparently in vain. It is only fair to the savage to say +that he listened patiently to the Elder's remonstrances, and attentively +to his exhortations, and assumed an aspect of mild contrition that might +or might not have been sincere--as far as appearance went. + +Now, it unfortunately happened that among the Sioux braves there was a +man who had done Kateegoose a deadly injury of some sort, which nothing +short of blood could wipe out. Kateegoose, in familiar parlance, +spotted him at once, and dogged his steps through the Settlement, +watching his opportunity for revenge. In savage life this dogging +process would not have been possible, but in a comparatively crowded +settlement, and in the midst of all the surprising novelties that +surrounded the Palefaces, it was all too easy; for Kateegoose took care +to keep as much as possible in the background, and well under cover of +houses, cottages, carts, stacks, and wigwams; besides which he had +painted his face in such a manner, and so modified his costume, that his +own acquaintances among the settlers--he had no friends--failed to +recognise him. They, in their comparative ignorance of savage life, set +him down as one of the visitors, while the visitors, if they noticed him +at all, esteemed him one of the cross-breeds of the Settlement. + +The only man who saw through the disguise of Kateegoose was Okematan, +who could not understand why he had adopted it, and who resolved to keep +a sharp eye on him. + +The enemy of Kateegoose was one of the younger Sioux chiefs. He led the +party which visited Prairie Cottage. + +The garden of the Cottage, at its lower end towards the river, +approached close to the confines of a thick coppice. It formed the +extremity of a belt of woodland which at that time bordered the river. +There a small summer-house had been erected by Dan and Peter Davidson +for the benefit of their mother and their sister Jessie. + +Kateegoose, while dogging his foe, recognised this as a spot very +suitable for his fell purpose, as the contiguous wood afforded a ready +means of escape after the deed should be done. + +While old McKay was conducting the Sioux slowly through the garden, +Kateegoose glided swiftly through the thicket to the spot where the +summer-house stood, and took up a position behind it, so that the party +in making the round of the garden would necessarily pass close to him. + +From the window of Dan's room, Little Bill observed part of these +mysterious movements and suspected mischief. Without uttering a word he +left the room, opened the front door, and gave a low whistle, which had +been set up as a private signal between him and Okematan. In a few +seconds the Cree chief was by his side. + +"Oke, there's mischief intended. You'll have to be quick," he said, +quickly explaining what he had seen. + +"Rejoin the party at once," he added, "and look out--sharp." + +The chief nodded and walked away. So swift, yet so quiet, had been his +movements that none of the whites of the party had observed his +departure from them. The Sioux, however, had noticed it, and their +suspicions were aroused, especially when they saw him rejoin the party, +and observed that he walked rather closer to them than before. But they +were proud warriors and refused by word, look, or movement, to indicate +their suspicions. They carried bows in their hands, arrows in their +quivers, tomahawks and scalping-knives in their belts, but they scorned +to make any visible demonstration of being on guard in the midst of +Paleface friends, though they gave intense and undivided attention to +the movements of Okematan. + +This concentration of attention on the wrong man was, of course, rather +favourable to the designs of Kateegoose, so that, when the party passed +the summer-house, he was enabled to spring upon his enemy, unobserved +for the first moment, with knife upraised. But the stab from which the +Sioux chief could not have escaped was rendered harmless by the prompt +action of Okematan, who threw up his left arm, turned the blow aside, +and received a slight wound in doing so. + +There was no time to repeat the blow. With a yell of mingled defiance +and disappointment the would-be assassin leaped the garden fence, +bounded into the thicket, and disappeared. A flight of Sioux arrows +entered the bush almost the moment after. The young chief and his +friends also leaped the fence, and followed in pursuit. + +The Sioux were swift and agile undoubtedly, but so was Kateegoose, and +he had the advantage of knowing the ground, while the trail--by which, +in ordinary circumstances, the Red-man can track his enemy through the +forest--was not available there in consequence of its being so mingled +up with the crossing and re-crossing of the innumerable tracks of +settlers. The result was that Kateegoose made his escape. + +The Colonists were very indignant at the perpetration of this cowardly +act, for it compromised their character for hospitality; and, if they +could have laid hands on the savage at the time, it is not impossible +that Lynch-law might have been applied to him. The Governor also was +greatly annoyed, and in the afternoon of the following day made the +visitors a number of presents, besides providing for them a feast; but +all his good intentions were spoiled by Kateegoose, who had the audacity +to come forward and deliberately shoot his foe while the Sioux were at +meat. The ball passed quite through the Sioux chief's body, and wounded +the man who was next to him. After this dastardly act the villain fled, +and again got safe away. + +The enraged Sioux, seizing their weapons, would have wreaked their +vengeance on the Saulteaux, if they could have discovered any; but these +wily savages had cleared away at the first note of alarm, and not one +was to be found. To have attacked the whites with so small a party +would have been useless as well as unjust. They therefore left the +colony in fierce anger. + +It chanced that La Certe had pitched his tent the day before on a stream +not far-distant from the colony. The Sioux had to pass that way, and, +espying the wigwam, turned aside to wreak their vengeance on whomsoever +it might contain. Fortunately the owner of the mansion and his wife had +gone out fishing in a canoe, and taken the child with them. All that +the Sioux could do, therefore, was to appropriate the poor man's goods +and chattels; but as the half-breed had taken his gun, ammunition, and +fishing-tackle with him, there was not much left to appropriate. Having +despoiled the mansion, they set fire to it and went their way. + +Returning in the evening, La Certe found his house a heap of ashes, and +himself reduced to a state of destitution. This being his normal state, +however, he was not profoundly affected. Neither was his wife; still +less was his child. + +He said no word, but carried the contents of the canoe on shore. His +wife, equally reticent, helped him. His child, lighting its father's +pipe, sat down to smoke and look on. + +They turned the canoe bottom up to serve as a partial shelter; they +kindled a huge fire before it; they set up three large fat ducks to +roast in front of it, and were soon busy with a simple but satisfying +supper. After washing this down with an unstimulating draught of pure +water, they put the baby to bed under the bow of the canoe, filled their +pipes, and sat down before the ruddy blaze to mingle their hopes, joys, +prospects, and sorrows in a halo of smoke--the very personification of +primitive contentment and felicity. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY EIGHT. + +VERY PERPLEXING INTERVIEWS WITH LITTLE BILL. + +Things in the colony had at this time come to what may be styled a +complicated pass, for distress and starvation were rampant on the one +hand, while on the other hand the weather was superb, giving prospect at +last of a successful harvest. + +The spring buffalo-hunt had been but partially successful, so that a +number of the buffalo runners had to make arrangements to support +themselves by fishing during the autumn in lakes Winnipeg and Manitoba. + +In these great fresh-water seas there is an unlimited quantity of rich +and finely flavoured whitefish, or Titameg, besides other fish. But +Titameg are only to be caught in large quantities during autumn, and of +course much of the success of fishing depends on weather--one gale +sometimes visiting the fishermen with ruin--ruin all the more complete +that the nets which may be carried away have in many cases to be paid +for out of the produce of the season's fishing. + +In addition to the buffalo-hunters, who were obliged to support +themselves by fishing, there was a large number of idle half-breeds, of +a much lower type than these plain hunters, who had to betake themselves +to the same pursuit. These were the "ne'er-do-weels" of the colony; men +who, like La Certe, with more or less--usually less--of his good-nature, +seemed to hold that all the industrious people in the world were created +to help or to support them and their families. Of course when the +industrious people were unsuccessful, these idlers were obliged to work +for their living, which, being unaccustomed to do anything energetic, +they found it hard and difficult to do, and generally regarded +themselves as the harshly used victims of a tyrannous fate. + +There was one thing, however, at which these idlers were very expert and +diligent--they begged well, and with persistency. No wonder; for their +lives often depended on their persistent and successful begging. The +Company and the private storekeepers were always more or less willing to +risk their goods by advancing them on credit. Before the summer was +over, most of these people had got their supplies and were off to the +fishing grounds, regardless of the future, with large quantities of tea +and tobacco, and happy as kings are said to be--but never are, if +history be true! + +Among these, of course, was La Certe. That typical idler had made the +most of his misfortunes. Everybody had heard what the Sioux had done to +him, and everybody had pitied him. Pity opens the heart, and that opens +the hand; and, when the poor man entered a store with the polite manner +of a French Canadian and the humble aspect of a ruined man, he scarcely +required to beg. One man lent him a tent. Another lent him a canoe. +From the Company's store at Fort Garry he received a fair outfit of +nearly all that he could require. Further down the Settlement there was +a private store-keeper with a jovial countenance. + +"O it was a sad, sad sight!" he said to this man on entering the +store--"so very sad to see my tent in ashes, and nothing left--nothing-- +absolutely!" The jovial man was moved. He gave La Certe what he asked +for--even pressed things on him, and also bestowed on him a considerable +"gratuity." + +Still further down the Settlement the unfortunate man found the store, +or shop, of another friend. This man was saturnine of countenance, but +moderately liberal of heart. La Certe approached him with an air so +pitiful that the saturnine man melted like snow in the sunshine or wax +under heat. + +"I have heard of your loss," he said, "and I will give you credit _this_ +time, La Certe, though you _are_ so bad at paying your debts. But I +won't give you much." + +"I do not want much," returned the afflicted man in tones of deep +humility--"only a little--a very little." + +By asking much more than he required, La Certe obtained as much as he +wanted from the saturnine man, and thus he finally started for Lake +Winnipeg with a canoe laden, almost to sinking, with the good things of +this life. + +The fineness of that summer brought forth the fruits of the earth in +great luxuriance, and it really seemed as if at last the Scotch settlers +were going to reap some reward for all their prolonged perseverance and +industry. The long rest, the good feeding, the sunshine of nature, and +the starlight of Elspie's eyes had a powerful effect on Dan Davidson's +health, so that, by the time autumn arrived and the prospects of a +splendid harvest became more certain every day, he had recovered much of +his usual strength of body and vigour of mind. + +Little Bill also felt the genial influences around him, and, to the +intense joy of Archie, became visibly fatter and stronger, while his +large blue eyes lost some of that wistfully solemn appearance with which +they had been wont to gaze inquiringly into people's faces. + +One afternoon Billie, having walked to the summer house in the Prairie +Cottage garden, along with Archie, was left alone there at his own +request, for, unlike other boys, he was fond of occasional solitary +meditation. + +"Now mind, Little Bill--you whistle if you want me," said Archie, when +about to leave him. "I'll hear you, for I'm only going to the +carpenter's shed." + +"I will, Archie, if I want you; but I don't think I shall, for I can +walk by myself now, quite easily, as far as the house." + +But Little Bill was not destined to be left to solitary meditations that +day, for his brother had not left him more than a few minutes when a +footstep was heard on the path outside, and next moment Fred Jenkins +presented himself at the opening of the summer-house. The face of the +mariner betrayed him, for he was too honest by nature to dissemble +effectively. + +"Well, Fred, how are you? You seem a little disappointed, I think." + +"Not exactly disappointed, Little Bill, but sort o' ways scumbusticated, +so to speak--perplexed, if I may say so. Kind o' ways puzzled, d'ee +see?" + +There was something very amusing in the manner of the strapping seaman +as he sat down beside the puny little boy, with a bashful expression on +his handsome face, as if he were about to make a humiliating confession. + +"What troubles you, Jenkins?" asked Billie, with the air of a man who is +ready to give any amount of advice, or, if need be, consolation. + +The seaman twisted his eyebrows into a complex form, and seemed +uncertain how to proceed. Suddenly he made up his mind. + +"Was you ever in love, Little Bill?" he asked abruptly, and with a smile +that seemed to indicate a feeling that the question was absurd. + +"O yes," answered the boy quite coolly. "I've been in love with brother +Archie ever since I can remember." + +Jenkins looked at his little friend with a still more complicated knot +of puzzlement in his eyebrows, for he felt that Billie was scarcely +fitted by years or experience to be a useful confidant. After resting +his hands on his knees, and his eyes on the ground, for some time, he +again made up his mind and turned to Billie, who sat with his large eyes +fixed earnestly on the countenance of his tall friend, wondering what +perplexed him so much, and waiting for further communications. + +"Little Bill," said Jenkins, laying a large hand on his small knee, "in +course you can't be expected to understand what I wants to talk about, +but there's nobody else I'd like to speak to, and you're such a knowin' +little shaver that somehow I felt a kind of--of notion that I'd like to +ask your advice--d'ee see?" + +"I see--all right," returned Billie; "though I wonder at such a man as +you wanting advice from the like of me. But I'll do what I can for you, +Jenkins, and perhaps I know more about the thing that troubles you than +you think." + +"I'm afraid not," returned the seaman, with a humorous twinkle in his +eye. "You see, Billie, you never wanted to get spliced, did you?" + +"Spliced! What's that?" + +"Well, I should have said married." + +"O no! I don't think the thought of that ever did occur to me. I'm +sorry, Jenkins, but I really cannot give you advice on that subject." + +"H'm! I'm not so sure o' that, Little Bill. You're such a practical +little chap that I do believe if you was put to it you'd be able to-- +see, now. If you happened to want to marry a nice little gal, what +would you do?" + +"I would ask her," said Little Bill, promptly. + +"Jus' so; but that is what I have not got courage to do." + +Jenkins laughed at the expression of blazing surprise with which the boy +received this statement. + +"Have not got courage!" he repeated; and then, after a pause--"Have all +the stories you have told me, then, been nothing but lies!" + +"What stories, Billie?" + +"Why, such as that one about the pirates in the Java seas, when ten of +them attacked you and you were obliged to kill four, and all the rest +ran away?" + +"No, Billie--that was no lie: it was quite true. But, then, these +blackguards were cowards at bottom, and they saw that I'd got a brace o' +double-barrelled pistols in my belt, and was pretty well up in the +cutlass exercise." + +"And that time when you led a storming party against the fort in South +America, and was the only one left o' the party, and fought your way all +alone in through the breach till the troops came up and carried you on +with a rush, and--and--was all about that untrue?" + +"Not a bit of it, Billie, though I wouldn't have you think I was +boastin' about it. I only gave you the bare facts, which, like bare +poles, is as much as a ship can stand sometimes." + +"An' that time you jumped overboard in Port Royal among the sharks to +save the little girl?" + +"That's a fact, if ever there was one," said the seaman quickly, "for +the dear child is alive this good day to swear to it if need be." + +"Yet you tell me," continued Little Bill, "that you have not the courage +to ask a nice little girl to marry you?" + +"That's exactly how the matter stands, Billie." + +It was now Billie's turn to look perplexed. + +"Who is this nice little girl?" he asked abruptly, as if the answer to +that question might help to explain the enigma. + +"Well--it's Elise Morel; an', mind, not a soul knows about that but you +an' me, Little Bill." + +"But--but Elise is _not_ a little girl. She's a big woman!" + +Jenkins laughed as he explained that seamen sometimes had a habit-- +mistaken, it might be--of calling even big women "nice little gals" when +they chanced to be fond of them. + +"And are you _really_ afraid to ask Elise to marry you?" asked the boy, +earnestly. + +"I suspect that's what's the matter wi' me," replied the sailor, with a +modest look. + +"I always thought that nothing could frighten you," said Billie, in a +somewhat disappointed tone, for it seemed to him as if one of his idols +were shaking on its pedestal. "I can't understand it, for _I_ would not +be afraid to ask her--if I wanted her." + +At this Jenkins again laughed, and said that he believed him, and that +Billie would understand these things better when he was older. + +"In the meantime, Little Bill," he continued, "I haven't got the heart +of a Mother Carey's chicken. I could stand afore a broadside without +winkin', I believe; I think I could blow up a magazine, or fight the +French, as easy as I could eat my breakfast a'most, but to ask a pure, +beautiful angel like Elise to marry _me_, a common seaman--why, I hasn't +got it in me. Yet I'm so fond o' that little gal that I'd strike my +colours to _her_ without firin' a single shot--" + +"Does Elise want to marry _you_?" asked Billie. + +"Oh, that's the very pint!" said the seaman with decision. "If I could +only make sure o' that pint, I'd maybe manage to come up to the scratch. +Now, that's what I wants you to find out for me, Little Bill, an' I +know you're a good little shaver, as'll do a friend a good turn when you +can. But you must on no account mention--" + +He was going to have said, "You must on no account mention that I was +blabbing to you about this, or that I wanted to find out such a thing," +when the sudden appearance of Elise's lap-dog announced the fact that +its mistress was approaching. + +With a flushed face the bold seaman sprang up and darted out, as if to +attack one of those pirates of the Java seas who had made so powerful an +impression on Little Bill's mind. But his object was escape--not +attack. Lightly vaulting the garden fence, he disappeared into the same +thicket which, on another occasion, had afforded opportune refuge to +Kateegoose. A few moments later Elise turned into the walk, and stood +before the summer-house. + +"You here, Little Bill!" she exclaimed on entering, "I am very glad to +find you, for I have been alone all the morning. Everybody is away--in +the fields, I suppose--and I don't like being alone." + +"Was you ever in love, Elise?" asked the boy with a solemn countenance. + +The girl laughed heartily, and blushed a little. + +"What a strange question, Billie," she said; "why do you ask?" + +"Well, it's not easy to explain all at once; but--but I want to know if +you want to be married?" + +Elise laughed again, and, then, becoming suddenly grave, asked seriously +why Billie put such foolish questions. + +"Because," said Little Bill, slowly, and with an earnest look, "Jenkins +is _very_ anxious to know if you are fond of him, and he actually says +that he's afraid to ask you to marry him! Isn't that funny? I said +that even _I_ would not be afraid to ask you, if I wanted you--How red +you are, Elise! Have you been running?" + +"O no," replied the girl, sheltering herself under another laugh; "and +what did he say to that?" + +"He said a great many things. I will try to remember them. Let me +see--he said: `I haven't got the heart of a Mother Carey's +chicken,'--(he didn't tell me who Mother Carey is, but that's no matter, +for it was only one of her chickens he was speaking of);--`I could stand +afore a broadside without winkin','--(I give you his very words, Elise, +for I don't quite understand them myself);--`I could blow up a +magazine,' he went on, `or fight the French, as easy as I could eat my +breakfast, a'most, but to ask a pure an' beautiful angel like Elise'-- +yes, indeed, you needn't shake your head; he said these very words +exactly--`a pure an' beautiful angel like Elise to marry _me_, a common +seaman, why, I hasn't got it in me. Yet I'm so fond o' that little gal +that I'd strike my colours to her without firin' a single shot.' Now, +do you understand all that, Elise? for I don't understand the half of +it." + +"O yes, I understand a good deal of it, though some of it is indeed +puzzling, as you say. But how did you come to recollect it all so well, +Little Bill?" + +"Because he said he wanted me to help him, and to find out if you wanted +to marry him, so I paid particular attention to what he said, and--" + +"Did he tell you to tell me all this?" asked Elise abruptly, and with +sudden gravity. + +"O dear, no; but as he wanted me to find it out for him, and said that +not a soul knew about the matter but me, I thought the simplest way +would be to tell you all he said, and then ask you straight. He was +going to tell me something more, very particularly, for he was just +saying, in a very solemn tone, `You must on no account mention--' when +your little dog bounced in and Jenkins bounced out, leaving the rest of +it unsaid." + +"Then he has just left you?" said Elise. + +"Just a moment or two before you came up. I think he must have seen +some sort of beast in the wood, and gone in chase of it, he bolted in +such a hurry, so I don't know yet what I was not to mention." + +"Now, Little Bill," said Elise with great seriousness of tone and +manner, "you must not tell Mr Jenkins one word of the conversation that +you and I have had just now." + +"What! not a single word?" + +"Not one. You understand?" + +"Yes, but, if he asks me, I must answer something, you know, and I must +not tell lies." + +"Quite true, Billie. You must not tell lies on any account whatever. +Now, listen. If he asks you about our conversation this morning, you +must say that I told you you were never to open your lips about the +subject again either to me or to him or to anybody. Mr Jenkins is an +honourable man, and will not ask you a single question after that." + +"Then I'm not to tell him whether you want to marry him?" + +"How can you tell him what you don't know?" + +"Well, but, I mean that you're not going to tell me, so that I might +tell him?" + +"Certainly not." + +"Not a word to him and not a word to you--nor to anybody! Not even to +Archie!" + +"Yes. That is exactly what you must promise me." + +"This is a very unpleasant state of things," said Little Bill, with a +sad and puzzled countenance, "but of course I promise, for it is your +affair, you know." + +It was a notable fact, which Little Bill did not fail to note--but did +not dare to mention--that after that date there was a distinct change of +demeanour in Elise Morel towards the handsome sailor--whether in his +favour or otherwise it was impossible to tell. + +Meanwhile, events were pending which were destined to exercise a very +powerful influence over the fortunes of the Red River Colony, and, +indeed, over the condition of the whole of Rupert's Land. + + + +CHAPTER TWENTY NINE. + +THE FISHERY DISASTERS. + +One fine day, when summer had merged into autumn, and things in Red +River appeared to be advancing favourably, and Dan Davidson had +recovered his strength, and Little Bill was fairly well, it occurred to +Okematan that he would like to go to Lake Winnipeg, and see how the +settlers who had gone to the fishery there, were getting on. + +You see, the Cree chief was an observant savage, and, before returning +to his tribe, had made up his mind to see all the phases in the life of +the new Palefaces who had thus come to take possession of the land. + +He was a remarkably independent fellow, and as he served the Davidsons +for nothing except his food--which he did not count, as he could easily +have supplied himself with victuals by means of his line, bow, and gun-- +he did not deem it necessary to ask leave of absence. He merely went to +the house one morning, and announced his intention of going to Lake +Winnipeg to fish. + +"I will go with you," said Dan, to whom the announcement was made. + +"An' so will I," said Fred Jenkins, who chanced to be conversing with +Dan at the time--"that is, if they can spare me just now." + +"The canoe of Okematan," said the chief, "holds no more than three. He +wishes to take with him Arch-ee and Leetil Bill." + +"Very well," returned Dan, "there's no objection to that, for there is +not much doing on the farm at this moment, and Archie has worked hard +all the summer, so he deserves a holiday. We will just make up the same +party that started last time, only that Fergus and I will take a +somewhat bigger canoe so as to accommodate you, Jenkins." + +"Thankee. Though I am big--unfort'nitly--I can stow myself away in +small compass, an' I've larned how, when there ain't overmuch grub, to +git along fairly well on short allowance. When d'ee trip your anchor?-- +I mean, when do ye start?" + +"When to-morrow's sun touches the tree-tops in the east," said the +Indian chief. + +"All right, Okematan, I'm your man--after layin' in a breakfast-cargo." + +According to this arrangement the two canoes pushed off at daybreak the +following morning, from the wharf at the foot of the garden of Prairie +Cottage, and began the descent of the Red River, which, after flowing +between twenty and thirty miles northward, enters the mighty bosom of +Lake Winnipeg. Okematan and Archie occupied their old places in the +stern and bow of the chief's canoe, with Little Bill in the middle--this +time using a paddle, for his strength had greatly increased. The other +canoe was steered by Dan; Fergus acted bowman, and Jenkins sat between +them, also wielding a paddle. + +That night they encamped on the banks of the river, for their progress +had been slow, owing to sundry visits which had to be paid to settlers +on the way down. + +"Well, now," observed the sailor, as he stood by the camp-fire smoking +his pipe contemplatively, "I find that as circumstances change about in +this world men's minds are apt to go 'bout-ship along wi' them." + +"That sounds a terribly profound speech, Fred," said Archie, who was +busy at his very usual occupation of whittling an arrow for his brother. +"Did your father teach it you, or did you crib it from a copy-book?" + +"No, I raither think," retorted the seaman quietly, "that I got it from +your grandmother by the father's side." + +"What may be the circumstance that has caused your mind to go about-ship +just now?" asked Dan, stirring the fire under the robbiboo-kettle. + +"Well, it's in regard to them there canoe-paddles. Although they do +seem small, compared with oars, I find they're quite big enough to do +the work, and although I've bin trained from a youngster to handle the +oar, an' go like a crab with my back the way I'm pullin', it do seem +more sensible-like to sit wi' one's face to the front and drive ahead;-- +anyhow, it's more comfortable and satisfactory." + +"Look out, Jenkins!" exclaimed Little Bill, "else your duck won't be +satisfactory--it's burnin' now." + +"O, never mind," remarked Fergus, lighting his pipe. "It iss havin' it +well done he would be fond of." + +"Ay, but not over-done," cried the seaman, snatching the duck in +question from before the blaze and turning its other side--for they used +no spits in the Nor'-West in those days, but cooked one side at a time-- +nay, even carved off and ate part of the cooked side while the other +side was roasting. + +Next day they came out on the ocean-like expanse of the great lake, and +steered along its western shores until they reached the fishery, where +numbers of rudely-constructed wigwams and a few tents sheltered the +fishing community. + +They had just returned from a successful visit to the nets when the +visitors arrived, and all was animation and rejoicing at the successful +take. Jacques Bourassin was the first man they met on landing, and he +was enthusiastic about the prospects before them. Slowfoot was the +first woman, and she was quite satisfied--in that amiable state of +mental and physical felicity in which it is so easy to believe that "all +is for the best." Her husband soon after appeared. He, of course, was +also greatly pleased. He had joined the fishers because he believed +that plenty of food, tea, and tobacco would be going amongst them. He +was not mistaken. + +"You will come to my tent," he said, in the wealth of his hospitality; +"we have plenty of good fish, a very little meat, some tobacco, and +oceans of tea!" + +The six visitors accepted the invitation, and were soon made acquainted +with all the gossip of the community. + +"Does it always smoke?" whispered Little Bill to his brother. + +The "it" referred to was Baby La Certe, which had, as usual, possessed +itself of its father's pipe when the mother was not watching. + +"I'm not sure, Little Bill, but I think that it does its best." + +It was observed, especially by Fred Jenkins, that the tea-drinking which +went on at this place was something marvellous. + +"There's that squaw sittin' there," he said, "she's bin an' swigged +three pannikins o' tea while I've bin looking at her--an' it's as black +as ink. What's that brown stuff they put into it, does any one know?" + +"That? Why, it is maple sugar," answered Archie, "an' capital stuff it +is to eat too." + +"Ah, I know that, for I've ate it in lump, but it can't be so good in +tea, I fancy, as or'nary brown or white sugar; but it's better than fat, +anyhow." + +"Fat!" exclaimed Little Bill, "surely you never heard of any one taking +fat in tea, did you?" + +"Ay, that I did. Men that move about the world see strange things. Far +stranger things than people invent out o' their own brains. Why, there +was one tribe that I saw in the East who putt fat in the tea, an' +another putt salt, and after they'd swallowed this queer kind of +tea-soup, they divided the leaves among themselves an' chawed 'em up +like baccy." + +The evident delight with which these half-breeds and more than +half-Indians swallowed cup after cup of the blackest and bitterest tea, +proved beyond question their appreciation of the article, and afforded +presumptive evidence at least that tea is not in their case as poisonous +as we are taught to believe. + +But it was not, as Jenkins remarked, all fair weather, fun, and tea at +the fishery. After the six visitors had been there for a week, shooting +and assisting in the canoes, and at the nets, there came a night when +the forces of Nature declared war against the half-breeds and those +settlers who had cast in their lot with them at that time. + +Jenkins, Okematan, and Archie had been out with their guns that day--the +last having been promoted to the use of the dangerous weapon--and in +their wanderings had about nightfall come upon a family of half-breeds +named Dobelle, a good-natured set, who lived, like La Certe, on the +_laissez faire_ principle; who dwelt in a little log-hut of their own +construction within the margin of the forest, not far from the shore of +the great lake. + +This family, though claiming to be Christian and civilised, was little +better than vagrant and savage. They were to some extent as independent +as the brute creation around them--though of course they betrayed the +inherent weakness of mankind in being unable to exist happily without +tea, sugar, and tobacco. For the rest, their wants were few and easily +satisfied. Snares provided willow-grouse and rabbits; traps gave them +furs and the means of purchasing guns and powder. Their log-hut was +only an occasional residence. Wherever night overtook them they were at +home. They camped on the open plains, in the woods, among the rocks, +and on the margins of rivers and lakes. Healthy, happy, and heedless, +the Dobelle family cared for nothing apparently, but the comfort of the +passing hour; regarded the past as a convenient magazine from which to +draw subjects for gossip and amusement, and left the future to look +after itself. + +There were in the hut, when the three visitors entered, old Dobelle, his +wife, a daughter of eighteen, another of four, and two sons of twenty +and twenty-two respectively. + +"It looks like dirty weather," said Jenkins on entering; "will you let +us come to an anchor here for a bit?" + +"Give us shelter?" explained Archie, who doubted old Dobelle's ability +to understand nautical language. + +"You are welcome," said the half-breed, making way politely, and +pointing to places on the floor where the visitors were expected to +squat. For there was no furniture in that mansion; the fire was kindled +in the middle of its one room; the family sat around it on deer and +buffalo skins, and the smoke alike of pipe and fire found egress at the +crevices in the roof. + +With kind hospitality Madame Dobelle poured some black tea into cups of +birch-bark, and, on plates of the same material, spread before them the +remains of a feast of roasted fish. + +While eating this, various questions were put as to the success of the +fishery. + +"Yes--we have been very successful," said old Dobelle. "No bad weather +to speak of, and plenty of fish. Our good fortune is great." + +"But it won't last long," said the eldest son, who seemed to be the only +growler in the family. + +"_N'importe_--we will enjoy it while it lasts," said the younger son. + +"Yes, truly we will," remarked Madame Dobelle. Whereupon the daughter +of eighteen smiled, and the daughter of four giggled. + +"What does Okematan think?" asked the host. + +Thus appealed to, the chief gave it as his opinion that something was +going to happen, for the sky in the nor'-west looked uncommonly black. +Having given utterance to this cautious remark he relapsed into silence. + +As if to justify his opinion, a tremendous clap of thunder seemed to +rend the heavens at that moment, and, a few minutes later, a heavy +shower of rain fell. + +"Well that we got inside before that came on," said Archie. "I hope it +won't come on to blow, else we shall be storm-stayed here." + +The weather seemed to be in a lively mood that night, for as the thunder +had promptly answered to Okematan's observation, so now the wind replied +to Archie's remark, by rushing up the natural avenue which extended from +the hut to the lake and almost bursting in the door. + +"See to the ropes, boys," said old Dobelle, glancing uneasily at the +roof. + +The young men arose, went out, regardless of weather, and secured with +additional care a couple of stout ropes with which the tendency of the +roof to fly away was restrained. + +"Did it ever come off?" asked Archie with some curiosity, as the young +men returned and resumed their pipes. + +"Yes--twice, and both times it was night," answered Madame Dobelle, "and +we were flooded out and had to camp under the trees." + +"Which was not comfortable," added the old man. Another clap of thunder +seemed to corroborate what he said, and a blast of wind followed, which +caused the whole fabric of the hut to shudder. Jenkins looked +inquiringly at the roof. + +"No fear of it," said old Dobelle; "the ropes are strong." + +Thus assured, the visitors continued their meal with equanimity, +regardless of the storm that soon began to rage with great fury, +insomuch that the door required a prop to keep it up and rain began to +trickle in through crevices in the roof and drop here and there upon the +party. When one such drop chanced to fall on old Dobelle's nose, his +younger son arose, and, fastening a piece of birch-bark to the rafters, +caught the drop and trained it with its followers to flow towards an +unoccupied place in one corner, which, being accidentally lower than the +rest of the floor, formed a convenient receptacle for superfluous water. + +At the same time Madame Dobelle made a shakedown of pine-branches in +another corner for her visitors, for it was obvious that they would have +to spend the night there, even although their own tent was not +far-distant. + +By that time the storm was raging with unwonted violence. Nevertheless +the Dobelle family smoked on in placid contentment. When the time for +repose arrived, Madame Dobelle and her eldest girl retired to a box-bed +in a corner of the hut which was screened off--not very effectually--by +a curtain of birch-bark. The two brothers lay down in another corner. +The three visitors disposed themselves in the third, and, as the fourth +was monopolised by the rain-rivulet, old Dobelle lay down on one side of +the fire in the centre of the room, while the four-year-old girl reposed +on the other. + +During the night the accumulation of tobacco-smoke with fire-smoke +produced a suffocating effect, but no one was capable of suffocation +apparently, for they all smoked on--except Archie, who, as we have said, +had not acquired the habit. Even the four-year-old girl, like Baby La +Certe, had a pull now and then at its father's pipe, and, from sundry +white emanations from the crevices in the bark curtains, it was evident +that the ladies behind these were enjoying themselves in the same way +during the intervals of repose. + +Next morning was fine, and the three sportsmen returned to the fishery +to find that the storm had made an almost clean sweep of the nets. It +had carried most of them away; torn others to pieces, and almost ruined +the whole colony of fishermen; the ruin being all the more complete that +most of the nets had been received on credit, and were to be paid for +chiefly by the results of the autumn fishery. + +La Certe was one of the chief sufferers; nevertheless, to judge from his +looks, La Certe did not suffer much! He had brought a considerable +amount of provision with him, as we have said, and, finding that one of +his nets had been washed ashore, he proceeded very leisurely to mend it, +while he smoked and assisted Slowfoot to consume pemmican and tea. + +About this time a mysterious message was sent to Dan Davidson from Red +River by an Indian, requiring his immediate return. The sender of the +message was Elspie McKay; the summons was therefore obeyed at once. + +As nothing further could be done at the fishery that autumn, the other +members of the expedition, and most of the fishers, returned with Dan to +the colony. + + + +CHAPTER THIRTY. + +THE TRIAL FOR MURDER. + +"Dan," said Elspie, as, seated in the summer-house after the arrival of +the sportsmen, these two held a meeting, "I have called you back to tell +you of a very terrible thing which has been said of my dear brother +Duncan, and which you must contradict at once, and then find out how it +was that the false report arose, and have the matter cleared up." + +"Dear Elspie," returned Dan, "I think I know what you are going to tell +me." + +"Have you heard the report, then?" said Elspie, turning pale, "and--and +do you believe it?" + +"I have suspected--I have--but let me hear first what the report is, and +who it came from." + +"I got it from Annette Pierre, and I am sure she would not have told it +me if she did not think it true; but, then, poor Annette is not very +intelligent, and she may be--must be--mistaken. She says that it was +Duncan who killed poor Henri Perrin, and that some of the half-breeds +are determined to avenge the death of their comrade. Now, it cannot be +true; and I want you at once to go and ferret out the truth, so as to +prove the report false." + +"Have you spoken to Duncan on the subject?" asked Dan. + +"No, I cannot bear to let him imagine even for a moment that I could +believe him guilty of murder--that I even suspected him of it. But you +say you have heard something, Dan--that you suspect something. What is +it?" + +"It is difficult to say, Elspie dear. I, too, have heard the rumour +that has come to your ears, and I have seen--but it is useless talking +of our mere conjectures. I will go at once and ferret out all about it +if possible. My first business will be to see Annette and get from her +all that she knows. Where is Duncan?" + +"In the wheat-field. They have begun to shear to-day, and, as the crop +is heavy, they will be glad of your help." + +Dan went to the field, after visiting Annette Pierre, and lent good +assistance to the shearers, but, like Elspie, he found that he had not +courage to say anything to Duncan that would indicate his suspicion. He +longed to put the question straight to him, but could not prevail on +himself to do so. + +Next morning, however, he and Elspie were both saved the necessity of +doing such violence to their feelings, by the arrival of two men from +Fort Garry. They were members of a sort of police force that the +Company had enrolled, and had come to arrest Duncan McKay junior, on the +charge of murder! + +There was not much of law in the colony at that time, but it was felt +that something had to be done in the way of governing a settlement which +was rapidly increasing, and in which Lynch and mob law would certainly +be applied if regularly constituted authority did not step in. As the +murder of Perrin had created great indignation among the half-breeds, +and the feeling about it was increasing, the Company resolved to clear +the matter up by having the supposed murderer tried. Duncan was +accordingly lodged in one of the bastions of Fort Garry, where, when +visited by the Governor, he firmly denied his guilt. + +The arrest of his younger son on such a charge fell very heavily on poor +Duncan McKay senior--more heavily than those who knew him would have +expected. It touched not only his feelings but his pride; for was he +not a lineal descendant of that Fergus McKay who had been a chief in one +of the Western Isles of Scotland--he could not tell which, but no +matter--at that celebrated period of Scottish history when the great +Norse king, Harold Fairhair, had made a descent on the Scottish coast +and received one of the few thorough thrashings that darkened his +otherwise successful career? + +"O! Tuncan, Tuncan, my boy!" cried the old man, shoving his hands +deeper into his breeches pockets, and apostrophising his imprisoned son +as he walked up and down in the privacy of his own bedroom. "O that wan +o' the name should come to such disgrace! An' it's denyin' it you will +be, whether you are guilty or innocent. O Tuncan, Tuncan! you wass ever +notorious for tellin' lies--an' a troublesome boy all round--whatever." + +But when the old man went to Fort Garry and visited his son, he stifled +his pathetic feelings, and appeared before him with all the offended +dignity of an injured member of the great clan McKay. + +"Are you guilty, Tuncan?" he asked, sternly. + +"No, I'm innocent," answered the youthful Highlander, with a brow quite +as stern and a manner as dignified as the old one. + +"You will hev to prove that--whatever." + +"No--they will hev to prove me guilty," retorted the son. + +"I wish I could believe ye, Tuncan." + +"It iss not of much consequence whether ye believe me or not, father. +You are not to be my chudge--whatever." + +"That is goot luck for you, Tuncan, for if I wass your chudge I would be +bound to condemn you--you wass always so fond o' tellin' lies." + +"It iss true what you say, father. It iss a chip o' the old block that +I am--more's the peety." At this point the door of the prison opened, +and Elspie was ushered in. + +"You here, father!" she exclaimed in evident surprise. "I had hoped to +see Duncan alone." + +"It iss alone with him you'll soon be," replied the Highlander, putting +on his hat. "Goot tay, Tuncan, my boy, an' see that you'll be tellin' +the truth, if ye can, when ye come to be tried." + +To this the youth made no reply. + +"O Duncan!" said the girl, when her father had retired, "how came they +to invent such lies about you?" + +The tender way in which this was said, and the gentle touch on his arm, +almost overcame the stubborn man, but he steeled himself against such +influences. + +"What can I say, Elspie?" he replied. "How can I tell what iss the +reason that people tell lies?" + +"But it _is_ lies, isn't it, Duncan?" asked the poor girl, almost +entreatingly. + +"You say that it iss lies--whatever, an' I will not be contradictin' +you. But when the trial comes on you will see that it cannot be proved +against me, Elspie--so keep your mind easy." + +With this rather unsatisfactory assurance, Elspie was fain to rest +content, and she returned home a little, though not much, easier in her +mind. + +To make the trial quite fair and regular, a jury of twelve men, chosen +by lot from a large number, was empanelled, and as many witnesses as +possible were examined. These last were not numerous, and it is +needless to say that Annette Pierre and Marie Blanc were the chief. But +despite their evidence and the strong feeling that existed against the +prisoner, it was found impossible to convict him, so that in the end he +was acquitted and set free. But there were men in the colony who +registered a vow that Cloudbrow should not escape. They believed him to +be guilty, in spite of the trial, and made up their minds patiently to +bide their time. + +It now seemed as if at last a measure of prosperity were about to dawn +upon the farmers in that distant land, and, as usual on such occasions +of approaching prosperity, Dan Davidson and Duncan McKay senior began to +talk of the wedding which had been so long delayed. + +"I wass thinkin', Tan," remarked the old man one morning, while walking +in the verandah with his after-breakfast pipe, "that I will be getting +in the crops pretty soon this year, an' they're heavy crops too, so that +we may look forward to a comfortable winter--whatever." + +"True, and as our crops are also very good, thank God, I begin now to +hope that Elspie may see her way to--" + +"See her way!" exclaimed McKay with some asperity: "she will hev to see +her way when I tell her to open her eyes an' look!" + +"Nay, but there are two to this bargain," said Dan, good-humouredly. "I +would not consent to have her on such terms. She must fix and arrange +everything without constraint from any one--not even from you, Duncan +McKay." + +"Oh! fery goot!" retorted the old man with a touch of sarcasm; "you know +fery well what Elspie will be sayin' to that, or you would not be so +ready to let it rest with her. Yes, yes, she is safe to see her way to +go the way that you want her to go." + +It was a strange coincidence that at the very time these two were +conversing on this subject in the verandah of Ben Nevis Hall, Mrs +Davidson and Elspie were discussing the very same subject in an upper +room of Prairie Cottage. We refrain from giving the details, however, +as it would be unpardonable to reveal such matters. We will merely +state that the conclusions to which the ladies came were very similar to +those arrived at by the gentlemen. + +But delay was still destined to be an element in the cup of this +unfortunate couple. + +When the harvest had been gathered in that year, there came what old +McKay called a visitation which, with its consequences, recalls +irresistibly the words of our great Scottish poet--"the best-laid +schemes o' mice and men gang aft a-gley." This visitation was a plague +of mice. The whole colony was infested with them. Like the +grasshoppers, the mice devoured everything. The grain after being +stacked was almost totally destroyed by them. The straw, the very +stubble itself, was cut to atoms. The fields, the woods, the plains, +seemed literally alive with this new visitor, and the result would have +been that most of the settlers would again have been driven to spend +another dreary winter in trapping and hunting with the Indians at +Pembina, if it had not been for the fortunate circumstance that the +buffalo runners had been unusually successful that year. They returned +from the plains rejoicing,--their carts heavily laden with buffalo-robes +and innumerable bags of pemmican. + + + +CHAPTER THIRTY ONE. + +RETRIBUTION. + +Owing to the success of the buffalo runners, the winter passed away in +comparative comfort. But, as we have said, some of the settlers who had +been ruined by the failure of the fisheries and the depredations of the +mice, and who did not share much in the profits of the autumn hunt, were +obliged once again to seek their old port of refuge at Pembina. + +Among these was the Swiss family Morel. Andre went, because he did not +wish to remain comparatively idle in the colony during the long months +of winter. Elise went for the purpose of keeping house--perhaps we +should say keeping hut--for Andre. Fred Jenkins went because he wanted +to learn more about Indian ways and customs, as well as to perfect +himself in the art of hunting the buffalo--that was all! + +There were some who did not believe what the bold seaman said. Elise +Morel was one of these--perhaps the most unbelieving amongst them. + +Indeed, she laughed quite hilariously when his motive was reported to +her by Billie Sinclair the day before they started. + +"Why do you laugh so?" inquired Little Bill, who was always more or less +in a state of surprise when he got upon this subject with Elise. + +"It is not easy to say, Billie," answered the girl, with another +pleasant little laugh, "but it is so funny that a sailor should take +such a fancy to come out here, so far away from his native element, and +find so much interest in snow-shoe walking and Indian customs." + +"Yes, isn't it?" responded the boy, "and him such a fine big man, too, +who has gone through so much, and seen so many lands, and been in such a +lot o' fights with pirates, and all that kind of thing. I can't +understand him at all. I wish I understood him better, for I like him +very much. Don't you?" + +Elise was so much taken up with what she was doing at the time that she +could not answer the question, and Billie was in such a wandering state +of mind that he neglected to press it! + +Daniel Davidson also went to Pembina that winter, because he could not +bear to press the subject of his marriage just after the destruction of +his and old McKay's crops by mice--a disaster which told rather heavily +on both families. When winter had passed away, he, along with many +others, returned to the colony and made preparations for going out to +the plains for the spring hunt with the buffalo runners. + +"You will better not be goin' wi' them," said Duncan McKay senior to his +younger son, some days before the hunters had arranged to set out. "It +will not be safe after your trial, for the half-breeds are mad at you, +Tuncan." + +If the old man had been wise enough to have left his son alone, Duncan +junior would probably have remained where he was; but the mere offer of +advice roused in him the spirit of opposition, and that reference to the +half-breeds decided him. + +"If all the half-breeds in Rud River wass to go as mad as buffalo-bulls +wi' their tails cut off, I would go," said Duncan junior, with quiet +decision of tone and manner, as he lighted his pipe. + +"Ay, it iss that same you would do if you wass to be hanged to-morrow +for doin' it, Tuncan," returned the old man testily, as he fired +cloudlets in rapid succession from his compressed lips. + +Duncan junior was equally firm in replying to his sister's remonstrances +later in the day. + +"You know, dear Duncan," she said, "that, although I believe you to be +quite innocent, most of the half-breeds are of the opposite opinion, and +some of them are very revengeful, especially when they think they have +been deceived or unjustly treated." + +"I do not fear the half-breeds," replied the youth gruffly. + +"Of course you don't, Duncan, but you know that, though most of them are +good, trusty men, some are mean fellows, who would not hesitate to shoot +you in the smoke and confusion of the hunt. Do give up the idea, for my +sake, dear." + +"I would do much for your sake, Elspie, but not this, for it iss showin' +the white feather I am, they will be sayin', and, as father often says, +that iss what must never be true of a McKay." + +Accordingly, Duncan junior mounted his horse, and accompanied Dan, +Peter, Fergus, Okematan, Morel, Jenkins, and others to the plains, where +they found that the main body of the hunters, under Antoine Dechamp, had +arrived just before them. Kateegoose was also there, and La Certe, who +once more tried his fortune at the chase under all the advantages of a +new cart and horse, a new gun, and a new outfit--all received on +credit--to be paid for by the proceeds of the chase, as the creditors, +hoping against hope, tried to believe; never to be paid for at all, as +the easy-going La Certe more than half suspected--though he was far too +honest a man to admit that even to himself. + +Of course, Slowfoot was with him--amiable, meek, and silent as ever. +And so was Baby La Certe, a five-year-old by that time, and obviously a +girl with a stronger penchant than ever for tobacco! + +"The buffalo have been found already," said Dechamp to Dan Davidson, as +the latter rode into camp at the head of his party. "Bourassin has just +come in with the report that they are in great numbers away to the +nor'-west, so we will make a fair start first thing in the morning." + +As he spoke, Dechamp glanced with evident surprise at Duncan McKay. + +"Why did you let him come?" he said in an under-tone to Dan, as they +were tying up the horses. + +"How could I prevent him?" replied Dan. + +Next morning all was bustle, eager expectation, and lively conversation +in the camp. Archie was there again, promoted to the condition of a +full-fledged hunter by the possession of a gun. Little Bill was there +also. He had improved so much in health and strength that he was +permitted to ride with the runners on a pony; but was to content himself +with viewing the battle from afar--that is, well in rear. + +"Now, Little Bill," said Archie, with the seriousness of a grandfather, +as they galloped with the hunters over the rolling plains, across which +were streaming the first beams of the rising sun, "you must promise me +to keep well in rear, and on no account to join in the chase. It's of +no use to go in without a gun, you know, and there is great risk when in +the thick of it, that you may come across a bullet or two. You'll have +all the fun without the danger, Little Bill." + +"All right, old boy; I'll do my best." + +"Hallo, Archie!" cried Jenkins, galloping up alongside, with the +blunderbuss in his left hand, "I've bin lookin' for you, lad. It's not +easy to spy out a friend in such a shoal o' queer craft. Are 'ee goin' +to sail alongside o' me this bout?" + +"Of course I am, Fred. A man that can steer his way by compass over +such a sea o' grass is worth holding on to." + +"Well, then, heave ahead. We'll hunt in couples. I see they're gettin' +into line o' battle, which means that the enemy's in view." + +The sailor was right. Buffalo were seen grazing in the far distance, +and the cavalcade was getting into line so as to advance in good order. + +As on a former occasion, they approached at a slow pace until the +animals began to lift their heads and throw inquiring glances in the +direction from which the mounted host came. Then the word was given to +trot, and, finally, to charge. + +The rush on this occasion was even more tremendous than on the former, +for there were considerably more men, and a larger herd of buffalo. + +The lumbering heavy gait of the latter at the first start did not +suggest the racing speed to which the clumsy creatures attained when +they were hard pressed. Soon the dropping shots of the fast riders +swelled into the rattling musketry of the real fight, and ere long the +plain became strewed with dead and wounded animals, while smoke and dust +obscured the air. + +There was no order maintained after the first onset. Every man seemed +to fight for his own hand. Crossing and re-crossing and firing +recklessly in all directions, it seemed a very miracle that no fatal +accidents occurred. Minor ones there were. Archie and his nautical +comrade witnessed a few of these. + +"I say, look at Bourassin!" exclaimed the former, pointing to the left +with his nose--both hands being fully engaged with gun and bridle. + +The seaman's eye turned in the direction indicated, and he beheld +Bourassin's horse stopped by the hairy forehead of a buffalo-bull, while +Bourassin himself was in the act of describing a magnificent parabolic +curve over the buffalo's back. He alighted on his back, fortunately on +a low bush, a yard or two beyond the buffalo's tail. + +"Killed!" exclaimed Jenkins, anxiously, as he turned his horse in the +direction of the fallen man. + +But the seaman was wrong. The hunter did indeed lie flat and motionless +for a few seconds--which was just as well, for it gave the bull time to +toss off the horse, turn, and leap over the prostrate man in continuing +its flight; but in another moment Bourassin was on his feet, soon caught +his trembling horse, remounted, and continued the chase. + +A little further on they saw Peter Davidson's horse put his foot in a +badger-hole, the result of which was that the horse rolled over in one +direction, while the expert Peter, tumbling cleverly to one side, rolled +away in another direction like a Catherine-wheel. Both horse and man +arose unhurt, and, like Bourassin, continued the chase. + +"Necks ain't easy broke in this here country," remarked the seaman, as +Archie pushed past him in pursuit of a fat young cow. + +"Not often. Necks are tough, you see, and ground is mostly soft," cried +Archie, as he fired and dropped the cow. + +"Who's that away to the right, ridin' like a madman after a calf?" asked +Jenkins, overtaking Archie, who was recharging his gun at the gallop. + +"Who--where?" cried the boy, looking impatiently round. + +"Keep cool, lad! Whatever condition you chance to be in, whether of +danger or safety, always keep cool. For why?--it makes you comfortable, +or more fit for action, as the case may be. See, the fellow over there +half-hidden by smoke." + +"Why, that's Duncan McKay. You might know him by his hat." + +"I ain't a good judge o' hats," remarked the seaman, as he fired at a +bull and missed it. "Ha! that comes o' firin' at long range," he said. +"It was at least six yards off, an' I can't count on the old blunderbuss +beyond five. Better luck next time!" + +"Hallo! Jenkins, did you hear that?" + +"What?" + +"That shriek? I'm sure some one has been hurt." + +"Very likely, lad. There's many a cropper a-goin' on just now, an' we +can't all expect to come off scot-free." + +"The voice sounded like that of Fergus," said Archie, "but I can see +nothing for smoke now. Is that a man on the ground over there?" + +"Don't know, Archie. Out o' the way, lad; there's another chance. Must +get closer this time." + +The tide of the chase swept on with irresistible fury, and not one of +all the band saw that the man who had fallen did not rise. + +Following close in rear, and profoundly excited with this new and wild +experience of life, came Little Bill, galloping along on his pony. + +The poor boy had either greatly benefited by his recent adventures, or a +change had taken place in his constitution, for he rode with ease, and +found that he could walk considerable distances without the old weary +feeling of exhaustion. + +As Little Bill passed over the prairie, which resembled a field of +battle where, not men, but buffaloes had been the combatants, he came +suddenly upon the dismounted hunter, who lay prone upon his face. + +"Poor man!" thought Little Bill, pulling up and dismounting, "he seems +to have been badly stunned." + +Stooping down he turned the fallen man over on his back with some +difficulty, and then discovered, to his consternation, that it was young +Duncan McKay, and that blood was flowing from a wound in his side. + +The shock at first deprived Billie of the power to do anything, but in a +very few minutes his strong common sense returned, and his first act was +to open Duncan's coat and stanch the wound. This he accomplished by +means of a strip torn off the poor man's cotton shirt, and the long red +worsted belt with which the hunter's capote was bound. Then he took +from his pocket a small bottle of water, with which he had provided +himself in case of need, and poured a little into Duncan's mouth. + +The result of these operations was that the fallen man opened his eyes +after a while, raised himself on one elbow, and looked round in a dazed +manner. + +"What iss it that has come over me?" he asked, faintly. + +"You have fallen off your horse, I think," answered the boy, "and I--I'm +afraid a bullet has wounded you in the side." + +"Bullet! Side!" exclaimed Duncan, looking quickly down at the bandage, +and attempting to rise. "Little Bill, you must--" + +He stopped; seemed to grow faint, and fell down; but quickly raised +himself again on one elbow and looked round. + +"Shot!--dying!" he muttered; then turning to the boy--"Stay by me, +Little Bill. Don't leave me here all alone." + +"No, I won't leave you, unless--perhaps it would be better if I rode +back to camp for help." + +"True, true. It's my only chance," said the poor man, faintly. "Go, +Billie, and go quick. Put something under my head. And--stay--leave +your gun with me." + +"I'm so sorry I haven't got one, but here is my bottle of water; you may +want that, and--" + +He stopped, for Duncan had evidently fainted again. + +The poor boy was terribly alarmed at this. He had wit enough to +perceive that prompt action was needed, for his friend was in very great +danger, while the buffalo runners were by that time out of sight in +front, and the camp was far behind. In this crisis Billie acted with +decision. First making the bandage over the wound more secure, and +pouring a little more water into the mouth of the wounded man, he went +to a clump of willows, and cut a stout switch, then, remounting, he +turned on his track and made straight for the camp as fast as his +willing pony could be made to lay hoof to the ground. + +Arrived there, to his great relief he found the Cree chief Okematan, for +that eccentric individual had, owing to some unknown reason, refrained +from joining in the hunt that day. La Certe was also there. + +In a few minutes, mounted on a fresh horse, Little Bill was galloping +over the prairie, acting as guide to Okematan, while La Certe followed +them, driving a cart with a couple of buffalo-robes in it. + +That night, instead of rejoicing in the camp of the buffalo runners +after their successful hunt, there was uneasiness and gloom, for Duncan +McKay lay in his tent dangerously wounded, and it was generally believed +that the shot which laid him low had been fired not by accident, but +with deliberate intent to kill. + + + +CHAPTER THIRTY TWO. + +SUFFERING AND ITS RESULTS. + +When the news that young Duncan had been shot was brought to Ben Nevis, +the effect on his father was much more severe than might have been +expected, considering their respective feelings towards each other. + +It was late in the evening when the news came, and the old man was +seated in what he styled his smoking-room, taking his evening glass of +whisky and water. + +"Elspie," he said, in a subdued voice, on being told, "help me up to my +bed." + +This was so very unusual a request that Elspie was somewhat alarmed by +it, as well as surprised--all the more so that the old man left the room +without finishing either his pipe or glass. Still, she did not suppose +that anything serious would come of it. A night's rest, she thought, +would do away with the evils of the shock. + +"Dear father," she said, as she kissed him at parting, "do believe that +God is waiting to be gracious: that He really means it when He says, +`Come unto me, all ye that labour and are heavy laden, and I will give +you rest.' And, consider--we have no reason to suppose that dear +Duncan's wound is very dangerous." + +"Goot-night, Elspie," was all the reply. + +Next morning McKay did not make his appearance at the usual +breakfast-hour, and, on going to his room, they found him lying +speechless in his bed, suffering under a stroke of paralysis. + +He soon recovered the power of speech, but not the use of his limbs, and +it became evident ere long that the poor man had received a shock which +would probably cripple him for life. Whatever may have been his secret +thoughts, however, he carefully concealed them from every one, and +always referred to his complaint as, "this nasty stiff feeling about the +legs which iss a long time of goin' away--whatever." + +In a few days, Fergus returned from the plains, bringing his brother in +a cart, which had been made tolerably easy by means of a springy couch +of pine-branches. They did not tell him at first of his father's +illness, lest it should interfere with his own recovery from the very +critical condition in which he lay. At first he took no notice of his +father's non-appearance, attributing it to indifference; but when he +began slowly to mend, he expressed some surprise. Then they told him. + +Whatever may have been his thoughts on the subject, he gave no sign, but +received the information--as, indeed, he received nearly all information +at that time--in absolute silence. + +Fortunately, the bullet which struck him had passed right through his +side, so that he was spared the pain, as well as the danger, of its +extraction. But, from his total loss of appetite and continued +weakness, it was evident that he had received some very severe, if not +fatal, internal injury. At last, very slowly, he began to grow a little +stronger, but he was a very shadow or wreck of his former self. +Nevertheless, the more sanguine members of the family began to entertain +some faint hope of his recovery. + +Of course, during these first days of his weakness his sister Elspie +nursed him. She would, if permitted, have done so night and day, but in +this matter she had to contend with one who was more than a match for +her. This was Old Peg, the faithful domestic. + +"No, no, dearie," said that resolute old woman, when Elspie first +promulgated to her the idea of sitting up all night with Duncan, "you +will do nothin' of the sort. Your sainted mother left your father an' +Fergus an' yourself to my care, an' I said I would never fail you, so I +can't break my promise by letting you break your health. I will sit up +wi' him, as I've done many a time when he was a bairn." + +It thus came to pass that Elspie nursed her brother by day, and Old Peg +sat up with him at night. Of course the duties of the former were +considerably lightened by the assistance rendered by various members of +the family, as well as friends, who were ever ready to sit by the +bedside of the wounded man and read to or chat with him. At such times +he was moderately cheerful, but when the night watches came, and Old Peg +took her place beside him, and memory had time to commence with him +undisturbed, the deed of which he had had been guilty was forced upon +him; Conscience was awakened, and self-condemnation was the result. +Yet, so inconsistent is poor humanity that self-exculpation warred with +self-condemnation in the same brain! The miserable man would have given +all he possessed to have been able to persuade himself that his act was +purely one of self-defence--as no doubt to some extent it was, for if he +had not fired first Perrin's action showed that he would certainly have +been the man-slayer. But, then, young McKay could not shut his eyes to +the fact that premeditation had, in the first instance, induced him to +extend his hand towards his gun, and this first act it was which had +caused all the rest. + +Often during the wakeful hours of the night would the invalid glance at +his nurse with a longing desire to unburden his soul to her, but +whenever his eye rested on her calm, wrinkled old visage, and he thought +of her deafness, and the difficulty of making her understand, he +abandoned his half-formed intention with a sigh. He did not, indeed, +doubt her sympathy, for many a time during his life, especially when a +child, had he experienced the strength and tenderness of that. + +After attending to his wants, it was the habit of Old Peg to put on a +pair of tortoise-shell spectacles and read. Her only book was the +Bible. She read nothing else--to say truth, at that time there was +little else to read in Red River. The first night of her watch she had +asked the invalid if he would like her to read a few verses to him. + +"You may if you like, Peg," he had replied. "You know it iss little I +care for releegion, for I don't believe in it, but you may read if you +like--it may amuse me, an' will help to make the time pass--whatever." + +Thus the custom was established. It was plain that the old woman +counted much on the influence of the simple Word of God, without +comment, for every time she opened the Bible she shut her eyes and her +lips moved in silent prayer before she began to read. + +The invalid was greatly tickled with this little preliminary prayer, and +would have laughed aloud if he had not been too weak to do so. As time +went on, however, he became interested in the Gospel narratives in spite +of himself, and he began to experience some sort of relish for the +evening reading--chiefly because, as he carefully explained to Elspie, +"the droning o' the old wumman's voice" sent him to sleep. + +Meanwhile the other invalid--Duncan senior--progressed as slowly as did +his son. The nursing of him was undertaken chiefly by Jessie Davidson-- +the sympathetic Jessie--who was established as an inmate of Ben Nevis +_pro tem_, for that very purpose. She was ably seconded--during part of +each day--by Billie Sinclair, between whom and the old Highlander there +grew up at that time a strong friendship. For many weeks poor old McKay +was confined to his bed, and then, when allowed to rise, he could only +walk across his room with the aid of the strong arm of his stalwart son +Fergus. To sit at his open window and look out at his garden was his +principal amusement, and smoking a long clay pipe his chief solace. +Like Duncan junior, old Duncan was quite willing to hear the Bible read +to him now and then, by Jessie Davidson and more especially by Little +Bill; but the idea of deriving any real comfort from that book never for +a moment entered his head. + +One day Elspie came to him and said: + +"Daddy, Dan wants to see you to-day, if you feel well enough." + +"Surely, my tear. It iss not the first time he will be seein' me since +I got the stroke." + +"He has brought you a present--something that he has made--which he +hopes will be useful to you." + +"What is it, Elspie?" + +"You shall see. May I tell him to come in and bring it with him?" + +"Surely, my tear. Let him come in. It iss always goot for sore eyes to +see himself--whatever." + +Elspie went out. A few minutes later there was heard in the passage a +strange rumbling sound. + +"What in all the world iss that?" said the old man to Little Bill, who +happened to be his companion at the time. + +"It sounds like wheels, I think," said Billie. + +The door opened as he spoke, and Dan Davidson entered, pushing before +him an invalid chair of a kind that is familiar enough in the civilised +world, but which was utterly unknown at that time in those regions. + +"Goot-mornin', Tan; what hev you got there? Iss it a surprise you will +be givin' me?" + +"It is a chair, sir, which will, I hope, add a good deal to your +comfort," said Dan. "I made it myself, from the memory-model of one +which I once saw in the old country. See, I will show you how it acts. +Push me along, Jessie." + +Dan sat down in the chair as he spoke, and his sister Jessie, who +entered at the moment, pushed him all about the room with the greatest +ease. + +"Well, well!" said the amused invalid. "Ye are a clever man, Taniel. +It iss a goot contrivance, an' seems to me fery well made. Could Little +Bill push it, think ye? Go an' try, boy." + +Little Bill found that he could push Dan in the chair as easily as +Jessie had done it. + +"But that is not all," said Dan. "See--now I will work the chair +myself." + +So saying he laid his hands on the two large wheels at either side-- +which, with a little wheel behind, supported the machine--and moved it +about the room, turned it round, and, in short, acted in a very +independent manner as to self-locomotion. + +"Well, now, that _iss_ goot," exclaimed the pleased invalid. "Let me +try it, Tan." + +In his eagerness the poor man, forgetting for a moment his helpless +condition, made an effort to rise, and would certainly have fallen off +the chair on which he was seated if Elspie had not sprung to his +assistance. + +"Come, there's life in you yet!" said Dan as he assisted the old man +into the wheel-chair. "Put your hands--so. And when you want to turn +sharp round you've only to pull with one hand and push with--" + +"Get along with you," interrupted the old man, facetiously giving the +chair a swing that caused all who stood around him to leap out of his +way: "will you hev the presumption to teach a man that knew how to scull +a boat before you wass born? But, Taniel," he added, in a more serious +tone, "we must hev one like this made for poor Tuncan." + +As this was the first reference which McKay had made to his younger son +since his illness--with the exception of the daily inquiry as to his +health--it was hailed as an evidence that a change for the better was +taking place in the old man's mind. For up to that period no one had +received any encouragement to speak of, or enter into conversation +about, Duncan junior. + +"You are right," returned Dan. "I have been thinking of that, and have +even laid in the wood to make a similar chair for him. But I fear he +won't be able to use it for some time to come. Elspie was thinking, if +you don't object, to have your bedroom changed to one of the rooms on +the ground floor, so that you could be wheeled into the garden when so +inclined." + +"Yes, daddy," said Elspie, taking up the discourse; "we can put you into +the room that corresponds with Duncan's room at the other end of the +house, so that you and he will be able to meet after your long illness. +But there is another contrivance which Dan has been making for us--not +for you, but for Old Peg. Tell daddy about it, Dan." + +"Like the chair," said Dan, "it is no novelty, except in this +out-o'-the-way place. You see, I have noticed that Old Peg is rather +deaf--" + +"Well, Tan," interrupted old McKay with a benignant smile, "it iss not +much observation that you will be requirin' to see that!" + +"Just so. Well, I also observed that it gives Duncan some trouble to +speak loud enough to her. So I have invented a sort of ear-trumpet--a +tin pipe with an ear-piece at one end and a mouth-piece at the other, +which I hope may make things easier." + +"Hev ye not tried it yet?" asked McKay. + +"Not yet. I've only just brought it." + +"Go down, lad, an' try it at wanse, an' let me know what the upshot +iss." + +Down they all went accordingly, leaving Duncan senior alone. + +They found Old Peg in the act of administering beef-tea refreshment--or +something of that sort--to the invalid. Peter Davidson and Archie +Sinclair were there also, paying him a visit. + +"Hallo, Little Bill!" said Archie as his brother entered. "You here! I +guessed as much. Your passion for nursing since you attended Dan is +outrageous. You do more nursing in this house, I do believe, than +Elspie and Jessie and Old Peg put together. What d'ee mean by it, Bill? +I get no good of you at all now!" + +"I like it, Archie, and I'm training myself to nurse you when you get +ill or old!" + +"Thank 'ee for nothin', Little Bill, for I don't mean to become either +ill or old for some time to come; but, I say, are they goin' to perform +an operation on Old Peg's head?" + +This was said in consequence of Elspie shouting to the old woman to let +her put something into her ear to cure deafness. + +"Cure deafness!" she exclaimed, with a faint laugh, "nothin' will ever +cure _my_ deafness. But I can trust _you_, dearie, so do what you +please." + +"Shut your eyes, then." + +"And open your mouth!" said Archie to Little Bill in a low voice. + +Old Peg did as she was bid. Dan, approaching behind her, put the small +end of the tube into her right ear--which was the best one--and Elspie, +putting her mouth to the other end, spoke to her in her soft, natural +voice. + +The effect was amusing. Old Peg dropped into her chair as if paralysed, +and gazed from one to another in mute amazement. + +"Eh! dearie. Did I ever think to hear the sweet low voice o' Elspie +like as it was when she was a bairn! Most amazin'!" she said. "Let me +hear't again." + +The operation was repeated, and it was finally found that, by means of +this extemporised ear-trumpet, the poor creature once more became a +conversable member of society. She went about the house the remainder +of that day in a quite excited state, asking questions of everybody, and +putting the end of the instrument to their mouths for an answer. Archie +even declared that he had caught her alone in the back-kitchen shoving +the cat's head into the mouth-piece of the instrument, and pinching its +tail to make it mew. + +It was two days after the occurrence of these incidents that the old +woman was seated by Duncan's bedside, gazing through her tortoise-shell +glasses at the well-thumbed Bible, when her patient, who had been very +restless, looked up and spoke. + +"Can I do anything for ye, dearie?" said Old Peg, putting the +trumpet-end into her ear, and handing the mouth-piece to Duncan. + +"You--you hear much better now, Old Peg?" said the sick man, in his +natural voice. + +"Ay, much, much better; thanks to the Lord--and to Mr Daniel." + +"If Daniel had not thought of it," said the invalid, quite gravely, "do +you think that the Lord would hev sent the machine to you?" + +"He might or He might not," returned the old woman, promptly. "It's not +for me to say, nor yet to guess on that point. But this I do know for +certain--if the Lord hadna' thought upon Mr Daniel, then Mr Daniel +wouldna' have been here to think upon _me_." + +Duncan made no reply, and for some time remained quite silent. Then he +spoke again. + +"Peg, what wass it that you would be reading to me last night--something +about a malefactor, I'm thinking." + +"Ay, it was about the robbers that was crucified on each side o' the +Lord. One o' them reviled the Lord as he was hangin' there, the other +found forgiveness, for he was led to see what a lost sinner he was, and +repented and confessed his sins." + +"That is fery strange," said Duncan, after a few moments' thought. "Do +you think, Peg, that the robber that was forgiven wass a--a murderer?" + +"I have little doubt o't," answered Peg, "for I've heard say that they +think very little o' human life in them Eastern countries. But whatever +he was, the blood of Jesus Christ was able to cleanse him." + +"Ay, but if he was a murderer, Peg, he did not _deserve_ to be +forgiven." + +"My bairn," said the old woman, with something of motherly tenderness in +her tone, "it's not them that _deserve_ to be forgiven that _are_ +forgiven, but them that see that they _don't_ deserve it. Didna' this +robber say that he was sufferin' for his sins justly? That, surely, +meant that he deserved what he was getting, an' how is it possible to +deserve both condemnation an' forgiveness at the same time? But he +believed that Jesus was a king--able and willing to save him though he +did _not_ deserve it, so he asked to be remembered, and he _was_ +remembered. But lie down now, bairn, an' rest: Ye are excitin' +yoursel', an' that's bad for ye." + +A week or so after the conversation above recorded, Dan brought a +wheel-chair for Duncan, similar to the one he had made for his father. +As Duncan had been getting out of bed for several days before, Dan found +him dressed and sitting up. He therefore lifted him into the chair at +once, and wheeled him out into the garden, where a blaze of warm +sunshine seemed to put new life into the poor invalid. + +It had been pre-arranged that old McKay should be brought down that same +day to his new room, and that he should also be wheeled into the garden, +so as to meet his son Duncan, without either of them being prepared for +the meeting. + +"I don't feel at all sure that we are right in this arrangement," Elspie +had said; but Dan and Fergus, and Mrs Davidson and Jessie had thought +otherwise, so she was overruled. + +Archie was deputed to attend upon Duncan junior, and Little Bill +obtained leave to push the chair of old McKay. The younger man was +wheeled under the shade of a tree with his back to the house, and left +there. Then the family retired out of the way, leaving Archie to attend +the invalid. + +A few minutes after young Duncan had been placed, Little Bill pushed his +charge under the same tree, and, wheeling the chair quickly round, +brought father and son suddenly face to face. + +The surprise was great on both sides, for each, recollecting only the +man that _had been_, could hardly believe in the reality of the ghost +that sat before him. + +"Father!" exclaimed Duncan at last. + +But the old man answered not. Some strong feeling was evidently surging +within him, for his mouth was tightly pursed and his features worked +strangely. Suddenly he burst into tears, but the weakness was +momentary. With an effort that seemed to concentrate the accumulated +energy of all the McKays from Adam downwards, he again pursed his mouth +and looked at his younger son with a stern persistent frown, worthy of +the most rugged of Highlanders in his fiercest mood. + +Duncan was inexpressibly touched. + +"Father," said he again, "I've been a baad, baad son to _you_." + +"Tuncan," retorted the old man, in a husky but firm voice, "I've been a +baad, baad father to you." + +"Let us shake hands--whatever," said the son. + +The two silently grasped each other's hands with all the little strength +that remained to them. Then old McKay turned suddenly to his henchman. + +"Little Bill," said he, in a tone that was not for an instant to be +disregarded, "shove me down to the futt of the garden--you _rascal_!" + +With a promptitude little short of miraculous the Highlander was wheeled +away, and thus the momentous meeting was abruptly brought to a close. + + + +CHAPTER THIRTY THREE. + +MATRIMONIAL PLANS AND PROSPECTS. + +Time passed by, as time is rather apt to do, and still the feud between +the rival fur companies continued, to the detriment of the Indians and +the fur-trade, the unsettling of Red River Settlement, and the +demoralisation more or less of all concerned. + +Men who would gladly have devoted all their energies to the arts of +peace, became more or less belligerent in spirit, if not in act, and +many were forced to take sides in the controversy--some siding with the +Nor'-Westers and others with the Hudson's Bay Company. + +With the merits of their contentions we do not propose to meddle. We +confine ourselves to facts. + +One important fact was that our hero Daniel Davidson took the side of +the Hudson's Bay Company. Being a stout fellow, with a good brain, a +strong will, an independent spirit, and a capable tongue, he was highly +appreciated by the one side and considerably hated by the other, +insomuch that some of the violent spirits made dark suggestions as to +the propriety of putting him out of the way. It is not easy, however, +or safe, to attempt to put a strong, resolute man out of the way, and +his enemies plotted for a considerable time in vain. + +The unsettled state of the colony, and the frequent failure of the crops +had, as we have seen, exerted an evil influence for a long time on poor +Dan's matrimonial prospects, and at last, feeling that more settled +times might yet be in the remote future, and that, as regarded defence +and maintenance, it would be on the whole better both for Elspie and +himself that they should get married without delay, he resolved to take +the important step, and, as old McKay remarked, have it over. + +"You see, Taniel," said the old man, when the subject was again +broached, "it iss of no use hangin' off an' on in this fashion. +Moreover, this nasty stiff leg o' mine is so long of getting well that +it may walk me off the face o' the earth altogether, an' I would not +like to leave Elspie till this matter iss settled. Tuncan also iss a +little better just now, so what say you to have the weddin' the month +after next? Mr Sutherland will be back from the Whitehorse Plains by +then, an' he can tie the knot tight enough--whatever. Anyway, it iss +clear that if we wait for a munister o' the Auld Kirk, we will hev to +wait till doomsday. What say you, Taniel?" + +It need hardly be said that Dan had nothing whatever to say in objection +to this scheme. It was therefore settled--under the proviso, of course, +that Elspie had no objection. Dan went off at once to see Elspie, and +found that she had no objection, whereupon, after some conversation, +etcetera, with which we will not weary the reader, he sought out his +friend Fred Jenkins, to whom he communicated the good news, and treated +him to a good many unanswerable reasons why young people should not +delay marriage when there was any reasonable prospect of their getting +on comfortably in life together. + +The sailor agreed with effusive heartiness to all that he said, and Dan +thought while he was speaking--orating--as one of the American settlers +would have expressed it--that Jenkins wore a peculiar expression on his +manly countenance. Attributing it to unusual interest in the event, he +continued-- + +"Now, Fred, I want you to be my best-man--" + +"Unpossible--quite unpossible," interrupted the seaman with a grave +shake of the head. + +"How--impossible!" + +"Ab-so-lutely unpossible." + +"But why? Explain yourself, Fred." + +"'Cause it's only a bachelor as can be a best-man to a bachelor--ain't +it?" + +"I believe so, though I'm no authority in such matters; but surely that +is a matter of no importance, for _you_ are a bachelor, you know." + +"True, that's what I am to-day, but I won't be that long, for I am goin' +to be married next month, so I won't be available, d'ee see, the month +after." + +"You--married!--to whom?" exclaimed Dan in amazement. + +"Well, that's a point blank shot right between wind an' water. +Hows'ever, I suppose I can't go wrong in tellin' you, Dan, for it's all +settled, though not a soul knows about it except Little Bill, an' +yourself, an' her brother." + +"But I _don't_ know about it yet," returned Dan. "Who is it?" + +"A angel--pure an' unmixed--come straight down from heaven a-purpus to +marry poor, unedicated, sea-farin' Fred Jenkins, an' her terrestrial +name is Elise Morel!" + +Dan laughed while he congratulated the modest seaman, and admitted the +strength of his difficulty. + +"D'you know, Fred, I've had a suspicion for some time past that you had +a leaning in that direction?" + +"So have I, Dan, had an uncommon strong suspicion for a very long time +past, not only that I had a leanin' that way, but a regular list to +port, an' now I'm fairly over on my beam-ends!" + +"But, surely, it must have come upon you very sudden at last," said Dan. +"How was it?" + +"Sudden! I should just think it did--like a white squall in the +Mediterranean, or a hurricane in the China seas. This is how it was. +I'd bin cruisin' about her--off an' on--for a considerable time, tryin' +to make up my mind to go into action, an' screwin' my courage up to the +stickin' pint by recallin' all the fine sentiments that has carried +Jack-tars through fire an' smoke, shot and shell since the world +began--`England expects every man to do his dooty,'--`Never say +die,'--`Hookey Bunkum,' an' such like. But it warn't no manner o' use, +for I'm an' outrageous coward wi' the gals, Dan. So, in a sort o' +despair, I sailed away this very mornin' into the plantation at the futt +o' your garden, intendin' to cool myself an' think over it, when, who +should I see almost hull down on my lee bow but the enemy--Elise +herself! + +"Well, I changed my course at once; bore straight down on her, an' soon +overhauled her, but the nearer I came the more did my courage run out, +so I gradooally begun to take in sail an drop astarn. At last I got +savage, `You're a fool, Jenkins!' says I to myself. `That's a fact!' +says su'thin' inside o' me. + +"Now, if that su'thin' had kep' quiet, I do believe that I'd have gone +about-ship an' showed her my heels, but that su'thin', whatever it was, +set up my dander. `Now then,' says I, `haul taut the main brace! Up +wi' the t'gall'nt-s'ls an' sky-scrapers! "England expects," etceterer!' + +"Afore you could say Jack Robinson, I was along side--grapplin'-irons +hove into her riggin', and a broadside fired. The way I gave it her +astonished even myself. Nelson himself could scarce ha' done it better! +Well, she struck her colours at the first broadside, an' somehow--I +never could make out exactly how--we was sittin' on the stump of a tree +with her head on my rough unworthy buzzum. Think o' that! Dan, _her_ +head--the head of a Angel! Give us your flipper, mate." + +"I congratulate you, Jenkins, with all my heart," said Dan, grasping the +seaman's flipper, and giving it a hearty shake. "So now, I must look +out for another best-man. Morel will do for me, I think, and you can +have my brother Peter, no doubt. But could we not manage to have both +weddings on the same day?" + +"Impossible," answered the seaman, promptly. "Couldn't wait." + +"But we might compromise the matter. I might have mine a little sooner +and you could have yours a little later." + +Still Jenkins shook his head. "Not fair-play," he said. "All the +advantage on your side. However, we might consider it. Hold a sort o' +drum-head court-martial over it, with Elise and Elspie as judges." + +When the said court-marital--as Dan called it--was held, the compromise +was agreed to, and it was finally fixed that six weeks thereafter the +two couples should be united in Ben Nevis Hall. + +But the current of these parallel streams of true love was not yet +destined to run smooth--as the next chapter will show. + + + +CHAPTER THIRTY FOUR. + +A NEW DISASTER. + +"I mean to go off to-morrow on a shooting trip to the lake," said Dan +Davidson to Archie Sinclair. "I've had a long spell at farming +operations of late, and am tired of it. The double wedding, you know, +comes off in six weeks. So I want to have one more run in the +wilderness in all the freedom of bachelorhood. Will you go with me?" + +"`Unpossible,' as Jenkins would say," answered Archie. "Nothing would +please me better, but, duty before pleasure! I've promised to spend a +week along wi' Little Bill at the Whitehorse Plains. Billie has taken a +great fancy to that chief o' the half-breeds, Cuthbert Grant, and we are +goin' to visit him. I've no doubt that Little Bill would let me off, +but I won't be let off." + +"Then I must ask Okematan to go with me," said Dan. + +"You needn't trouble yourself, for I heard him say that he was goin' off +to see some o' his relations on important business--a great palaver o' +some sort--and Elise told me this morning that she saw him start +yesterday." + +"Morel is too busy with his new farm to go," rejoined Dan, "and Jenkins +is too busy helping Morel. Perhaps Dechamp or Bourassin may be more at +leisure. I will go see." + +But on search being made, neither Dechamp nor Bourassin was to be found, +and our hero was returning home with the intention of taking a small +hunting canoe and going off by himself, when he chanced to meet with La +Certe. + +That worthy seemed unusually depressed, and returned Dan's greeting with +very little of his habitual cheerfulness. + +"What's wrong with you, Francois?" asked Dan, anxiously. + +"Domestic infelicity," answered La Certe, with a sorrowful shake of the +head. + +"What! surely Slowfoot has not taken to being unkind to you?" + +"O no! Slowfoot could not be unkind, but she is unhappy; she has lost +her cheerful looks; she does not take everything as she once did; she +does not now let everything go anyhow with that cheerful resignation +which was once her delightful characteristic. She no longer hands the +pipe of peace to our little one--indeed she refuses to let it have the +pipe at all, though the poor child cries for it, and comes to me +secretly, when Slowfoot is out of the way, to beg for a draw. Then, she +scolds me--no, she does not scold. Slowfoot cannot scold. She is too +amiable--but she remonstrates, and that is worse than scolding, for it +enlists myself against myself. O! I am now miserable. My days of +peace are gone!" + +"This is all very sad, La Certe," said Dan, in a tone of sympathy. +"What does she remonstrate about?" + +"About my laziness! She does it very kindly, very gently--so like her +old self!--but she _does_ it. She says, `Husband; we have gone on this +way too long. We must change. _You_ must change. You are lazy!'" + +"Well, La Certe," said Dan, "I'm afraid that Slowfoot is right." + +"I know she is right!" retorted the half-breed, with more of +exasperation in his manner than his friend had ever before seen in him. +"When that which is said of one is false, one can afford to smile, but +when it is true what can one say? Yet it is hard--very hard. _You_ are +full of energy; you love to expend it, and you search for work. It is +natural--and what is natural _must_ be right. So, I am full of +laziness. I love to indulge it, and I search for repose. That is also +natural, and what is natural _must_ be right. Voila!" + +"Then I suppose your love for repose," returned Dan, "will oblige you to +decline an offer which I thought of making to you." + +"What is that?" + +"To go with me on a shooting expedition to Lake Winnipeg for a week or +two." + +"O no! I will not decline that," returned La Certe, brightening up. +"Shooting is not labour. It is amusement, with labour sufficient to +make after-repose delightful. And I will be glad to leave my home for a +time, for it is no longer the abode of felicity." + +This having been satisfactorily arranged, preparations made, and +Slowfoot advised of her husband's intention, Dan went to Ben Nevis Hall +next morning to bid farewell to Elspie for a brief period. He found +only old McKay in the Hall, Elspie having gone up the Settlement, or +down the Settlement--the man did not know which--to call on a friend. + +"See that ye will not be long o' comin' back, Tan," he said. "There +will be a good many arranchments to make, you see." + +"I hope to be back in three weeks at latest," said Dan, "if all goes +well." + +"Ay, if all goes well," repeated the old man, thoughtfully. "As Elspie +says sometimes, `We never know what a day may bring furth.' Well, well, +see that you will not be upsetting your canoe, for canoes are cranky +things--whatever." + +In a short time our hero and La Certe found themselves floating once +more on the calm breast of the mighty inland sea. + +It was afternoon. The circumstances were eminently conducive to the +felicity which is derivable from repose, and thus admirably suited to +the tastes of La Certe. An unruffled sheet of glassy water lay spread +out to the north-western horizon, which not only doubled the canoe and +its occupants, but reflected the golden glory of the sun, and mirrored +every fleecy cloudlet in the bright blue sky. A mere dip of the paddles +now and then served to give impulse to the light, and literal, bark. +Genial warmth pervaded the atmosphere, and little white gulls floated +almost motionless on outspread wings, or sloped hither and thither with +lazy flap, while ever and anon the whistling wings of passing wild-fowl +gave promise of occupation to their guns, to say nothing of their +kettles. + +On their third day out, towards evening, they went ashore on the +lee-side of a rocky point where some bushes and trees seemed to offer +firewood and shelter. + +"This will do," said Dan, as he stepped lightly out on a shelving rock +and held the canoe while his companion took out the lading. "Plenty dry +sticks and lots of moss for bedding." + +"Truly, that is so," returned La Certe. "It is a place in which +Slowfoot would rejoice to repose, and the little one to smoke its pipe." + +"You forget," said Dan. "The little one is no longer allowed that +luxury." + +"No, I forgot not. But I reflect that it is possible to give her many a +draw on the sly." + +The fire was soon kindled, ducks were roasting in front of it, and the +kettle boiling above it. The tea had been infused, and La Certe, while +filling his pipe, was blinking good-will at all around, when the notes +of a voyageur-song were heard like an echo in the far distance. + +Gradually the song grew louder, and soon a canoe rounded the point, and +came in sight of the camp-fire. It was what used to be called a +north-canoe, of the largest size, made of birch-bark, and contained a +crew of ten men. + +The song and the paddling stopped simultaneously when the camp was +observed, and the men appeared to hold a consultation. Their +hesitation, however, was very brief. Suddenly, breaking again into +song, they ran the canoe to shore, and landed. + +"We are bound for Red River," said their chief to Dan. "Just come from +Canada. We suppose you don't object to our camping beside you. It is a +convenient spot." + +Of course the two hunters had no objection whatever to fraternise with +the strangers from Canada, and in a short time another large fire was +sending its myriad sparks up into the darkening sky like a gigantic +roman-candle. + +During supper the strangers made themselves very agreeable. After +supper, two of the stoutest of them arose, as if to go into the bush for +more firewood. Suddenly these threw themselves upon and seized Dan and +his comrade, who were reclining quietly on the ground. Before either +could make even an attempt at self-defence they were overpowered by the +Canadians, and held forcibly down, while their arms were securely bound +to their sides with strips of deerskin. + +"It is useless to struggle, Dan Davidson," said the chief, when this was +being accomplished. "We know you as a bitter opponent of the +Nor'-westers, and we intend to carry you where your power to do mischief +will be ended." + +"Who are you? and under whose authority do you act?" demanded Dan, +angrily. + +"Who I am is a matter of no interest to you, Dan. I act under my own +authority, and I may just as well tell you, at the beginning, that if +you and your comrade choose to submit peaceably, we will treat you +reasonably well;--if not, we will find means to quiet you, even though +we should be driven to do it wi' that." + +The man pointed significantly to a gun which leant against a +neighbouring tree. His meaning could not be misunderstood. + +That night, Dan and La Certe were fastened to a tree by cords which +allowed of their moving about freely within a small space, but their +arms were not unbound. Here they were allowed to make themselves as +comfortable as possible in the circumstances. Their bed, being mossy, +was well enough, but the distracted state of their minds--especially +Dan's--may be imagined. + +"La Certe," said Dan, when the camp-fire had burned low, and the stars +were shining on them through the leaves, and all was still, save an +occasional snore from the Nor'-westers. + +La Certe groaned in reply. + +Poor Dan was not in a mood to comfort him or anybody else at that +moment, and did not follow up his remark. + +"La Certe," he said again, after a quarter of an hour. + +"Well?" + +"Do you remember John Bourke?" + +"Yes, yes. I remember him, but I care not for him. My own sorrows are +too great." + +"Do you recollect," continued Dan, regardless of this despairing remark, +"that a good while ago the Nor'-westers took him prisoner, when he was +wounded after a skirmish with them, and carried him to Canada--treating +him with great barbarity on the way. There he was put in jail, but, as +nothing could be proved against him, he was liberated, and then tried to +return to his family in Red River, but the Nor'-westers caught him +again, imprisoned him, sent him a second time to Canada, and had him +tried at the Court of the King's Bench, although his only crime was that +of resisting the North-West Company. He was acquitted, and, after +terrible sufferings from which he never quite recovered and a three +years' absence, he rejoined his family in Red River." + +"Yes, O yes! I know it all," groaned La Certe. + +"Well," continued Dan, bitterly, "his fate is not unlikely to be ours." + +The poor half-breed made no reply to this. For some time he lay quite +still, and his comrade had almost fallen into an uneasy slumber, when he +was awakened by La Certe breaking out into a soliloquy in which he +apostrophised his absent wife. + +"O my Slowfoot!" he murmured. "Shall we never meet again on earth? +Yes, you are right. I have been lazy! I _am_ lazy. I suppose that +this is punishment for my sin. But it is hard to bear, and very heavy-- +is it not?--for only following one's nature in longing for repose. O! +why was I born? Why was our little one born, to enjoy for so brief a +time the delights of smoke, and then have it denied her--except on the +sly, when with her miserable father, who will never see her more-- +perhaps." + +He paused for a few minutes, and then broke out again. + +"Yes, my Slowfoot--you are right. I must reform. I will cast off my +sloth as a garment--even--even though I should go naked all the rest of +my days! I will work--energise! I will--" + +"Hold your tongue, La Certe, and listen," said Dan in a low, stern +voice. + +"I am all attention," returned the poor man in a similarly low tone. + +"Are you game to fight, if you get the chance?" + +"Game to fight!" echoed the other--"to fight for my Slowfoot, my little +one, my smoke, and my repo--I mean my--my--new--" + +"Speak lower, man, and listen to a plan I have in my head." + +Here Dan spoke so low that he could not be heard at all, save only by +his companion; but that is of little consequence, for the plan, whatever +it might have been, was never carried out. + +Next day the Nor'-west party with their two prisoners paddled away +towards the mouth of the grand turbulent Winnipeg River, and began to +traverse the weary wilderness-route of rivers and lakes, which at that +time formed the only direct means of communication between the frontiers +of Canada and "Rupert's Land." + + + +CHAPTER THIRTY FIVE. + +THE LAST. + +Eagerly, earnestly, doggedly, did Daniel Davidson and Francois La Certe +watch for a favourable opportunity to escape from their captors, but +they waited and watched in vain, for their captors were cruel, suspected +them of the intention to escape, and were consequently careful to +prevent even an attempt being made. They never freed their wrists from +strong cords; kept knives and axes out of their way; tethered them to a +tree each night, and watched them continually. + +Can it be wondered at that, in the circumstances, our unfortunate hero +became almost insane? The wedding-day had been fixed before he left Red +River; preparations were being made for the great event, and it was +pretty well understood that Dan had gone off hunting with the view, +chiefly, to be out of people's way till the day should arrive. They +would scarcely begin to notice his prolonged absence till the day +approached. Then, no doubt, when too late, and he should be far on the +way to Canada, they would in some alarm send out parties to search for +him. + +Dan became desperate, but he was gifted with an unusual power of +self-control, so that, beyond a very stern expression, his countenance +betrayed no sign of the terrible conflict that was raging within--a +conflict in which mortal hatred of mankind in general and an +overwhelming desire to kill or be killed formed elements. Ah! reader, +poor human beings have many and many a time in the past been brought to +this terrible condition. God grant that we and ours may never know what +it is to tremble on the brink of madness because of the combined +influence of gross injustice and horrible cruelty. To do the +Nor'-westers justice, they were unaware of the intensity of the pain +they were inflicting. They had only captured a powerful enemy, and +meant, by keeping a tight hold of him, to render him powerless in the +future--that was all! + +As for La Certe, they had no intention of taking him to Canada. They +only meant to carry him so far on the road, that, when set free, it +would be impossible for him to get back to the colony in time to give +effective warning to Dan's friends. + +One afternoon the voyagers put ashore at one of the numerous portages +which obstruct the navigation of that route to Canada, and, after +unloading the canoe and lifting her out of the water, they proceeded to +carry the lading across to the still water above the rapids which +rendered this portage necessary. + +Although bound, the prisoners were by no means freed from labour. The +cords had been so arranged that they could use the paddle while in the +canoe; while, on the portages, although unable to load themselves, they +were quite able to carry a load which others placed on their shoulders. +On this occasion Dan was first sent off with a load, and then La Certe +and some of the others followed. When he reached the upper end of the +portage, Dan flung down his load, and, from his elevated position, gazed +wistfully down the valley through which the waters of the Winnipeg River +roared and seethed among jagged rocks as far as the eye could reach. It +was a wild majestic scene, but no thought of its grandeur touched the +mind of the poor prisoner. He thought only of escape. His intimate +knowledge, however, of the terrific power of rushing water told him that +there could be no escape in that direction. + +"Oh! if my arms were only free, I would risk it!" he murmured, as he +raised his hands and looked at the powerful thongs of hide with which +they were bound--thongs which were always drawn tighter when he landed, +to render an attempt at escape more hopeless. Then he glanced at the +rushing river beside him. A sheer precipice of full thirty feet +descended from the spot on which he stood to the edge of the flood. +Just below there was a whirlpool, and beyond that began the first of the +series of falls and rapids which were avoided by means of the portage. +Half-mad though he was, he did not dream of attempting such a leap with +bound hands. He would wait, and continue to hope for a more favourable +opportunity, but the possibility of such an opportunity was now growing +very faint indeed, for even if he did escape, and had a canoe to use, it +was by that time barely possible to accomplish the journey in time for +the wedding-day. But although his hope of being in time had pretty well +died out, his whole heart was still concentrated on the simple desire to +escape. + +A rush of despair came upon the poor youth just then, and the idea of +ending his misery by taking his own life occurred to him for a fleeting +moment, as he gazed wistfully around on water, wood, and sky, and +observed the laden and toiling men who were slowly clambering up the +steep towards him--La Certe being in front. + +Just then an object among the grass at his feet attracted his attention. +Stooping, he picked it up and found it to be a scalping-knife!-- +dropped, probably, long before by some passing Indians or voyageurs, for +it was very rusty. + +With a bounding heart and a wild rush of blood to his temples, he sprang +towards a tree: stuck the point of the knife into it; held the handle +with his teeth; sawed the thongs across its edge once or twice--and was +free! + +His first impulse was to bound into the woods, but the thought of his +comrade arrested him. La Certe was already close at hand. Running +towards him he said, quickly, "Drop your load! Now or never!" and cut +his bonds at once. Then, turning, he sprang towards the woods. But +from the very opening through which he meant to plunge into the tangled +thicket, there issued the leader of the Nor'-westers and two of his men. +The chief was armed with a gun, which he immediately presented. With +the instinct of bush-warriors the two prisoners dodged behind rocks, and +made for the higher ground which Dan had recently quitted. Here a sheer +precipice barred further progress. There was no way of escape but the +river. They ran to the edge and looked down. La Certe shrank back, +appalled. Dan glanced quickly round to see if there was any other +opening. Then there came over his spirit that old, old resolve which +has, in the moment of their extremity, nerved so many men to face danger +and death, from the days of Adam downward. + +"Now, La Certe," he said, grasping his comrade's hand: "Farewell! Death +or Freedom! Tell Elspie my last thoughts were of her!" + +Almost before the half-breed could realise what was said, Dan had leaped +over the cliff and disappeared in the raging torrent. A few seconds +later he was seen to rise in the whirlpool below the first cataract, and +to buffet the stream vigorously, then he disappeared a second time. +Before La Certe could make out whether his friend rose again, he was +seized from behind, and dragged from the brink of the precipice. + +Swift as the hunted stag springs from his covert, and bounds over every +obstacle with speed and apparent ease, so sprang the chief of the +Nor'-westers down the rugged path which led to the foot of the series of +rapids, and the lower end of the portage. There was good grit in the +man, morally and physically, for he was bent on a rescue which involved +considerable danger. + +Throwing off his capote, and tightening his belt, he stood on a ledge +just below the last fall, intently watching the water. + +The fall was not high, but it was deep, and rushed into a large dark +basin with terrible velocity, causing the tormented foam-speckled water +to circulate round its edges. In a few moments the form of Dan was seen +to shoot down the fall and disappear in the basin. The chief stooped, +but did not spring until, not far from him, the apparently inanimate +form reappeared on the surface and began to circle slowly round among +the flecks of foam. Then he plunged, swam out with powerful strokes, +and quickly returned to the shore with Dan in his grasp. + +Soon they were surrounded by the other voyageurs, who had left La Certe +to look after himself,--not caring much, in the excitement of the +moment, whether he escaped or not. + +"He is dead," said one; "he breathes not; and see how his face is +bruised and cut." + +"And his chest, too," said another. "I think his ribs have been broken. +Poor fellow! It was a wild, a reckless jump!" + +"Keep back, and let him have air," said the chief, who was doing his +best, according to his knowledge, to resuscitate Dan. + +Presently La Certe arrived, panting. + +"O! he is gone! My comrade, my friend, is dead!" he exclaimed, +clenching his hands, and gazing at the pale, bruised face. + +"You are wrong," exclaimed the chief, testily. "Out of the way, man! +See! his eyelids quiver." + +And so they did; and so also quivered his lips, and then a sigh came-- +faint and feeble--then stronger, and at last Dan opened his eyes and +thanked God that his life had been spared. But when he recovered +sufficiently to realise his true position as being again a captive, the +feeling of despair returned. + +That night they encamped a mile above the upper end of the portage. At +supper the two prisoners were allowed to sit by the camp-fire and eat +with their hands free. + +"Monsieur," said the guide to Dan, respectfully, "you see it is +impossible to escape. Why compel us to bind you? Give me your word of +honour that you will not try, and your limbs may then remain as free as +mine." + +"I give you my word of honour," answered Dan, with a sardonic smile, +"that till after breakfast to-morrow I will not try, for I need rest and +food; but after that, I give you my word that I will never cease to +try." + +With this promise the guide was fain to rest content, and that night Dan +and his friend were allowed to sleep untethered, which they did soundly. + +Next morning they were roused in gentler tones than usual, and not +required to work--as had been the case hitherto--before breakfast. In +short, there was an evident change in the feelings of their captors +towards them, founded largely, no doubt, on admiration of Dan's reckless +courage; but that did not induce them in the least degree to relax their +vigilance, for the moment the hour of truce had passed, the chief +advanced towards Dan with the thongs to bind him. + +For one moment Dan felt an impulse to knock the man down, and then fight +the whole party until death should end the matter; but the good-humoured +look on his jailer's face, the fact that the man had saved his life the +day before, and the certainty of defeat with such odds against him, +induced him to quell the evil spirit and to hold out his hands. + +"Pardon, Monsieur," said the chief, with the politeness of a French +half-breed. "I am sorry you refuse to give me your parole. I would +rather see you like the rest of us; but my orders are strict, and I must +obey." + +Before Dan could reply, a sound struck on their ears, which caused the +whole party to listen, immovable and in perfect silence. + +It was the wild, plaintive, beautiful song of the voyageur which had +floated to them on the morning air, softened by distance to a mere echo +of sweet sound. After listening intently for a few moments, the guide +said gently: "Voyageurs." + +Again they listened to the familiar sound, which increased in volume and +strength as it approached, proving that the voyageurs were descending +the river towards them. As yet nothing could be seen, for a +thickly-wooded point intervened. Presently the song burst on them in +full resonant chorus; at the same moment two large north-canoes--in all +the brilliancy of orange-coloured bark, painted bows and sterns, +red-bladed paddles, with crews of scarlet-capped or bare-headed men +swept round the point with quick stroke, in time to the rapid measure. + +A cheer was the irrepressible impulse of the men on shore, causing the +newcomers to stop and listen. + +"Perhaps," said Dan, "they may be your foes of the Hudson's Bay +Company." + +"That may be so," returned the Nor'-west Chief, gravely. + +The unfurling of an "H.B.C." (Hudson's Bay Company) flag proved that it +was so, to a certainty, and the depressed Nor'-westers did not cheer +again; but the H B C men came on, paddling with wild vigour and cheering +hilariously. + +"They seem in great spirits," growled the Nor'-west leader. "We are +almost as strong as they, boys, and have the advantage of woods and +cliffs. Shall we fight and keep our prisoners?" + +"What is that white thing in the bow of the first canoe?" said one of +the men. + +"It looks like a flag," said another. + +"If so, it is a flag of truce," observed Dan. "They have something to +say, and do not want to fight." + +"That may be trite, but we won't let _you_ be at the conference," +returned the leader, sternly. "Come, four of you, lead them out of +earshot. Take your guns, and use them if need be." + +Four powerful fellows at once obeyed the order, and led the prisoners, +who had been once more bound, into the woods. Once again Dan was +tempted to offer fierce resistance, but he knew that the Hudson's Bay +men were yet too far off to be able to hear shouts--at least to +understand the meaning of them--and that it would be useless to resist +such a guard. He therefore submitted to be led a mile or so into the +woods, and finally was permitted to sit down with La Certe under a tree +to await the result of the conference. + +They had not to wait long. In less than half-an-hour one of the younger +among the Nor'-westers came bounding towards them, waving his cap and +shouting. + +"You are free, Messieurs--free!" he cried, seizing both prisoners by the +hands. "We are no longer enemies!" + +"Free! What do you mean?" demanded Dan, who fancied that the young man +must have gone mad. + +"The companies have joined!" he cried, excitedly. "They are one! We +are all friends now; but come and see and hear for yourself." + +Filled with wonder, and some small degree of hope, Dan and La Certe +followed the young man, accompanied by their guards, who were not less +mystified than themselves. Arrived at their camping-place, they found +that the canoes had brought a Chief Trader--or officer of the Hudson's +Bay Company--who was conveying to Red River, and the interior of +Rupert's Land generally, the good news of a momentous historical event, +namely, the union of the two companies. + +The important event here referred to, namely, the coalition between the +two great rival companies, which took place in 1821, was the death-blow +to party strife over the whole of Rupert's Land, and also inaugurated +the dawn of lasting prosperity in the Red River Colony. + +"Cut their bonds," said the Chief Trader, as the prisoners approached. + +No touch of the surgeon's knife ever effected a cure more speedily. + +"I congratulate you, young sir," said the Trader, grasping Dan's hand: +"you are now free, for I understand that your loss of liberty had +nothing to do with crime, and the rival companies are no longer +opponents; they are friends. Indeed, we have been married, so to speak, +and are now one. I am on my way to Red River with the good news." + +"When do you start?" asked Dan, abruptly. + +"Well, if you mean from this spot," answered the Trader, somewhat +surprised as well as amused at the eagerness of the question, "I start +at once. Indeed, I would not have landed here had I not seen your +party. You appear to be anxious. Why do you ask?" + +"Because it is of the utmost importance to me that I should be in Red +River on a certain date, and I fear that that is all but impossible +now." + +Dan then explained, as briefly as possible, his circumstances. +Fortunately, the Trader was a sympathetic man. He ordered his crews to +embark at once and bade the two captives take a brief, if not an +affectionate, farewell of their late captors. + +"I cannot promise you to push on," he said, "at a rate which will +satisfy you--or even accomplish the end you have in view--but I will do +the best I can, without overworking my men. I fear, however, that you +will have to make up your mind to a delayed wedding!" + +"If you will only do your best for a day or two," said Dan, "until we +reach the mouth of this river, that will do, for there my own hunting +canoe was left; and, once in that, La Certe and I can go ahead and tell +them you are coming." + +"Nay, that would be requiting me ill--returning evil for good--to take +the wind out of my sails and make my news stale," returned the Trader, +with a good-natured laugh. + +"True, I did not think of that," said Dan. "Then we will say not a word +about it until you arrive." + +"Yes, we will be dumb," added La Certe. "Even Slowfoot shall fail to +drag it out of me!" + +And thus it was arranged. The (late) Nor'-westers continued their +voyage to Canada, and the Hudson's Bay men resumed their descent of the +Winnipeg River. + +Arrived at the great lake, the anxious pair did not wait even to rest, +but at once embarked in their little hunting canoe. + +"I'm sorry you are such an unpresentable bridegroom," said the Trader, +when they were about to separate. He referred to the cuts and bruises +with which poor Dan's countenance was temporarily disfigured. + +"Never mind," returned our hero, with a laugh, "wait till you see the +bride; she will more than make up for the shortcomings of the groom. +Adieu!--_au revoir_!" They pushed off, and now began a race against +time, which, in the matters at least of perseverance, persistency, hard +labour, and determination, beat all the records of bicyclists and +horsemen from the beginning of time. Cyclists have frequent down-hills +to help and rest them; Dan and his friend had no such aids. It was all +either dead level or upstream. Dick Turpin and the rider to Ghent, (we +forget his name), only killed their horses. Dan and Francois nearly +killed themselves--not only with hard work and no rest, but with +profound anxiety, for the wedding hour was rapidly approaching and they +were still far from home! + +While these events were transpiring in the wilderness, things were going +smoothly enough in the Colony. + +"I will be thinkin'," said old Duncan McKay, one fine evening as he sat +in his invalid chair, beside Duncan junior, who was woefully reduced and +careworn, despite the attentions of the sympathetic Jessie Davidson, who +was seated near him on a rustic seat beside Elspie-- + +"I will be thinkin' that Tan an' La Certe are stoppin' longer away than +iss altogither seemly. Tan should have been here two or three days +before the weddin'." + +"He will likely be time enough for his own weddin'--whatever," remarked +Duncan junior. "Don't you think so, Miss Jessie?" + +"I think it likely," answered the girl with a smile. + +"He is _sure_ to be in time," said Elspie, with emphasis. + +"We niver can be sure of anything in this world, my tear," remarked old +Duncan, becoming oracular in tone. "How do you know he iss so sure?" + +"Because Dan never breaks his word," returned Elspie, with an air of +decision that would have gratified Dan immensely had he been there to +see it. + +"Fery true, my tear," rejoined the Highlander, "but there are many other +things that interfere with one's word besides the will. He might tie, +you know, or be trowned, or his gun might burst and render him helpless +for life, if it did not kill him altogither. It iss an uncertain world +at the best--whatever." + +Archie Sinclair, who joined them--with his brother, Little Bill, by his +side, not on his back--was of the same opinion as Elspie, but Billie +shook his head, looked anxious, and said nothing--for he felt that his +friend was running things much too close. + +At a later hour that same evening, the other members of the two +families--who dropped in to make inquiries--began to express anxiety, +and Okematan, who called just to see how things were getting on, shook +his head and looked owlish. Old Peg said nothing, but she evidently +thought much, to judge from the deepening wrinkles on her forehead. + +As for Fred Jenkins, he was too much taken up with Elise Morel to think +much about anything, but even he at last grew anxious, and when the +wedding morning finally dawned, and no Dan made his appearance, +something like consternation filled the hearts of all within the walls +of Ben Nevis Hall and Prairie Cottage. Elspie appeared to feel less +than the others, but the truth was that she only controlled herself +better. + +"He only wants to take us by surprise," she said, and, under the +strength of that opinion, she robed herself for the wedding. Only her +gravity and the pallor of her cheeks told of uneasiness in her mind. + +"Muster Sutherland said he would come soon after breakfast," observed +old Duncan, uneasily. "He should hev been here now,--for we need his +advice sorely." + +"Here he iss," exclaimed Fergus, starting up and hurrying forward to +welcome the good old Elder. + +Mr Sutherland's advice was decided, and promptly given. Both weddings +should be deferred and all the young men must turn out in an organised +search without a moment's delay! + +It was amazing to find that every one had been of exactly the same +opinion for some time past, but no one had dared to suggest a course of +action which implied a belief that Dan might be in imminent danger, if +not worse. + +Now that the ice had been broken, however, all the youth of the +neighbourhood volunteered for service, and a plan of search was being +hastily formed under the direction of the Elder, when two men in a canoe +were seen to paddle very slowly to the landing-place at the foot of the +garden. After hauling the end of their canoe on shore, they walked, or +rather staggered, up towards the house. + +One of them tripped and fell, and seemed from his motions as if he +thought it was not worth while to rise again. The other, paying no +attention to his companion, came on. + +"Pless my soul!" exclaimed old McKay, "it iss Tan--or his ghost-- +whatever!" + +And so it was! Dirty, bruised, scratched, battered, and soaking wet, +Daniel Davidson appeared to claim his beautiful bride. And he did not +come in vain, for, regardless of propriety and everything else, Elspie +ran forward with a little shriek and flung herself into his arms. + +"I have kept my promise, Elspie." + +"I knew you would, Dan! I _said_ you would." + +"Tan, you rascal! come here." + +The youth obeyed, languidly, for it was evident that he was thoroughly +exhausted. + +"My poy," said the Highlander, touched by Dan's appearance, "you hev +been in the watter!" + +"Not exactly, father, but last night's thunderstorm caught us, and we +had no time to seek shelter." + +"An' it iss fightin' you hev been?" + +"With water and rocks only," said Dan. + +"Well, well, go into the house now, and change your clo'es. Dry +yourself, an' get somethin' to eat, for you are used up altogither." + +Elspie took his hand, and led him away. Meanwhile La Certe, having +gathered himself up and staggered to the front, was seized upon and +questioned unmercifully. Then he also was taken into the house and fed; +after which both men were made to lie down and rest. + +Having slept for six hours Dan awakened, and rose up to be married! +Fred Jenkins and Elise were--as the jovial tar expressed it--turned off +at the same time. + +It was customary in Rupert's Land at that time, as it is customary in +many remote lands, no doubt, at the present day, to celebrate every +wedding with a feast and a dance. Feasts are very much alike in +substance, if not in detail, everywhere. We refrain from describing +that which took place in Ben Nevis Hall at that time, further than to +say that it was superb. The dancing was simple: it consisted chiefly of +the Highland Fling danced by the performer according to taste or +imagination. + +But that it was eminently satisfactory to all concerned was clearly +evinced by the appearance of the whole party--the elegant ease with +which Fergus McKay did it; the tremendous energy with which Jacques +Bourassin tried it; the persistent vigour with which Andre Morel studied +it; the facility with which Elise acquired it--under Elspie's tuition; +the untiring perseverance with which Archie and Little Bill did +something like it--for the latter had quite recovered, and was fit to +hold his own, almost, with any one; the charming confusion of mind with +which Fred Jenkins intermingled the sailor's hornpipe with it; the +inimitable languor with which La Certe condescended to go through it; +the new-born energy with which Slowfoot footed it; the side-splitting +shrieks with which Old Peg regarded it; the uproarious guffaws with +which the delighted old Duncan hailed it; the sad smile with which that +weak and worn invalid Duncan junior beheld it; and, last, but not least, +the earnest mental power and conspicuous physical ability with which Dan +Davidson attempted something which Charity personified might have +supposed to bear a distant resemblance to it. + +The music was worthy of the dancing, for the appointed performer had, +owing to some occult cause, failed to turn up, and a volunteer had taken +his place with another fiddle, which was homemade, and which he did not +quite understand. A small pig with feeble intellect and disordered +nerves might have equalled--even surpassed--the tones of that violin, +but it could not hope to have beaten the volunteer's time. That, +performed on a board by the volunteer's foot, automatically, beat +everything that we have ever heard of in the musical way from the days +of Eden till now. + +Only four members of the two households failed to take a violently +active part in that festive gathering. Jessie Davidson had conveniently +sprained her ankle for the occasion, and thus was set free to sit +between the wheeled chairs of the two Duncans, and act as a sympathetic +receptacle of their varied commentaries. Her mother, being too stout +for active service, sat beside them and smiled universal benignity. Her +little maid, Louise, chanced to be ill. Peter Davidson's case, however, +was the worst. He had gone off in company with Okematan to visit a camp +of Cree Indians, intending to be back in time, but his horse had gone +lame while yet far from home, and as it was impossible to procure +another at the time, he was fain to grin and bear it. Meanwhile Antoine +Dechamp had been pressed into the service, and took his place as +best-man to Fred Jenkins--a position which he filled to admiration, +chiefly owing to the fact that he had never served in such a capacity +before. + +Late on the following evening La Certe sat by his own fireside, somewhat +exhausted by the festivities of the day before, and glaring +affectionately at Slowfoot, who was stirring something in a pot over the +fire. The little one--rapidly becoming a big one, and unquestionably by +that time a girl--crouched at her father's side, sound asleep, with her +head resting on his leg. She no longer cried for a pull at her father's +pipe. + +"Have you heard that Kateegoose is dead?" asked Slowfoot. + +"No--how did he die?" + +"He was met on the plains by enemies, killed, and scalped." + +"That is sad--very sad," said La Certe. + +"The world is well rid of him," observed Slowfoot; "he was a bad man." + +"Yes," responded her lord; "it is necessary to get rid of a bad man +somehow--but--but it is sad--very sad--to kill and scalp him." + +La Certe passed his fingers softly among the locks of his sleeping child +as if the fate of Kateegoose were suggestive! Then, turning, as from a +painful subject, he asked-- + +"Does our little one never smoke now?" + +"No--never." + +"Does she never wish for it?" + +"Slowfoot cannot tell what our little one wishes," was the reply, "but +she never gets it." + +La Certe pondered for some time, and then asked-- + +"Does my Slowfoot still like _work_?" + +"She likes it still--likes it better." + +"And she _does_ it--sometimes?" + +"Yes, often--always." + +"Why?" + +"Because Mr Sutherland advises me--and I like Mr Sutherland." + +"Does my Slowfoot expect me to like work too, and to _do_ it?" asked La +Certe with a peculiar glance. + +"We cannot like what we don't like, though we may do it," answered the +wife, drawing perilously near to the metaphysical, "but Slowfoot expects +nothing. She waits. My Francois is not a child. He can judge of all +things for himself." + +"That is true, my Slowfoot; and, do you know," he added, earnestly, "I +have had hard work--awfully hard work--killing work--since I have been +away, yet it has not killed me. Perhaps you will doubt me when I tell +you that I, too, rather like it!" + +"That is strange," said Slowfoot, with more of interest in her air than +she had shown for many a day. "Why do you like it?" + +"I think," returned the husband, slowly, "it is because I like Dan +Davidson. I like him very much, and it was to please him that I began +to work hard, for, you know, he was very anxious to get home in time to +be at his own wedding. So that made me work _hard_, and now I find that +hard work is not hard when we like people. Is it not strange, my +Slowfoot?" + +"Yes. Your words are very like the words of Mr Sutherland to-day. It +is very strange!" + +Yet, after all, it was not so very strange, for this worthy couple had +only been led to the discovery of the old, well-known fact that--"Love +is the fulfilling of the law." + +There was yet another of those whose fortunes we have followed thus far +who learned the same lesson. + +About the same time that the events just described took place in Red +River, there assembled a large band of feathered and painted warriors in +a secluded coppice far out on the prairie. They had met for a grave +palaver. The subject they had been discussing was not war, but peace. +Several of the chiefs and braves had given their opinions, and now all +eyes were turned towards the spot where the great chief of all was +seated, with a white-man beside him. That great chief was Okematan. +The Paleface was Peter Davidson. + +Rising with the dignity that befitted his rank, Okematan, in a low but +telling voice, delivered himself, as follows: + +"When Okematan left his people and went to live for a time in the +wigwams of the Palefaces, he wished to find out for himself what they +wanted in our land, and why they were not content to remain in their own +land. The answer that was at first given to my questions seemed to me +good--a reply that might have even come from the wise heads of the Cree +Nation; but, after much palaver, I found that there was contradiction in +what the Palefaces said, so that I began to think they were fools and +knew not how to talk wisely. A Cree never reasons foolishly--as you all +know well--or, if he does, we regard him as nobody--fit only to fight +and to die without any one caring much. But as I lived longer with the +Palefaces I found that they were not all fools. Some things they knew +and did well. Other things they did ill and foolishly. Then I was +puzzled, for I found that they did not all think alike, as we do, and +that some have good hearts as well as good heads. Others have the heads +without the hearts, and some have the hearts without the heads--Waugh!" + +"Waugh!" repeated the listening braves, to fill up the pause here, as it +were, with a note of approval. + +"The Palefaces told me," continued Okematan with great deliberation, as +if about to make some astounding revelations, "that their land was too +small to hold them, and so they came away. I told them that that was +wise; that Cree Indians would have done the same. But then came the +puzzle, for they told me that there were vast tracts of land where they +lived with plenty of lakes, rivers, and mountains, in which there was +nobody--only fish and birds and deer. Then I said, `You told me that +your land was too small to hold you; why did you not go and live on +these mountains, and fish and shoot and be happy?' To this they +answered that those fine lands were claimed by a few great chiefs, who +kept them for their own shooting and fishing, and drove out all the +braves with their wives and families and little ones to crowd upon the +shores of the great salt-water lake, and live there on a few fish and +shells--for even there the great chiefs would not allow them to have all +the fishing, but kept the best of it for themselves! Or, if they did +not like that, the poor braves were told to go and live in what they +called cities--where there are thousands of wigwams crowded together, +and even piled on the top of each other,--but I think the Palefaces were +telling lies when they said that--Waugh!" + +Again there were many "Waughie" responses, mingled with numerous "Ho's!" +of astonishment, and a few other sounds that seemed to indicate +disbelief in Okematan's veracity. + +"What," continued Okematan, with considerable vehemence, "what would my +braves do if Okematan and a few of the Cree chiefs were to take all the +lands of Red River, and all the buffalo, and all the birds and beasts to +themselves, and drive the braves with their families to the shores of +Lake Winnipeg, to live there on fish, or die, or leave the country if +they did not like it! What would they do?" + +Okematan's voice increased in fervour, and he put the finishing question +with an intensity that called forth a chorus of "Waughs!" and "Ho's!" +with a glittering of eyes, and a significant grasping of scalping-knives +and tomahawks that rendered further reply needless. + +"Would you not scorn us," he continued, "scalp us, tear out our eyes, +roast us alive?--but no--the Cree Nation loves not cruelty. You would +merely pat us on the head, and tell us to go and make moccasins, and +boil the kettle with the squaws! + +"Then, when I began to know them better, I found that all the Paleface +chiefs over the great salt lake are not greedy and foolish. Some are +open-handed and wise. I also found that there is a tribe among them, +who lived chiefly in the mountain lands. These are very kind, very +brave, very wise, and very grave. They do not laugh so loud as the +others, but when they are amused their eyes twinkle and their sides +shake more. This tribe is called Scos-mins. I love the Scos-mins! I +lived in the wigwam of one. He is old and fierce, but he is not bad, +and his heart is large. In his house were some other Scos-mins--braves +and squaws. They were very kind to me. This is one of them." + +The flashing eyes of the entire party were turned upon Peter Davidson, +who, however, had presence of mind enough to gaze at the cloudless +heavens with immovable solemnity and abstraction. + +"There are two others, whom I look upon as sons. One is named Arch-ee; +the other Leetil Beel. Now," continued Okematan, after a pause, "my +advice is that we should teach the Paleface chiefs over the great salt +lake a lesson, by receiving the poor braves who have been driven away +from their own lands and treating them as brothers. Our land is large. +There is room for all--and _our_ chiefs will never seize it. Our hearts +are large; there is plenty of room there too. + +"The Great Spirit who rules over all inclines my heart to go and dwell +with the Palefaces until I understand them better, and teach them some +of the wisdom of the Red-man. I shall return to Red River to-morrow, +along with my Paleface brother whose name is Pee-ter, and while I am +away I counsel my braves and brothers to dwell and hunt and fish +together in love and peace." + +How it fared with Okematan on his self-imposed mission we cannot tell, +but we do know that from 1821--the date of the auspicious coalition +before mentioned--the sorely tried colony began steadily to prosper, +and, with the exception of the mishaps incident to all new colonies, and +a disastrous flood or two, has continued to prosper ever since. +Civilisation has made rapid and giant strides, especially during the +later years of the century. The wave has rushed far and deep over the +old boundaries, and now the flourishing city of Winnipeg, with its +thousands of inhabitants, occupies the ground by the banks of the Red +River, on which, not many years ago, the old Fort Garry stood, a sort of +sentinel-outpost, guarding the solitudes of what was at that time +considered a remote part of the great wilderness of Rupert's Land. + +THE END. + + + + + + +End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of The Buffalo Runners, by R.M. Ballantyne + +*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BUFFALO RUNNERS *** + +***** This file should be named 23372.txt or 23372.zip ***** +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: + http://www.gutenberg.org/2/3/3/7/23372/ + +Produced by Nick Hodson of London, England + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at +http://gutenberg.org/license). + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org. + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at +http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at +809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email +business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact +information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official +page at http://pglaf.org + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit http://pglaf.org + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + http://www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. |
